Skip to main content

Full text of "Arithmetic for Schools"

See other formats


Google 



This is a digital copy of a book that was preserved for generations on Hbrary shelves before it was carefully scanned by Google as part of a project 

to make the world's books discoverable online. 

It has survived long enough for the copyright to expire and the book to enter the public domain. A public domain book is one that was never subject 

to copyright or whose legal copyright term has expired. Whether a book is in the public domain may vary country to country. Public domain books 

are our gateways to the past, representing a wealth of history, culture and knowledge that's often difficult to discover. 

Marks, notations and other maiginalia present in the original volume will appear in this file - a reminder of this book's long journey from the 

publisher to a library and finally to you. 

Usage guidelines 

Google is proud to partner with libraries to digitize public domain materials and make them widely accessible. Public domain books belong to the 
public and we are merely their custodians. Nevertheless, this work is expensive, so in order to keep providing this resource, we liave taken steps to 
prevent abuse by commercial parties, including placing technical restrictions on automated querying. 
We also ask that you: 

+ Make non-commercial use of the files We designed Google Book Search for use by individuals, and we request that you use these files for 
personal, non-commercial purposes. 

+ Refrain fivm automated querying Do not send automated queries of any sort to Google's system: If you are conducting research on machine 
translation, optical character recognition or other areas where access to a large amount of text is helpful, please contact us. We encourage the 
use of public domain materials for these purposes and may be able to help. 

+ Maintain attributionTht GoogXt "watermark" you see on each file is essential for informing people about this project and helping them find 
additional materials through Google Book Search. Please do not remove it. 

+ Keep it legal Whatever your use, remember that you are responsible for ensuring that what you are doing is legal. Do not assume that just 
because we believe a book is in the public domain for users in the United States, that the work is also in the public domain for users in other 
countries. Whether a book is still in copyright varies from country to country, and we can't offer guidance on whether any specific use of 
any specific book is allowed. Please do not assume that a book's appearance in Google Book Search means it can be used in any manner 
anywhere in the world. Copyright infringement liabili^ can be quite severe. 

About Google Book Search 

Google's mission is to organize the world's information and to make it universally accessible and useful. Google Book Search helps readers 
discover the world's books while helping authors and publishers reach new audiences. You can search through the full text of this book on the web 

at |http : //books . google . com/| 



tcUtTTl I r.i-S-.T}* 



► 




Saibact ffioUese Liitats 



.±AMa£cL.... 



.JA...i).d,.4X<js:, 



\i 




1 





3 2044 097 002 950 



ARITHMETIC 



mm 



AEITHMETIC 



FOR 



SCHOOLS 



BY 



CHARLES J^MITH, M.A. 

MASTER OF SIDNEY SUSSEX COLLEGE, CAMBBIDOB 
REWRITTEN AND REVVED BY 

CHARLe¥ LTjiXRRINGTON 

HEAD MASTER OF DR. J. SACHS'S SCHOOL 
FOR BOYS, NEW YORK 



NetD gorfe 
MACMILLAN AND CO. 

AND LONDON 
1896 

All rights reserved 



V 



V 



.\ 



10 ir-^^ 



r - 3 



/ 



M ^. W^v64,, 



Copyright, 1895, 
By l^CMILLAN AND CO. 



Norfajoot) iPrrssf : 

J. S. Gushing & Co. — Berwick & Smith. 

Norwood, Mass., U.SA. 



PREFACE. 



In the following work it has been the endeavor to put 
the science of Arithmetic on a sound basis, and to give 
clear and complete explanations of all the fundamental 
principles and processes. It has not been the aim to 
introduce novelties, but to promote accuracy and clearness 
of conception, so as to make the study of Arithmetic not 
only of practical utility, but also of great educational value. 

I am indebted to many friends for their kindness in 
looking over the proof sheets, for help in the verification 
of the answers, and for valuable criticisms and sugges- 
tions. My special thanks are due to Mr. J. Barnard, M.A., 
Head Mathematical Master at Christ's Hospital. 

CHARLES SMITH. 



^ 



PREFACE. 



My share in this work has been performed with the 
expectation of giving to the teachers of our Preparatory 
Schools an Arithmetic which will induce close thought 
by the student and at the same time open to him a knowl- 
edge of the reasons for the several processes which he 
will be compelled to investigate. 

I am under special obligations to Mr. E. H. Schuyler for 
his kindly criticisms, and to Mr. C. H. Gorsline for his 
suggestions in regard to the Chapters on the applications 
of Arithmetic to business calculations and forms. 

C. L. HARRINGTON. 
38 West 59th Street, 

New York City. 



Vll 



b? 



CONTENTS. 



OHA.PTEB PaGB 

I. Numeration — Notation 1 

II. Addition — Subtraction — Multiplication — Divis- 
ion 13 

m. Factors and Multiples— Square Root — Highest 
Common Factor — Least Common Multiple — 

Parenthesis — Cancellation 59 

IV. Fractions 87 

V. Decimal Measures 125 

VI. Non-Decimal Measures 139 

VII. Approximation 176 

VIII. Areas — Volumes 185 

Carpeting, Papering, Plastering .... 189 

Dimensions of Circles 193 

Specific Gravity 201 

p- IX. Ratio and Proportion 208 

Partnership 217 

Mixtures 221 

Work and Time 223 

Races and Games 226 

^ X. Percentages .231 

Profit and Loss .234 

Trade Discount 237 

Commission and Brokerage 239 

Taxes and Duties 241 

ix 



^ 



X 



CONTENTS. 



ClIAPTEB PaOE 

XI. Interest 244 

Promissory Notes 244 

Interest for Days at 6 % 249 

Interest for Days at Other Rates than 6 % . 262 

6% for Long Times 264 

Annual Interest 266 

Commercial Discount 268 

Exact Interest 268 

Partial Payments 269 

XII. Exchange — Domestic and Foreign . 276 

Xni. Stocks and Bonds 282 

XIV. Progressions 291 

XV. Cube Root 297 



^' 



ARITHMETIC. 



CHAPTER I. 

NUMERATION — NOTATION. 

1. The idea of number is first axjquired from the obser- 
vation of groups of distinct objects, actions, sounds, etc. ; 
we thus learn to speak of two boys, three balls, foui^ 
strokes of a clock, etc. 

A single object of any kind, or any group of objects 
considered as a whole, is called a unit. 

Thus, one ball, one inch, one dozen, one, one ten, are units. 

2. Arithmetic is the science which treats of numbers and 
of the different operations to which they are subject. 

3. The first few numbers in order are, one, two, three, 
four, Jive, six, seven, eight, nine, and ten, 

4. It will be observed that the names of the first ten 
numbers are in no way connected with one another. 

Now it is obvious that the knowledge of numbers and 
of their relations to one another must always have re- 
mained very limited if every successive number had had 
a special name given to it independent of the names of 
the preceding numbers ; for it would be almost impossi- 
ble to remember, in their order, many such names. 

B 1 



2 NUMERATION — NOTATION. [Chap. I. 

5. Successive numbers have therefore been named 
according to a systematic plan which requires the use of 
as few independent names as possible. 

The method by which numbers are expressed in words 
according to some systematic plan is called Numeration. 



Numeration. 

6. To show how all numbers can be named by means 
of a few special words, imagine a collection of objects of 
the same kind, for example, a heap of apples ; and sup- 
pose that we wish to know how many apples there are, 
and to give a name to this number. 

If there are not more than ten apples altogether, we 
find the number at once by counting them, that is by say- 
ing in order the names one, two, three, etc., each time 
separating one of the apples from the original heap ; and 
the name which is said with the last of the heap gives 
the number of the apples. 

If there are more than ten apples in the heap, count 
off ten and put them apart, and go on making groups of 
ten until there are fewer than ten apples left. Suppose 
there are seven groups of ten each and five apples over, 
then we could call the number seven tens and five. 

By separating the whole heap into groups of ten in 
this way we at once find, and can give a name to, the 
number of the apples, provided there are not more than 
ten of the groups. Thus, our original ten names suffice 
to name all numbers up to that which is made up of ten 
groups, each containing ten apples, and we have a new 
name, namely one hundred, for the number which con- 
sists of ten tens. 

If there are more than ten of the groups each of which 
contains ten apples, the groups ciin be arranged in sets of 



Arts. 6-7.] NUMERATION. 3 

ten, so that there will be one hundred apples in each of 
these sets. Suppose that there are five of these sets and 
six groups over and four single apples besides, then the 
number is made up of five hundreds, six tens, and four. 
Thus no new name is necessary until we come to the 
niunber which consists of ten hundreds, and this number 
is called a thousand. 

It will be seen at once that the names in actual use are only 
slightly modified forms of the names which naturally arise from 
the above method of division into groups of ten. Instead of 
saying two tens, three tens, four tens, etc., we say twenty, thirty, 
forty, etc., and we say seventy -five instead of seventy and five. 
Also instead of the names ten and one, ten and two, ten and 
three, ten and four, etc. , we use the names eleven [Gothic ainlif, 
ain one and lif ten], twelve [Gothic twalif, twa two and lif ten], 
thirteen, fourteen, etc. 

If an apple be cut into ten equal parts, any number of 
these parts may be put with some apples already counted. 
Each part is but one out of ten parts and may be counted 
as one tenth. 

If one of these tenths be cut into ten equal parts, each 
new part is but one out of ten parts of one tenth, and 
may be counted as one one-hundredth. Thus by separat- 
ing into ten equal parts, etc., we do not really require new 
names. If, now, we have five sets, six groups, four single 
apples, and three tenths and seven hundredths, then the 
number is five hundred sixty-four and thirty-seven hun- 
dredths (for three tenths is equal to thirty hundredths). 

The principle of the ordinary system of numeration 
will now be apparent. 

7. The English names which are employed in the 
system of Numeration which is universally used are the 
following : one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, 
ten, eleven, twelve, thirteen, fourteen, fifteen, sixteen, seven- 



seventy, eighty, nin 


ety, 


a hundred 


which is 


a thousand 


ii (( 


a million 


a ii 


a hillion 


ii a 


a trillion 


ii a 


a quadrillion 


a a 


and so on. 





4 NUMERATION — NOTATION. [Chap. I. 

teen, eighteen, nineteen, twenty, thirty, fo^'ty, ffty, sixty, 



ten tens, 

ten hundreds, 

a thousand thousands, 

a thousand millions, 

a thousand billions, 

a thousand trillions. 



The names hillion, trillion, etc., are very rarely used. 

8. The numbers one, ten, a hundred, a thousand, ten 
thousand, a hundred thousand, a million, etc., are often 
called units of the first order, of the second order, of the 
third order, etc. ; and ten units of any order are required 
to make one unit of the next higher order. 

To give a name to any number it is sufficient to state 
the number of units of each different order that the 
number contains. 

Thus the number which is made up of three millions two hun- 
dreds-of-thousands three tens- of -thousands four thousands five hun- 
dreds seven tens six units two tenths and four hundredths is called 
three million tico hundred thirty-four thousand Jive hundred 
seventy-six and twenty-four hundredths ; also the number which is 
made up of two hundreds-of-millions three tens-of-millions two 
tens-of-thousands three thousands and five hundreds is called two 
hundred thiHy million twenty-three thousand five hundred. 

It should be remarked that the parts of a number are 
mentioned in the order of their magnitude, the largest 
being given first; in English, however, this order is 
reversed for the numbers between ten and twenty. It 
should also be noticed that all the thousands, all the mil- 
lions, all the billions, etc., are grouped together, as in the 
above two cases. 



Akts. 8-11.] NOTATION. 6 

9. The system of numeration described above is called 
the Decimal system, since ten units of any order are 
required to make up one unit of the next higher order. 

The decimal system of numeration is employed by all 
people who have any names at all for numbers greater 
than ten, and the origin of the system was doubtless the 
natural habit of counting on the fingers. 

Notation. 

10. We have now to show how numbers can be repre- 
sented in a simple manner by means of a few symbols 
cdlled figures or digits. 

The method by which numbers are expressed by means 
of symbols according to some systematic plan is called 
Notation. . 

11. The first nine numbers in order are represented 

by the symbols 

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9. 

The same figures are also employed to represent the 
fii'st nine collections of tens, of hundreds, of thousands, 
etc., but on the understanding that the figures are to be 
written in a row, and that the figure which represents 
the units of the highest order named in a number is to 
be written as the left-hand figure of the row; while 
the figure which represents the units of the lowest order 
named is to be written as the right-hand figure. Thus, 
<*^2/ fig'i^re placed just to the right of another represents 
units of the order next below t!tat represented by the 
other. 

To distinguish the figures which represent units, tens, 
hundreds, etc., from those which represent tenths, hun- 
dredths, etc., a dot, called the Decimal Point, must be 



[ 

I 



6 NUMERATION — NOTATION. [Chap. I. 

written between the figures which represent units and 
tenths. 

Forty-five is written 46. 

Four hundred seventy-two is written 472. 

Three and two-tenths is written 3.2 

Fifty-one and twenty-seven hundredths is written 61.27 

Thirty-five hundredths is written .36 

12. The decimal point serves to separate the figures 
which represent the wholes from those which represent 
the tenths, hundredths, etc. That part of the number 
to the left of the decimal point is called the Integral part ; 
that part to the right is called the Decimal part. 

In 2.6, the 2 is integral, and the .6 is decimal ; in 46.627, the 46 
is integral, and the .627 is decimal. 

The decimal point is omitted, if the number contains 
no decimal. 

13. Besides the nine symbols already specified, it is 
necessary to have an additional symbol to meet the case 
when units of one or more of the different orders are 
absent. This symbol is ; its name is nanght or cipher. 
It has no value by itself, and is used to indicate that 
there are no units of the particular order corresponding 
to the place in which it occurs. 

The other figures are sometimes distinguished from 
the naught by being called significant figures. 

Thus, 20 represents two tens and no ones; that is, the num- 
ber twenty. Again, 2006 represents two thousands^ no hundreds, 
no tenSy and five ones; that is, the number two thousand five, the 
naughts serving to bring the significant figures into the places 
intended for them. 

It should be noticed that a naught placed at the beginning of 
an integral number, or at the end of a decimal number, does not 
affect the value of the number ; 066, .7020, 0102.60 are the same 
as 66, .702, 102.6. 



Arts. 12-15.] 



NOTATION. 



14. Any figure, say 5, has two values ; namely (1) its 
digit value, which is indicated by its shape, and in virtue 
of which it always represents jive units of some kind, 
and (2) its local value, which depends only on its place, 
and in virtue of which it represents units of the order 
which corresponds to its position in the horizontal row ; 
so that if 5 be in the first place to the left of the decimal 
point, it represents five units ; if in the second place, it 
represents five tens, and so on ; if it be in the first place 
to the right of the decimal point, it represents 5 tenths, 
and so on. 

Thus, in 46 the 6 represents five ones ; in 567, it represents five 
hundreds; in 2.35, it represents five hundredths. Again, 584.62 
represents five hundreds three tens four ones six tenths and two 
hundredths; therefore the number represented is five hundred 
thirty-four and sixty-two hundredths. 

15. The names of the units of the orders in common 
use, and the positions which correspond to them, are 
shown below : 









OB 








1 • 








1 


















^ 


09 






^ 






millions 

ins 

ons 


thousands 

lands 

sands 




sandths 
usandths 
if thousan 


onths 
iionths 
if milliontl 












• 

8 of 

tnillk 
milli 




% 


thou 
ftho 
thso 


milli 
fmll 
thso 














li'S 


ndred 

ns 

its. 

nths 
ndred 




° « s 












' ' c g:K 


■g « J2 


**c 


J«^ • 












1 • a at B 


age 


a S e £3 


B g a 


e o a . 








.c 4= a 


JZ ^ s 


f ^ a«£ JB 


• a i^ f 


a ^ f 


3d 


2d 


l8t Ist 


2d 


3d 




Period 


Period 


Period Period 


Period 


Period 






INTEGRAL PERIODS DECIMAL PERIODS 






AND ORDERS 




AND ORDERS 





It will be seen that the names are repeated in groups of three ; 
and that the decimal periods and orders correspond in name to the 
integral periods and orders. 



8 NUMERATION— NOTATION. [Chap. I. 

The first twelve integral periods are as follows : 

First, Units. Seventh, Quintillions. 

Second, Thousands. Eighth, Sextillions. 

Third, Millions. Ninth, Septillions. 

Fourth, Billions. Tenth, Octillions. 

Fifth, Trillions. Eleventh, Nonillions. 

Sixth, Quadrillions. Twelfth, Decillions. 

16. To write in figures any number expressed in words, 

it is necessary only to write the figures which represent 
the number of the units of the different orders in their 
proper places as shown above, filling up the vacant places, 
if any, with naughts. 

Thus, to write in figures the number two hundred forty-three, 
we must have 2 in the place for hundreds, 4 in the place for tens, 
and 3 in the place for units. To write in figures the number five 
hundred twenty-four thousand six hundred seven, we must have 6 
in the place for hundreds of thousands, 2 in the place for tens of 
thousands, 4 in the place for units of thousands, 6 in the place for 
hundreds, in the place for tens, and 7 in the place for units, as 
follows : 524,607. Sixteen million is written 16,000,000. To write 
in figures one thousand thirty and seven thousandths, we must 
have 1 in thousands* place, in hundreds* place, 3 in tens* place, 
in units* place, in tenths'* place, in hundredths* place, and 7 in 
thousandths' place, as follows : 1030.007. 

17. To express in words any number given in figures, 

first divide the integral and the decimal parts separately 
J into groups of three, beginning at the right in each case 

(the left-hand groupa will often be incomplete) ; begin- 
ning at the left, read each group of the integral part as if 
it were alone and give it the name of the period to which 
it belongs, then read the decimal part as if it were inte- 
gral and give it the name of the order on the right. 

For example, to express in words the number represented by 
^ 24160523, we can separate off two complete groups of three figures, 

and 24,160,523 is then read twenty-four milHon one hundred 
sixty thousand five hundred twenty-three. 



Arts. 16, 17.] EXAMPLES. 9 

To express in words the number represented by 36405.4916, 
we can separate off one complete group in the integral part and 
one in the decimal part, and 36,405.4,916 is then read thirty-six 
thousand four hundred five and four thousand nine hundred six- 
teen ten-thousandths. 

To *read off' decimals, it is, however, the common 
practice merely to name the digits in order. 

Thus .615 is read * decimal six, one, five ' ; 15.0624 is read * fifteen, 
decimal naught, five, two, four'; and 1567.0082 is read *one 
thousaiWl five hundred sixty-seven, decimal naught, naught, eight, 
two.* j 

In riading numbers the word * and ' should be used only when 
we reach a decimal point. 

EXAMPLES I. 

1. For what does 5 stand in the numbers 15, 1.57, 514, 
352167, and 3561234, respectively ? 

2. For what does 7 stand in the numbers 70, 37123, 
125.479, 274126315, and 370001002003, respectively ? 

3. Name all the figures which represent their digit 
value of hundreds in 314, 2167, 50412, and 31024. 

4. Name all the figures which represent their digit 
value of thousands in 2314, 56123, 60417, and 3005167. 

5. Express in words the separate value of every figure 
in 3.5, 15.7, 125.34, 12.53, 800.17, 1200.63, .875, 50.037, 
5.00107, 560002.19007. 

6. Express in words the numbers 27, 349, 560, 3.06, 
1204, and 5020. 

7. Express in words the numbers 200.9, 6050, 12345, 
10.305, 40050, and 1.20463. 

8. Express in words the numbers 518618, 602010, 
100010, 504075, 420040, and 107.005. 



'^I 



10 NXMEBATIOX— NOTATION. [Chap. I. 

9. Express in words 111111111, 120^405, 2314100, 
504.0314, 2(H)rj(HHj(), and 30300074. 

10. Express in words the numbers 3012004, 1101.11011, 
201201201, 100fXJ4(>30ol01, and 604102000300004. 

11. Write in figures the numbers fifty-eight, eighty- 
five, two hundred eleven, three thousand twelve, six 
thousand forty, and nine thousand three hundred. 

Write in figures the following numbers : 

12. Twelve and three-tenths. 

13. Three hundred four and nine-tenths. 

14. Twenty-five, three-tenths, and four hundredths. 
16. Four, six-tenths, and seven-thousandths. 

16. One million, four-tenths, and three-millionths. 

17. Write in figures the numbers eleven hundred 
eleven, fourteen hundred sixty, twelve hundred thou- 
sand sixteen hundred, six million twelve hundred six- 
teen, and eleven billion eleven hundred eleven. 

18. Write in figures twenty million twenty thousand, 
seventeen million fifty thousand nineteen, one hundred 
four million six hundred two thousand eleven, and six 
thousand three hundred seven million two thousand fifty 
six. 

18. The ordinary system of notation was introduced 
into Europe by the Arabians, and is still called the Ara- 
bic fyftem of Notation although it is now known that the 
Arabians derived their knowledge from the Hindoos. 

Roman Numerals. 

19, Besides the Arabic system of notation some use 
is still made of the cumbrous system employed by the 
Komans. 



Abts. 18-22.] ROMAN NUMERALS. H 

The symbols which were used by the Romans, and 
which are called Roman Numerals, are the following : 

I for 1, V for 5, X for 10, L for 50, C for 100, D for 500, 
M for 1000. 

A horizontal line over any numeral increases its value 
one thousand fold : thus V stands for 5000, X for 10000, 
etc. 

Eoman numerals are arranged in order of magnitude 
from left to right, and are repeated as often as may be 
necessary. 

Thus, 2 is represented by II, 30 by XXX, 233 by CCXXXIII, and 
1887 by MDCCCLXXXVII. 

20. To avoid some of the troublesome repetitions 
which are common to the Roman system of notation, a 
numeral is in certain cases placed before another of 
greater value to denote that the value of the larger is to 
be diminished by the amount of the smaller. 

Thus, IV denotes one less than five, that is, 4 ; IX denotes one 
less than ten, that is, 9 ; XL denotes ten less than fifty, that is, 40 ; 
and XC denotes ten less than one hundred, that is, 90 ; so also, 
CCXC denotes 290. 

21. The symbols CIO, CCIOO, CCCIOOO, etc., were 
anciently employed to denote respectively 1000, 10,000, 
100,000 etc. ; also ID, 100, 1000, etc., to denote respect- 
ively 500, 5000, 50,000, etc. In fact, M and D are only 
modified forms of CIO and 10 respectively. 

22. Roman numerals were used only to register num- 
bers, and were never employed in making numerical 
calculations. The Romans made their calculations by 
means of counters and a mechanical apparatus called an 
Abacus. The counters used were often pebbles (Latin, 
calculus^ whence our word caiculation. 



12 NUMERATION— NOTATION. [Chaps. I., U. 

EXAMPLES II. 

1. Express all the numbers from 1 to 20 by means of 
Roman numerals. 

2. Express by means of Roman nimierals the nimi- 
bers 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 200, 400, 600, 800, 
and 900. 

3. Express by means of Roman numerals the nimibers 
39, 49, 59, 69, 79, 89, 99, 96, 444, 1294, and 1889. 

4. Write the numbers LVIII, XXXIX, XLIV, XCIV, 
XCIX, CXCIX, and MMDCCXCIX, in the Arabic 
notation. 7- 7 "^ ^"i 



Arts. 23, 24.] ADDITION. 13 



CHAPTER II. 

ADDITION — SUBTRACTION — MULTIPLICATION — 

DIVISION. 

Addition. 

23. The process of finding a single number which 
contains as many units as there are in two or more given 
numbers taken together is called Addition ; and this single 
number is called the Sum. 

The sum of the numbers of the units in two or more 
groups would therefore be found by forming a single 
group containing them all, and then counting the number 
of the units in this single group. 

24. The following fundamental truth is evident : 

The number of the things in any group will always he 
found to he the same in whatever order they may he counted. 

From this it follows that the sum of the numbers of the 
things in any two groups will be found by first counting 
all the things in the first group and then proceeding to 
the second ; that is, by increasing the numher in the first 
group by as many units as there are in the second. The 
same sum will also be found hy increasing the numher in 
the second group hy as many units as there are in the first. 

Thus, the sum of 3 and 5 is found by counting five 
onwards from three, namely four, five, six, seven, eight; 
or by counting three onwards from five, namely six, seven, 



\ 



14 ADDITION. [Chap. H. 

eight. In the first case we are said to add 5 to 3, and in 
the second case we are said to add 3 to 5 ; but the results 
must be the same. 

25. Addition is indicated by the sign +, which is read 

* plus.' 

ThuB, 5 + 4 is read five plus four, and denotes that 5 is to be 
increased by 4, that is, that 4 is to be added to 5 ; also, 5 + 4 + 3 
denotes that 4 is to be added to 5, and then 3 added to the result. 

26. The sign =, which is read ^ equals^ or ^is eqiicU to,' 
is used to denote the equality of two numbers. 

Thus, 5 + 4 = 9 denotes that the sum of 5 and 4 is 9. 

27. When children first begin to add they make use 
of their fingers, but all counting on the fingers, or with 
any other real objects, should be discontinued as soon as 
possible, and the results of adding numbers not greater 
than nine should be given instantaneously. 

Tables of the results of the addition of any two numbers 
each not greater than 10 might at first be made by the 
pupil, arranged in lines ; as for example, 8 and 1 are 9, 

8 and 2 are 10, 8 and 3 are 11, etc. 

EXAMPLES in. 
Oral 'Ezerciges. 

These examples should be practised until great rapid- 
ity is attained. 

1. Add 1 and 9, 3 and 8, 2 and 6, 4 and 7, 6 and 3, 
4 and 4. 

2. Add 7 and 8, 7 and 6, 3 and 9, 5 and 4, 3 and 5, 

9 and 8. 

3. Add 4 and 3, 9 and 9, 8 and 8, 6 and 9, 7 and 2, 
3 and 3. 



Arts. 26-28.] EXAMPLES. 16 

4. Add 5 and 9^ 9 and 4, 6 and S, 5 and 7, 2 and 9^ 

8 and 5. 

5. Add 7 and 7, 5 and 5, 6 and 6, 8 and 4, 6 and 4, 

9 and 7. 

6. Add 8 to 15, to 25, to 35, to 45, to 65, and to 95. 

7. Add 13 and 7, 23 and 7, 43 and 7, 63 and 7, 83 
and 7, 93 and 7. 

8. Add 9 to 17, to 27, to 57, to 67, to 87, and to 97. 

9. Begin with 7 and add 2 again and again up to 27. 

Do not say 7 and 2 are 9 and 2 are 11 and 2 are 13, etc., but 
state results ; thus, 7, 9, 11, 13, etc. 

10. Begin with 2 and add 3 again and again up to 35. 

11. Begin with 85 and add 4 again and again up to 
101. 

12. Begin with 50 and keep on adding sevens until 
the sum exceeds 100. 

13. Begin with 15 and keep on adding nines until the 
sum exceeds 100. 

14. Add the following numbers in order, first begin- 
ning at the right and then at the left : 

(1) 2, 7, 4, 0, 6, 9, 5, 2, 6, 5, 9, 3, 4, 8. 
State results only ; thus, 2, 9, 13, 13, 19, 28, etc. 

(2) 7, 9, 5, 4, 0, 8, 6, 7, 3, 5, 9, 8, 2, 6. 

(3) 3, 5, 6, 9, 0, 7, 8, 4, 3, 6, 2, 5, 7, 9. 

(4) 9, 6, 7, 4, 2, 8, 1, 3, 7, 5, 4, 6, 5, 8. 

28. The sum of any two numbers may be found by 
counting onwards from the first as many units as there 
are in the second, but this method would obviously be 
very troublesome except when the second number is very 
small. 



16 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

Now numbers are divided, as we have already learned, 
into groups of units, tens, hundreds, tenths, hundredths, 
etc. ; and when numbers are to be added, the parts into 
which they are divided may be added in any order we 
please, provided they are all counted; hence we may first 
add the units of one ord-er, then the units of another order, 
and so on. 

29. In order to add numbers, they should first be 
arranged so that their decimal points are in a vertical 
column. This will ensure that all the tenths shall be in 
the same vertical column, and so for the hundredths, 
etc. ; and so also for the units, tens, hundreds, etc. This 
arrangement is for convenience only. 

The following examples will show how this principle 
enables us readily to find the sum of any given numbers. 

Ex. 1. Add 236.7 and 524.2. 

Since we wish to add the tenths by themselves, the units by 
themselves, etc., we vn:ite the numbers so that the decimal points 
are in a vertical column ; thus, 

236.7 
624.2 

Now 2 tenths and 7 tenths maiiie 9 tenths, 4 units and 6 units 

make 9 units, 2 tens and 3 tens make 6 tens, and 6 hundreds and 2 

hundreds make 7 hundreds. The required sum is generally placed 

just under the numbers to be added and separated from them by a 

horizontal line ; thus, 

236.7 
624.2 

759.9 

Ex. 2. Add 648.6, 789, and 197.8. 

Write the numbers as in Ex. 1 ; thus, 

648.6 

789. 

197.8 

1636.4 



Arts. 29, 30.] EXAMPLES. 17 

Now 8 tenths and 6 tenths make 14 tenths, that is, 1 unit and 4 
tenths. The 4 tenths can be put in the column for tenths, but the 

1 unit must be counted with the other units. We then have 1 unit, 
7 units, 9 units, and 8 units, which make 25 units ; that is, 2 tens 
and 6 units. The 6 is put in the column for units, but the 2 tens 
are * carried ' (as it is called) and added with the other tens. So we 
proceed until all the columns are added. 

Note. Since ten units of any order make one unit of the next 
higher order, the figures in any column may be added without 
specifying the kind of units they represent ; that is, without call- 
ing them tens, or hundreds, or thousands, etc., as the case may be. 

Also, we should never use as many words as in the abo^e explana- 
tions, but should say (see ex. 2) only 8, 14 ; 1 (carried), 8, 17, 26 ; 

2 (carried), 11, 19, 23 ; 2 (carried), 3, 10, 16. Of course the 4, 6, 3, 
and 16 are the figures to be written. In all cases the sums of num- 
bers should be more prominent than the numbers themselves. 

30. To detect mistakes in addition it is well to add 
each line of figures twice, once from bottom to top and 
once from top to bottom. An error is much more likely 
to be detected in this way than by simply repeating the 
addition in the same order, for the same mistake is very 
likely to be made again. 

Pupils should not be allowed to add more than one 
column at a time. 

EXAMPLES IV. 
Written Hxercises. 

1. Add 3104, 297, 5649, and 989. 

Find the sum of 

2. 21.63, 5.24, 170.63, 27.59, 17. 

3. 301.7, 30.17, 3.017, .3017, .03017. 

4. 319, 562, 1230, 857, 4908, and 9087. 

6. 235, 796, 804, 987, 359, and 856. 

6. 170.2, 3.605, 17.35, 15.609, .0086. 
c 



18 



ADDITION. 



[Chj 



, XL 



7. .0037, 21.85, 169.4, 17.9375, .90087. 

8. 4.1372, 41.372, 4137.2, .41372, 41372. 

Add the numbers in eacli column and in each row of 
the equarea. Do not change the positions of the numbers. 



1 


16 


14 


4 




9 


10 


23 


12 


6 


12 


6 


7 


9 


13 


2 


10 


19 


21 


8 


10 


11 

2 


5 
16 


20 


24 


11 


3 


7 


1^ 


3 


1 


8 


17 


25 


14 










22 


16 


4 


6 


18 



1 


101 


80 


59 


38 


17 


117 


96 


76 


64 


33 


21 


121 


80 
109 




47 


26 


5 


105 


84 


63 


42 


m 

30 
48 


9 


88 


56 


35 


14 


114 


S3 


72 


61 


18 


118 


97 


7a 


56 


23 


2 


102 


81 


60 
69 
"78 


27 





106 


85 


64 


43 


22 


111 


00 


57 


3t) 


15 


115 
3 


04 
10:) 


73 
01 


52 


31 


10 


110 


77 
86 
96 
i04 


45 
65 


24 
44 


61 


40 


19 


119 


98 
105 

lie 

4 


12 


112 


70 

79 
99 


49 


28 


7 

"io 


74 
83 


53 


32 
IT 


11 


too 


58 
67" 


37 


20 


120 


46 


26 


113 


02 


71 


50 


20 


a 


108 


87 


66 


34 


13 



■Parfonn the additions indicated below; 



2. 3157 


13. 589.761 


14. 412.64606 


-294 


35.71 


39.17412 


16903 


840,693 


246.82441 


8057 


392.75 • 


49.1733 


62934 


1569.4242 


387.198207 


998 


359.177 


129.38946 



Art. 31.] 



15. 



L.] 


EXAMPLES. 


1 


50971 


16. 


314569 


17. 842713 


8265 




73985 


9185 


13926 




387648 


38977 


78912 




930807 


796359 


34056 




186794 


246824 


19389 




389548 


135791 


8747 




153875 


924678 



In the next three examples do not change the positions 
of the numbers. 

18. Find 30.1 + 297 + 35.16 + 1079 + 8.017 + 10.053. 

19. Find 93084 + 15614 + 3801.76 + 536174 + 123456 
+ 40.404. 

20. Find 218904 + 37.215 + .199 + 582163 + 397157 
+ 81.429 + 7.9163. 

21 . Add six hundred ninety-five, one thousand seventy- 
four, eleven thousand four hundred eighty-nine, and fifty- 
four thousand three hundred seventy. 

22. Add three million four hundred seventeen thou- 
sand thirty-five, nine hundred forty-six thousand seven 
hundred, fifteen million fifteen thousand fifteen, and sixty 
million sixteen hundred twenty-four. 

23. Add six million five hundred nine thousand seven 
hundred six and twelve thousand four hundred thirty- 
two hundred-thousandths, three hundred ninety thousand 
and four hundred twelve thousandths, eighteen million 
forty and six ten-thousandths. 



31. Thus 'far we have studied numbers without refer- 
ence to objects. 

When numbers are used without reference to any 
particular units, they are called Abstract Numbers. 

Tvoo and^ve are abstract numbers. 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. XL 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Tvoofeet and^re tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
is the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the simi of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLB8 V. 
Written fxercises. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Rhode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northumberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191; and Yorkshire, 2SS6564:, What 
is the total population ? 



Abts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is, however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

6 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that the remainder is that number which, 
wlien added to the subtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, Tdll make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 5 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 5 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 5 ? 

(4) By how many is 6 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read 'minus.' 

Thus, — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
5 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 6, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



22 SUBTRACTION. [Chap. II. 

results of the subtraction of small numbers. Examples 
of subtractions of this kind should be practised until 
great rapidity is attained. 

EXAMPLES VI. 
Oral Exercises. 

1. How many are left when we take 7 from 14, 
6 from 10, 6 from 12, 8 from 12, 4 from 10, and 7 from 
16, respectively ? 

2. How many are left when we take 5 from 14, 
4 from 13, 8 from 14, 7 from 12, 9 from 11, aiid 5 from 
13, respectively ? 

Find the difference between the numbers in each of the 
following pairs : 

3. 5 and 12, 7 and 16, 9 and 18, 3 and 11, 6 and 14, 

8 and 15. 

4. 3 and 8, 5 and 11, 6 and 13, 8 and 14, 7 and 15, 

9 and 16. 

' 6. Begin with 50 and go on diminishing by fours as 
many times as possible. * 

6. Begin with 53 and go on diminishing by fives as 
i? many times as possible. 

7. Begin with 70 and go on diminishing by sixes as 
many times as possible. 

8. What must be added to 5 to make 8, to make 13, 
to make 10, to make 12 ? 

9. What must be added to 7 to make 9, to make 12, 
to make 10, to make 15 ? 

10. What must be added to 8 to make 10, to make 12, 
to make 14, to make 16 ? 



Art. 38.] 



SUBTRACTION. 



28 



Pill up the blanks below. 



11. 



9 and 
4 and 



12. 7 and 
4 and 

13. 3 and 
6 and 



make 10, 3. and 
make 11, 6 and 

make 15, 6 and 
make 9, 3 and 

make 7, 9 and 
make 15, 7 and 



make 11, 2 and 
make 9, 4 and 

make 13, 9 and 
make 8, 8 and 

make 18, 8 and 
Imake 9, 3 and 



make 8, 
make 8. 

make 12, 
make 17. 

make 16, 
ymake 6. 



38. The consideration of the following examples will 
show how the difference between any two numbers can 
be found. 

Ex. 1. Subtract 624.63 from 759.85. 

The smaller number should be placed just under the greater, so 
that one decimal point is vertically over the other. (See Art. 29.) 

759.86 
524.63 

Beginning with the lowest order, we find the remainder when 

3 hundredths are taken from 5 hundredths, 6 tenths from 8 tenths, 

4 units from 9 units, 2 tens from 5 tens, and 5 hundreds from 
7 hundreds ; thus, 

759.86 Minuend. 
524.63 Subtrahend. 

235.22 Remainder. 



Ex. 2. Subtract 35.7 /row 78.3. 

78.3 Minuend. 
35.7 Subtrahend. 

42.6 Remainder 

Now 7 tenths are more than 3 tenths, therefore we cannot sub- 
tract: if, however, we take 1 unit from the 8 units and change 
that unit to 10 tenths, we shall have 13 tenths in all. Now 7 tenths 
from 13 tenths leave 6 tenths, 5 units from 7 units leave 2 units, 
. and 3 tens from 7 tens leave 4 tens. Remainder = 42.6. 



1= 



24 SUBTRACTION. [Chap. II. 

Mental Work Illustrated. We may omit names of orders. (See 
note, Art. 20.) 

Ex. 3. 468.27 9 from 17, 8. 

180'^Q 4 from 11, 7. 

281.78 6 from 7, 1. 

8 from 16, 8. 
1 from 3, 2. 

Ex. 4. 20.07 from 7, 7. 

12.6 6 from 10, 4. 

7.47 2 from 9, 7. 

1 from 1, 0. 

In this example 1 ten is taken from 2 tens and changed to 10 
units ; one of these units is changed to ten tenths. The operation 
may be represented thus : 

20.07 =19. 10 7 

12.6 = 1 2. 6 



Remainder = 7. 4 7 

39. One concrete number cannot be subtracted from another 
unless both are expressed in terms of the same unit. For example, 
we cannot subtract 5 tons from 7 miles ; nor can we subtract 3 
feet from 60 inches, unless either 8 feet is expressed in inches or 
60 inches expressed in feet. 

40. It is easily seen that if from a given number several num- 
bers be taken in succession the result will be the same as if the 
sum of those numbers were subtracted from the given number. 

Ex. 'Subtract the sum o/366, 648, and 1^^ from 2314. 

??l3 9, 8, and 6 make 23 ; subtract the 3 from the 4 and carry 

^^ the 2 ; 2, 5, 4, and 6 make 17 ; subtract the 7 from 11 

759 and carry the 1 ; 1, 7, 6, and 3 make 17, which is to be sub- 

~54J tracted from 22. 

Mental Work. 

9, 17, 23, 3 from 4 = 1. 

2, 7, 11, 17, 7 " 11 = 4. 

1, 8, 14, 17, 17 " 22 = 6. 



Arts. 39-42.] EXAMPLES. 25 

4iL. When several operatioDS of addition and sabtraction have 
to be performed in succession the result is the same in whatever 
order the operations are performed. 

Hence, to find 28 - 15 + 26 - 17 - 14 + 12, first find the sum of 
28, 26, and 12, the numbers to be added ; then the sum of 15, 17, 
and 14, the numbers to be subtracted ; and finally taking the 
difference of these two sums ; thus, 

28 15 
26 17 
12 U 

66 - 46 = 20. 

42. To detect mistakes in subtraction, add the remain- 
der to the subtrahend, and the sum should equal the 
minuend ; or subtract the remainder from the minuend, 
and the new remainder should equal the subtrahend. 

EXAMPLES VII. 
Written Bxerclses. 

1. Subtract 129.6 from 3145, 81.7 from 3002, and 
123.4 from 432.1. 

2. Subtract 15.97 from 79.15, 18235 from 1000000, 
and 135.79 from 24680.6. 

3. Find the values of 645 - 378, 307 - 149, 294 - 
208, 2179 - 1984, 3206 - 1679, and 120573 - 98765. 

Find the difference between 

4. 3.726 and 5.949. 8. 3.008 and 3.08. 

5. 14.753 and 6.876. 9. .217 and .271. 

6. 1 and .888. 10. 20 and .675. 

7. .00013 and .00175. 11. .8017 and .00693. 

12. Find the values of 

(1) 31 + 97 - 23 + 175 - 184. 

(2) 151 - 77 + 94 - 111. 



26 SUBTRACTION. [Chap. II. 

(3) 315 - 127 - 172 + 358 - 265. 

(4) 742 - 329 - 197 + 215. 

13. Find 3.17 + 4.216 - 5.8004 + 2.0097 - .99873. 

14. Find 21.09 - 3.985 - 7.0095 + .09372 - 4.38009+ 
2.60009. 

16. Subtract from 11.214 the sum of 2.301, 1.7293, 
2.0507, and 3.62743. 

16. Subtract from 20 the sum of 3.416, 2.6008, 5.73124, 
and 1.5063. 

17. Subtract from 121097 the sum of 7916, 1214, 1397, 
and 34162. 

18. Subtract from 1000000 the sum of 421654, 127, 
31562, 1795, and 123456. 

19. Subtract 27 from 80, and then 27 from the re- 
mainder, and so on as many times as possible ; and find 
the final remainder. 

20. What number must be taken from 81 to leave 37 
as remainder ? 

21. By how much does the sum of 3.5612 and 4.71305 
exceed the sum of 1.70862 and 5.91927 ? 

22. What number must be taken from one hundred 
thousand to leave five thousand four hundred eighty- 
seven as remainder ? 

23. The difference between two numbers is 145, and 
the greater is 597 ; what is the smaller ? 

24. The sum of two numbers is 1000, and one of them 
is 594; what is the other? 

25. On a man's birthday in 1891 he was 63 years old. 
In what year was he born ? 

2iB. In 1891 a man of 65 was on his birthday just 37 
years older than his son. In what year was the son bom ? 



Arts. 43, 44.] MULTIPLICATION. 27 

27. Add the sum of 516 and 784 to the difference be- 
tween 314 and 176. 

28. Add the difference between 1925 and 1789 to the 
difference between 3421 and 1679. 

29. In an orchard there are 1572 fruit trees; of these 
352 are apple trees, 275 are pear trees, and 187 are plum 
trees. How many other trees are there ? 

30. The population of each of five towns is as fol- 
lows : A, 3789 ; B, 7861 ; C, 2893 ; D, 756 ; E, 847. If 
B and D were united, the new town would be how much 
larger than A^ C, and E together ? 

Multiplication. 

43. A short process of adding two or more equal num- 
bers is called Maltiplication. 

Ex. 1. 5 + 6 + 6 + 6 = 20 ; i.e., 4 fives = 20. 

Ex. 2. 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 = 16 ; i.e., 6 threes = 15. 

If we say (Ex. 1) 5, 10, 15, 20, or (Ex. 2) 3, 6, 9, 12, 
15, we are adding by a long process. 

If we say 4 fives = 20, or 5 threes = 15, we are adding 
by a short process called multiplication. 

44. The number which is to be thus increased is called 
the Multiplicand. 

The number which indicates how many equal numbers 
are to be added is called the Multiplier. 

The result of multiplication is called the Product. 

The multiplicand and multiplier are called Factors of 
the product. 

Ex. 1. Multiply 6 by 4. Ex. 2. Multiply 3 by 6. 

Factors of 20 1 ^ Multiplicand. 3 1 ^^^^ ^^ ^^ 

I _4 Multiplier. _6 i 

20 Product. 16 



} 



28 



MULTIPLICATION. 



[Chap. II 



45. The multiplication of any two numbers not greater 
than nine is easily found by actual addition. It will be 
shown that every case of multiplication can be reduced 
to a series of cases of multiplications of numbers not 
greater than ten; it is therefore essential to learn by 
heart all the products of such numbers. These products 
are given in the following table, called the Multiplication 
Table. 



1 

2 
3 
4 
5 
6 
7 
8 
9 
10 
11 
12 


2 

4 

6 

8 

10 

12 

14 

16 

18 

20 

22 

24 


3 

6 

9 

12 

15 

18 

21 

24 

27 

30 

33 

36 


4 

8 

12 

16 

20 

24 

28 

32 

36 

40 

44 

48 


5 

10 

15 

20 

25 

80 

35 

40 

45 

50 

55 

60 


6 

12 

18 

24 

30 

36 

42 

48 

54 

60 

66 

27 


7 

14 

21 

28 

35 

42 

49 

56 

63 

70 

77 

84 


8 

16 

24 

32 

40 

48 

56 

64 

72 

80 

88 

96 


9 

18 

27 

36 

45 

54 

63 

72 

81 

90 

99 

108 


10 

20 

30 

40 

50 

60 

70 

80 

90 

100 

110 

120 


11 

22 

33 

44 

55 

QQ 

77 

88 

99 

110 

121 

132 


12 

24 

36 

48 

60 

72 

84 

96 

108 

120 

132 

144 



Any horizontal line in the table gives the products of 
the number which begins the line by the first twelve 
numbers in order. Thus the fourth line can be read 1 
four is 4, 2 fours are 8, 3 fours axe 12, 4 fours are 16, etc. 

It is usual and desirable, though not absolutely necessary, to 
learn the Multiplication Table as far as 12 times 12. This table 



Aets. 46-47.] THEOREMS. 29 

should be made again and again by the pupil himself by actual 
addition. 

46. Multiplication is indicated by the sign x , which 
is read * multiplied by' or * times.' 

Thus, 6 X 4 is read 5 multiplied by 4, which means 4 times 5 ; 
also, 5x4x3 denotes that 5 is to be multiplied by 4, and this 
product multiplied by 3. 

When one number is multiplied by two or more other 
numbers in succession, the result is called the Continued 
Product. 

47. Before considering how to find the product of any 
two numbers, certain general truths, which hold good for 
all numbers whatever, must be investigated. Por this 
purpose consider the following arrangement of dots : 



The total number of the dots is independent of the way 
in which they are counted. 

Now there are 10 dots in each row and 5 rows ; the 
whole number of the dots can therefore be counted as 10 
repeated 5 times, or 5 repeated 10 times ; i.e., 10 x 5 
= 5 X 10. It is clear that this result would hold good 
however many rows and columns there might be ; thus 
we are led to 

Theorem I. The product of any number by any second 
number is the same as the product of the second by the 
first. 



■ r 

r 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and five tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
is the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the simi of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written fxercises. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Rhode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northumberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Abts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is, however, impossible to 
subtract oue number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

5 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that tJie remainder is that number which, 
wlien added to the subtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 6 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 5 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 5 ? 

(4) By how many is 5 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read 'minus.' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
6 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 6, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and five tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
is the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the sum of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written fxerolses. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Ehode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northumberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Arts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is» however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

5 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that tlie remainder is that number which, 
when added to the subtraJiend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 6 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 6 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 6 ? 

(4) By how many is 6 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read * minus.' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
5 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 5, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and five tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
is the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the sum of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written fxerolses. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Ehode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northumberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Arts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is» however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

6 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that the remainder is that number which, 
when added to the subtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 6 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 6 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 6 ? 

(4) By how many is 6 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read * minus.' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
5 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 5, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and five tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
18 the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the sum of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written fxerolses. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Ehode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northuzaberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191 ; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Arts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is» however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

6 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that the remainder is that number which, 
when added to the subtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 6 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 6 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 6 ? 

(4) By how many is 6 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read * minus.' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
6 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 5, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and^t?e tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
is the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the sum of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written fxerolses. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Ehode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northumberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Arts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder, 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is» however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

6 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that the remainder is that number which, 
when added to the sxcbtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 5 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 6 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 6 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 6 ? 

(4) By how many is 6 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 
read * minus. ' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
6 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 5, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



20 ADDITION. [Chap. II. 

When numbers are associated with particular units, 
they are called Concrete Numbers. 

Two feet and five tons are concrete numbers. 

32. Concrete numbers can be added only when the unit 
18 the same. For example, 3 horses and 4 cows do not 
make 7 horses noj* 7 cows ; they do, however, make 7 
animals; because regarding them as animals the unit is 
the same. Also the sum of 3 feet and 4 inches is not 7 
feet nor 7 inches. 

EXAMPLES V. 
Written £xerclse8. 

1. In 1890 the population of each of the New England 
States was as follows : Maine, 661000 ; New Hampshire, 
377000; Vermont, 332000; Massachusetts, 2239000; 
Ehode Island, 346000 ; Connecticut, 746000. What was 
the total ? 

2. In a town, noted for the number of its schools, 
there were 225 boys in a military school, 175 girls in a 
school for girls, 126 young men in a theological school, 
163 boys in a training school, 23 children in a kinder- 
garten, and 1500 pupils in the public schools. How many 
pupils in all ? 

3. A man paid 527.37 dollars for 14 cows, 1463.80 
dollars for twelve horses, and 918.36 dollars for 153 pigs. 
How many animals were there, and how much was paid 
for them all ? 

4. The population of each of the six northern counties 
of England is as follows : Cumberland, 250647 ; Durham, 
867258 ; Lancashire, 3454441 ; Northuzaberland, 434086 ; 
Westmoreland, 64191 ; and Yorkshire, 2886564. What 
is the total population ? 



Arts. 32-37.] . SUBTRACTION. 21 

Subtraction. 

33. The process of finding how many units are left 
when a number is taken away from a larger number is 
called Subtraction. The result is called the Remainder^ 
or the Difference. 

Any two numbers can be added ; it is» however, impossible to 
subtract one number from a smaller number. 

34. The larger of the two numbers is called the 
Minuend. 

The smaller of the two numbers is called the Sub- 
trahend. 

Illustration. 8 Minuend. 

6 Subtrahend. 

3 Remainder. 

35. It is clear that the remainder is that number whicfi, 
when added to the subtrahend, will give the minuend. 

Thus, to subtract 6 from 12 is to find the number which, when 
added to 5, will make 12. 

The question involved in subtraction may be put in different 
ways. Thus, it may be asked : 

(1) What is the remainder when 5 is taken from 12 ? 

(2) What must be added to 6 to make 12 ? 

(3) By how many is 12 greater than 6 ? 

(4) By how many is 5 less than 12 ? 

36. Subtraction is indicated by the sign — , which is 

read * minus.' 

Thus, 9 — 4 is read nine minus four, and denotes that 9 is to be 
diminished by 4, that is, that 4 is to be subtracted from 9 ; also, 
5 — 4 + 3 denotes that 4 is to be taken from 6, and then 3 added 
to the result. 

37. The knowledge of the results of the addition of 
numbers not greater than ten will furnish us with the 



42 DIVISION. [Chap. II. 

the dividend, or else the divisor is a quantity of the same 
nature as the dividend, and the quotient is an abstract 
number. 

60. Division is indicated by the sign -5-, which is read, 
' divided by,' or, < by.' 

Thus, 24 -T- 4 is read 24 divided by 4, and denotes that 24 is to be 
divided by 4 ; also, 24-7-4-4-3 denotes that 24 is to be divided by 
4 and the result divided by 3, and 24 -7- 4 x 3 denotes that 24 is to 
be divided by 4 and the result multiplied by 3. 

61. Inexact Division. If we try to divide 14 by 4, we 
find that after subtracting 3 fours there are 2 units left. 

The number left over is called the Remainder. 
One number is said to be exactly divisible by another 
when it is divisible without remainder. 

62. It follows from the definition of division that the 
product of the divisor and the quotient plus the remainder 
is equal to the dividend; that is. 

Divisor x Quotient + Eemainder = Dividend. 

Hence, if any three of these four numbers be given, the 
remaining one can be found. 

Ex. 1. The divisor is 6, the quotient is 20, and the remainder 
is 2. What is the dividend? 

The dividend must exceed the product of the divisor and quotient 

by 2. Hence, 

Dividend = 5 x 20 -f 2 = 102. 

Ex. 2. The dividend is 69, the quotient 7, and the remainder 3. 
What is the divisor? 

The dividend must exceed the product of the quotient and divisor 
by 3. Hence, the product of the quotient and divisor is 69 — 3 = 56, 
and the divisor = 66 -?- 7 = 8. 

63. Division could always be performed by successive 
subtractions of the divisor, as in Art. 6^ j but, except in 



Arts. 60-64.] DIVISION BY 10, ETC. 43 

the case of very small numbers, the process would be 
extremely tedious, and the necessity for these successive 
subtractions is obviated by a knowledge of the results of 
multiplication. 

For example, to divide 76 by 9. 

Since we know that 8 nines are 72, and that 9 nines are 81, we 
see that 76 -f- 9 gives 8 for quotient and 3 for remainder. 

EXAMPLBS XII. 
Oral Exercises. 

Give the quotient in each of the following cases, and 
the remainder whenever the division is not exact : 





1. 


12^4. 


11. 


64^8. 


21. 


80 -J- 9. 




2. 


18 -s- 9. 


12. 


45^9. 


22. 


66^9. 




3. 


35-7. 


13. 


15-^4. 


23. 


63-5-7. 




4. 


56^8. 


14. 


17 H- 5. 


24. 


48-5-5. 




5. 


60 -!- 10. 


15. 


18-^7. 


25. 


92^9. 




6. 


49 -s- 7. 


16. 


17-4-3. • 


26. 


87^8. 




7. 


81^9. 


17. 


37 H- 9. 


27. 


80-^7. 




8. 


72 -s- 8. 


18. 


43-^5. 


28. 


63-^5. 


I 


9. 


56^7. 


19. 


68^7. 


29. 


70-5-6. 




10. 


36 -i- 6. 


20. 


70 -i- 8. 


30. 


100^9. 



64. Division by 10, 100, etc. To divide any number 
by 10, it is necessary only to move the decimal point one 
place to the left. For this divides each of the parts of 
the number by 10. 

For example, 623.4 (see ex.. Art. 48) is divided by 10 when its 
6 hundreds are made 6 tens, its 2 tens are made 2 units, its 3 units 
are made 3 tenths, and its 4 tenths are made 4 hundredths ; t'.e., 
623.4 -- 10 = 62.34. 

Also, 62.34 -5- 10 = 6.234 ; 6.234 -f- 10 = .6234. 



44 DIVISION. [Chap. II. 

Dividing by 10 and by 10 again is the same as divid- 
ing by 100, and it will be noticed that in dividing 623.4 
by 100 the decimal point is moved two places to the left. 

Hence, to divide by 10, 100, 1000, etc., move the decimal 
point as many places to the left as there are naughts in the 
divisor. 

Examples. 1. 268706-^10 =26870.6. 

2. 46000 -r 100 = 460. 

3. 26783 -^ 1000 = 26.783. 

65. Short Division. — When the divisor is not greater 
than 12, the process of division can be written in a 
very compact form. The method will be seen from the 
following example : 

Ex. Divide 43261 by 8. 

The operation is set down in the following form : 

8 ) 43251 

5406, remainder 3. 

Explanation. First, 43 -;- 8 gives quotient 5 and remainder 3 ; 
we put 5 under the 3 of the dividend, as the 5 represents units of 
the same order as the 3 (namely, thousands^ in the present case). 
Then, the remainder 3 is equal to 30 units of the next lower order, 
and taking into account the next figure of the dividend, namely 2, 
we have 32 which when divided by 8 gives quotient 4 and 
remainder ; we put down 4 next to 5, and have nothing to * carry.' 
Then, 5 -f- 8 gives quotient and remainder 5 ; we put down next 
to 4 and * carry ' 5. The 5 carried and 1, the next figure of the 
dividend, make 51 which when divided by 8 gives quotient 6 and 
^mainder 3. Thus, the complete quotient is 5406 with remainder 3. 

EXAMPLES XIII. 
Written Exercises. 

Divide 

1. 92 by 4. 3. 75 by 5. 5. 7.85 by 5. 

2. 87 by 3. 4. 234 by 6. 6. 91.8 by 9. 



Arts. 66, 66.] 



LONG DIVISION. 



45 



7. 72.15 by 5. 11. 7568 by 11. 15. 823507 by 8. 

8. 6.402 by 6. 12. 35.628 by 12. 16. 2104316 by 6. 

9. .3564 by 9. 13. 72156 by 9. 17. 123456 by 7. 
10. 6822 by 12. 14. 346089 by 7. 18. 987654 by 9. 

19. 563753696 by 11. 20. 1374819756 by 12. 

Divide without uniting the terms of the dividend 

21. (8 -t- 14 -t- 6) by 2. 

22. (6x2 + 15x5) by 3. 

23. (14 X 3 -t- 21 X 5) by 7. 

24. (18 X 4 4- 33 X 12) by 3, and the result by 2. 

66. Long Division. — When the divisor is greater than 
12 the process of division is written in a long form so 
that the mind will not become confused. 



Ex. 1. Divide 1026 by 18. 

18)1026(57 
90 

126 
126 



The full operation may be 
thus expressed : 

18)1026(60 + 7 
900 

126 
126 



First, beginning at the left, we use the smallest part of the number 
that can be divided by 18. Now, neither 1 nor 10 can be divided 
by 18, but 102 can be. 102 ~ 18 = 6, with a remainder of 12. The 
quotient 5 is of the same order as the last figure of the dividend 
used in the first division (just as in short division). The remainder 
12 we reduce to units of the next lower order and add the 6 of that 
order, and we have 126 to be divided by 18. Now 126 -*- 18 = 7. 

Ex.2. Divide 1027S9 btf 29. 



29)102739(^642 
87 



167 
146 

123 
116 



79 
68 

21 remainder. 



The last figure of the dividend used in 
the first division is 2, and in thousands' 
place. Therefore the first quotient figure 
obtained is thousands'. 



46 DIVISION. [Chap. IL 

Ex. 3. Divide 44303 by 146. 

lu this example, the first remainder (8 

iAfi^A4&7^n« hundreds) reduced to tens and the 9 tens 

^^3g ^ added makes 89 tens, which does not con- 

ggg tain 146. Therefore there are no tens in 

870 the answer and we write a naught, and 

23 remainder, proceed by reducing the 89 tens to unite, 

adding 3 units. 

T? A 9Mfti ^^® same reasoning applies for a deci- 

^ mal dividend as for an integral dividend. 

The first figure obtained in the quotient is 

of the same order as the last figure used in the first division. 

This fact determines the position of the decimal point. 

Ex. 6. Ex. 6. Divide .019 by 126. 

QN 233 

"^ 126).019600(.000i52 

126 

650 
625 



250 
250 



Ex. 7. 

48)5.220(.108 
A. a 

— 2oo "^^ remainder is the same in name as the last 

384 figure of the dividend. In this case it is .036. 

~36 

Ex. 8. 

15)474000(31600 In this example, it is unnecessary to extend 

i^ the written work beyond dividing 90 hun- 

^* dreds by 16. Since, however, every order of 

-^ the dividend must have a corresponding figure 

QQ in the quotient, we write naughts in tens' and 

imits' places. 



67. To divide, when the divisor is partly or wholly a 
decimal. 



Abt. 67.] DIVISION BY A DECIMAL. 47 

Here we make use of the following principle : 

Multiplying both dividend and divisor by the same num- 
ber does not change the quotient. 

Thus, 24 -T- 4 = 6, and if both 24 and 4 be multiplied by 2, we 
shall have 48 -^ 8 = 6 ; also, 3.6 -^ .6 = 6, and if both 3.6 and .6 
be multiplied by 10, we shall have 36 -r- 6 = 6. 

Hence, to divide any number by a decimal, we first 
multiply both dividend and divisor by that power of 10 
which will make the divisor a whole number, and then pro- 
ceed as in the case of division by a whole number. We 
perform these multiplications by moving the decimal 
points. 

Ex. 1. Divide 11.68 by 1.6 

Move the decimal points one place to the right. Then 

1.6J11.68(7.8 
112 

48 
£8 

Do not forget that the first significant figure of the quo- 
tient is of the same order as the last of those figures of the 
dividend which are used in the first division. This will 
indicate the position of the decimal point in the quotient. 

Ex. 2. Divide .21 by .0126 Ex. 3. Divide .0697585 by 1.33. 
.0125J.21(56^.8 1.33J.06,97585(.05245 

100 ^^ 

mo 532 

666 

665 

Note. Always let the old decimal point remain, and indicate 
the new one by a mark similar to those in Ex. 1. 



48 DIVISION. [Chap. U, 

68i Note. It shonld be noticed that, although the quotient is 
anchanged by multiplying both dividend and divisor by the same 
number, the remainder, if any, is not unchanged, but is equal to 
the original remainder multiplied by the number by which the 
original divisor and dividend were multiplied. 

For example, 26 -^ 6 = 4, with a remainder of 2 ; and 8 times 26 
divided by 8 times 6 equals 4, with a remainder of 8 times 2. 
Therefore, we must divide the remainder by the multiplier, if we 
wish the remainder obtained by using the original numbers, as the 
remainder is the part of dividend not used. 

Ex. 1. Divide 17.8 by 1.4. 



1.4J17.^ 

14 The remainder would have been 1 

3 8 unit if we had not multiplied by 10. 

28 

Remainder 1 units. 

Ex. 2. How many pieces each 1.02 inches long can be cut from 
a rod whose length is 18 inches f 

We can find the quotient by dividing 1800 by 102. Thus 

102)1800(17 
102 

780 
714 

Hence there are 17 pieces ; and since the original divisor and 
dividend were multiplied by 100, the remainder left over is 

(66 -J- 100) inches = M inches. 

69. Division by Factors. — We have seen that to multi- 
ply by two or more numbers in succession gives the same 
result as to multiply at once by their product. It there- 
fore follows, conversely, that to divide by two or more 
numbers in succession gives the same result as to divide 
at once by the product of the numbers. 



Arts. 68-70.] BY FACTORS. 49 

Ex. 1. Divide 11445 by 85. 

Since 35 = 7 x 5, we may divide by 7 and 5 in succession. 

7 )11445 
5 )1635 
327 
Ex. 2. To divide 315637 by 20. 

2 0)31563J 

15781, remainder 17. 

Dividing both dividend and divisor by 10, as indicated, we have 
31563 to be divided by 2. The quotient is 15731 and the remainder 
1, which must be multiplied by 10 and the figure cut o£E by the 
decimal point annexed, making 17 as the true remainder. 

70. When one number is divided by several others in 
succession, the method of finding the remainder will be 
seen from the following example : 

Ex. 1. Divide 11467 by 35. 

7 )11467 
5 ) 1638 sevens and 1 unit over. 

327 thirty-fives and 3 sevens over. 

The whole remainder is therefore 3 sevens and 1 unit, that is, 22. 

From the above it will be seen that the whole remain- 
der is found by multiplying the remainder after the second 
division by the first divisor and then adding the remainder 
after the first division, 

Ex. 2. Divide 251633 6y 3 x 5 x 7. 

3 )251633 
5 )83877 groups of 3 each and 2 units over. 
7)16775 groups of 3 x 5 each and 2 groups of 3 each over. 
2396 groups of 3 x 5 x 7 each and 3 groups of 3 x 5 each over. 

The whole remainder is therefore 3 groups of 3 x 5 each + 2 
groups of 3 each +2 =3x3x5 + 2x3 + 2 = 45 + 6 + 2 = 53. 

Thus, if there are more than two successive divisions the whole 
remainder is found by multiplying each remainder by all the di- 
visors preceding that from which the remainder arises, and then 
adding these results to the first remainder. 

B 



60 DIVISION. [Chap. IL 

71. The work of finding some products may be short- 
ened by making use of multiplication and division at the 
same time. 

Ex. 1. Multiply 6174 by 25. 

Since 25 = 100 -¥■ 4, we shall multiply by 25 if we first multiply 
by 100 and then divide by 4. For by multiplying by 100 we get 4 
times too much, which is put right when we divide by 4. To mul- 
tiply by 25 we may therefore affix two naughts and divide by 4 ; 

thus, 

4 )617400 

154360 

Ex. 2. Multiply 6174 by 125. 

Since 125 = 1000 -h 8, we multiply by 1000 and then divide by 8, 
that is, we affix three naughts and divide by 8 ; thus, 

8 )6174000 
771750 

The methods adopted iu the following examples are also worth 
notice. 

Ex. 3. Multiply 7964 by 9098. 

Since 9998 = 10000 - 2, we can multiply by 10000 and by 2, and 
take the difference of these products. 

7964 
9998 



79640000 
15928 



79624072 

Ex. 4. Multiply 7.964 by 9998. 

7.964 , 
9998 



79640. 
16.928 

79624.072 

72. To test the answer in division, multiply the quo- 
tient by the divisor (not divisor by quotient), and to the 
])roduet add the remainder (if any); the result should 
equal the dividend. [Art. 58.] 



Arts. 71-73.] EXAMPLES. 51 

73. Some saving of time in division will be effected by- 
performing the multiplication of the divisor and the sub- 
traction from the dividend simultaneously ; this method 
should, however, be attempted only by those who show 
some aptitude for numerical calculations, for the slight 
gain in speed by no means makes up for the increased 
liability to error. 

The method will be understood from the following 
example : 

mvide 102739 by 29. 

29)102739(3542 

167 

123 

79 

21 rem. 

Explanation. Instead of multiplying 29 by 3 and subtracting 
the whole product from 102, we subtract the several figures of the 
product as we go along. Thus, 3 times 9 are 27, and 7 from 12 
leaves 5 ; we write 5, and carry 3 (2 from the 27, and 1 from the 
12). Then, 3 times 2 are 6, and 3 (carried) are 9, and 9 from 10 
leaves 1. The remainder is 16, which with the 7 of the dividend 
makes 157 for the next partial dividend. And so on to the end. 

EXAMPLES XIV. 
Written ESxeroites. 

a. 

Divide 

1. 182 by 13. 4. 399 by 19. 7. 702 by 26. 

2. 204 by 17. 5. 575 by 23. 8. 1054 by 34. 

3. 221 by 17. 6. 899 by 29. 9. 4185 by 31. 

10. 1591 by 37. 14. 430686 by 71. 

11. 6016 by 94. 15. 415242 by 59. 

12. 710007 by 87. 16. 426713 by 47. 

13. 435435 by 66. 17. 562171 by 53. 



52 DIVISION. [Chap. II. 

18. 850902 by 78. 26. 21112 by 104. 

19. 1173021 by 97. 27. 185745 by 305. 

20. 1034550 by 95. 28. 801738 by 567. 

21. 2706420 by 86. 29. 8035370 by 2674. 

22. 11336 by 109. 30. 9570744 by 1593. 

23. 22563 by 207. 31. 407514744 by 6724. 

24. 160335 by 315. 32. 31587678 by 5067. 

25. 39483 by 123. 33. 266 4- 126 4- 210 by 14. 

34. 6164 4- 5226 by 67. 

35. The trees in an orchard are arranged in 153 rows, 
with the same number of trees in each row, and there 
are 16371 trees altogether. How many trees are there 
in each row ? 

36. There are 86400 seconds in a day; in how many 
days are there 13664800 seconds ? 

b. 

In division of decimals, the quotient should be continued until 
there is no remainder, unless otherwise directed. This can be 
accomplished by annexing naughts to the dividend, as in Ex. 6, 
Art. 06, In general practice three or four decimal places in the 
quotient are considered sufficient. 

Divide 

1. 16.4 by 2. 3. 17.2 by 4. 5. .288 by 9. 

2. 32.7 by 3. 4. .156 by 6. 6. .135 by 9. 

7. 125.6 by 20. 13. 5.22 by 48. 

8. 31.83 by 30. 14. .171 by 72. 

9. 11.7215 by 50. 15. .012 by 1600. 

10. 215.4 by 80. 16. .027 by 45. 

11. .0321 by 60. 17. 2.355 by 75. 

12. .174 by 120. 18. 2.715 by 48. 



IT. 7 


8.] 


EXAMPLES. 


19. 


52.7 by 17. 


26. 


67.77 by 135. 


20. 


43.7 by 23. 


27. 


.006777 by 1350. 


21. 


166.6 by 119. 


28. 


1.036656 by 207. 


22. 


3751.5 by 123. 


29. 




.1036656 by 5008. 


23. 


3.7515 by 1230. 


30. 


.001036656 by 2070 


24. 


375.15 by 125. 


31. 


.651714 by 3156. 


26. 


37.515 by 1250. 







68 



Find, to 4 places of decimals, 

32. 12.15^148. 36. 135^-17. 

33. 2.374^156. 36. 17^135. 

34. 41.75-^89. 37. 121^-170. 

38. Simplify .026 x .0493 -s- 221. 



Divide 

1. 6.2 by .01. 

2. .347 by .001. 

3. 12.3 by .0001. 

4. 3.5 by .5. 

5. .75 by .05. 

6. 1.25 by .005. 

7. 62.5 by 2.5. 

8. ,625 by .025. 

9. 625 by .0025. 

10. 1.1 by .125. 

11. .019 by 1.25. 

12. 170 by .00125. 

25. Find, to 4 places 
.0167 -*- 3.17, 



c. 



13. 1.5 by 2.4. 

14. 5.76 by 4.8. 

15. 8.1 by .36. 

16. 159.1 by 3.7. 

17. 6.016 by .94. 

18. 70.992 by 8.7. 

19 .435435 by .0065. 

20. 430.686 by .0071. 

21. 415.242 by .0059. 

22. .185745 by 3.05. 

23. 4.07514744 by .006724. 

24. .9570744 by 159.3. 

of decimals, 43.21 -f- 123.4, and 



64 DIVISION. [Chap. IL 

26. Simplify 360 -!- 7.2 -*- .16. 

27. Simplify .0441 -^ .21 H- .56. 

28. Simplify 1.953 -i- 8.68 x .035. 

29. How many lengths each 2.56 inches are there in a 
rod 120 inches long ; and how much is left over ? 

30. How many packets of tea, each containing 1.85 
ounces, can be made up out of a chest containing 2400 
ounces ; and how much is left over ? 

Divide, using factors not greater than 12, 

1. 396 by 18. 3. 625 by 25. 5. 8820 by 36. 

2. 816 by 24. 4. 3753 by 27 6. 15750 by 42. 

7. 1958528 by 64. 18. 21574 by 20, 40, and 60. 

8. 59081805 by 81. 19. 123456 by 20, 30, and 40. 

9. 13339728 by 108. 20. 158937 by 20, 50, and 70. 

10. 10654069140 by 132. 21. 2167 by 30, and 50. 

11. 316794 by 45. 22. 16819 by 30, and 80. 

12. 7196243 by 35. 23, 17943 by 40, and 60. 

13. 2106935 by 36. 24. 21985 by 50, and 90. 

14. 9172143 by 72. 25. 217943 by 500. 

15. 22222222 by 99. 26. 712415 by 700. 

16. 123456789 by 132. 27. 217643 by 216. 

17. 32163 by 20, 30, and 40. 28. 1234567 by 242. 

e. 

Multiply, using the short process, 

1. 74562 by 25. 4. 387.4 by 126. 

2. 4.162 by 26. 5. 79.624 by 99. 

3. 12678 by 126. 6. 1897 by 999. 



Akt. 73.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 66 

7. 29075 by 998. 10. .6003 by 12.6. 

8. .79184 by 9999. 11. 786 by 250. 

9. 6729 by 12.5. 12. 34.65 by .0125. 

EXAMPLES XV. 
Mlscellaneoas Examples, Chapters I and II. 

1. Express in words 3015602, and in figures eleven 
million five hundred thousand two hundred fourteen. 

. 2. Find the sum of 30157, 12.468, 31947, and 3.6539. 

3. By how many is 13018 greater than 12997? 

4. Multiply 8000 by 1250, and 3200 by 12345. 

5. How many times can 317 be subtracted from 1389, 
and what is the remainder ? 



6. Express MDCCCLXXIX in the Arabic notation, 
and 1449 by means of Roman numerals. 

7. Find 1325 + 3016 4-79 + 90167. 

^. Find 316 - 179 + 257 - 89 - 185 + 398 - 485. 
9. Multiply 1234 by 4321 and 9009 by 31562. 

10. How many nineteens are there in five thousand, 
and how many are over ? 

11. By how much does the sum oj^.72 and 10.015 fall 
short of the sum of 7.216 and 6.52 ?' 




12. Express in words 163205J and 3004167201500. 

13. Subtract the sum of 3158, 2016, and 5143 from 
11111. 

14. Multiply the difference between seventy-six mil- 
lion seventy-six and four hundred forty thousand four 
hundred forty, by eleven hundred fourteen. 



66 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chap. II. 

15. A farmer has 197 sheep and three times as many 
lambs. How many sheep and lambs has he altogether ? 

16. Find by short divisions how many thirty-fives 
there are in 31578, and how many are over. 

17. Add 31.057, 156.0083, 2.61759, and .008347. 

18. Subtract the difference between 3.14 and 1.0625 
from the sum of 1.00172 and 2.127. 



19. By how many is one million eight thousand nine 
hundred seventy-four less than two million eleven hun- 
dred twelve ? 

20. Find 3142 - 1250 - 989 + 6217 - 3587 - 1924. 

21. A farmer had 2000 bags of wheat. He sold 527 
bags to one man and 255 bags to each of three others. 
How many bags were left unsold ? 

22. How many letters are there in a book of 375 
pages, each page of which contains 32 lines, and each line 
45 letters ? 

23. Multiply 31.025 by .032, and .0625 by .00125. 

24. By what number must 59755 be divided in order 
that the quotient may be 19? 

25. Divide 7.0175 by 17.6, and 7.6 by .00625. 



26. In one school there are one hundred seventy-six 
boys and one hundred and twelve girls ; and in another 
school there are half as many boys and twice as many 
girls. How many scholars altogether are there in the 
two schools ? 

27. The sum of two numbers is 317205 and one of 
them is 185964; what is the other? 



Art. 73.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 67 

28. A farmer sold 75 cattle at 24 dollars a head and 
bought with the money sheep at 2 dollars each. How 
many sheep did he buy ? 

29. Divide .04312 by .0044, and 9.0226 by .226. 

30. Divide 358 by 15 by short divisions. 

31. What is the least number which must be added to 
57914 in order that the sum may be exactly divisible by 
315? 

32. Divide the product of 37.5 and .1248 by .005625. 



33. Express MDCCCXCIV in the Arabic notation, and 
2875 by means of Roman numerals. 

34. In a school of four hundred and ninety children 
there are two hundred and seventy-six girls. How many 
more girls than boys are there ? 

35. In a train there are 37 cars each having seats for 
36 people, and there are 375 passengers in the train ; how 
many seats are empty?' 

36. Simplify 1.702 x 2.9015 ^ .0005803. 

37. Divide the product of .0374 and .0075 by the dif- 
ference between .675 and .6375. 

38. Show that the sum of the squares of three thousand 
nine, and four thousand twelve, is equal to the square of 
five thousand fifteen. 

39. What is the least number which must be subtracted 
from 2146537 in order that the remainder may be exactly 
divisible by 4275 ? 



40. Subtract nine hundred five million eight thousand 
nine hundred sixty-five from eleven hundred million two 
thousand three hundred, and express the result in words. 



58 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chapb. IL, IIL 

41. At an election, the successful candidate, who ob- 
tained 12597 votes, had a majority of 1479 over the un- 
successful candidate. How many votes were given 
altogether? 

42. Find 2197-1982 + 374 4-10085-8216 4-11597 
- 7986. 

43. Find the squares of 2.15 and .0324. 

44. Multiply 16777216 by 131072, also divide 16777216 
by 131072, and express the results in words. 

45. Find the least number of repetitions of 3745 whose 
sum is greater than a million. 

46. Divide .378 by 262.5, and 37.8 by .02625. 



47. Express the numbers 29, 47, 158, 679, 1464, and 
10385 by means of Roman numerals. 

48. How many figures are there in all the numbers 
from 1 to 100 ? How many in the numbers from 1 to 
1000? 

49. A certain number when divided by 3008 gives a 
quotient 3875 and a remainder 2794. What is the 
number ? 

50. Divide 999999 by the continued product of 3, 7, 
11, and 13. 

51. The sum of two numbers is 315642, and one of the 
numbers is twice the other : find them. 

52. Divide 2722.05 by .345, and .0272205 by 3.45. 

53. Divide (144.4 4-152x4.6) by 19; prove your 
answer by dividing after uniting the terms of the 
dividend. 

54. Divide, by factors, (6.3 x 6 4- 4.9 x 18) by 21. 
See Art. 44 for definition of factors. 



Arts. 74, 75.] FACTORS. 69 



CHAPTER III. 

FACTORS AND MULTIPLES — SQUARE ROOT — HIGHEST 
COMMON FACTOR — LEAST COMMON MULTIPLE. 

Factors. 

74. An exact divisor of a number is called a Factor 
of that number ; thus, 

2, 3, 4, 6, and 12 are factors of 24. [Art. 44.] 

A factor is also called a Measure. 

A number that is exactly divisible by another number 

is called a Multiple of that number ; thus, 

12, 30, 54, 72, and 90 are multiples of 6. 

It will be seen at once that a number has a limited number of 
factors, but an unlimited number of multiples. 

75. A number which is not divisible by any number 
except itself and 1 is called a Prime Number, or a Prime. 

Thus, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc., nxe primes. 

Every number which has other factors beside itself 
and unity is called a Composite number. 
Thus, 4, 6, 8, 9, etc., are composite numbers. 

Two numbers, both of which cannot be divided by the 
same number (except unity), are said to be prime to one 
another. 

Thus, 4 and 9 are prime to one another; both, however, are 
composite numbers. 



60 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

76. Numbers divisible by 2 are called Even numbers. 
Numbers not divisible by 2 are called Odd numbers. 

2, 14, 30, and 74 are even numbers. 

3, 7, 27, and 51 are odd numbers. 

The following simple conditions of divisibility will be 
found to be useful : 

(i) A number whose last digit expresses an even num- 
ber is divisible by 2. 

248 and 100694 are divisible by 2. 

(ii) A number whose last digit is 6 or is divisible 
by 5. 

26, 55, and 600 are divisible by 5. 

(iii) A number whose last two digits express a num- 
ber divisible by 4 or by 25 is divisible by 4 or by 25, 
respectively. 

67215736 is divisible by 4. 
23798676 is divisible by 25. 

(iv) A number the sum of whose digits is divisible by 
3 or by 9 is divisible by 3 or by 9, respectively. 

The sum of the digits of the number 56174154, namely, 

5 + 6 + 1 + 7+4 + 1+5 + 4, is 33; 

and 33 is divisible by 3, but is not divisible by 9. Thus, the 
number 56174154 is divisible by 3, but not by 9. 

(v) A number is divisible by 11 when the difference 
between the sum of the first, third, fifth, etc., digits and 
the sum of the second, fourth, sixth, etc., digits is zero 
or a multiple of 11, and not otherwise. 

Thus, 3572129 is seen to be divisible by 11, since 9 + 1 + 7 + 3 
differs from 2 + 2 + 5 by 11. 



Arts. 76, 77.] EXAMPLES. 61 

EXAMPLES XVI. 
Oral Exercises. 

Which of the numbers, 2, 4, 8, 3, 9, 5, 25, 125, 11, can 
be seen by inspection to be factors of 

1. 964. 4. 7326. 7. 94680. 10. 49125. 

2. 225. 5. 6975. 8. 29304. 11. 307890. 

3. 1925. 6. 4125. 9. 76164. 12. 264792. 

77. The following are important general theorems : 

I. Every divisor or fcbctor of each of several numbers is 
a divisor of their sum. 

If, for example, each of several numbers is divisible by 12, then 
each can be arranged in groups of twelve, and therefore their sum 
consists of a certain number of twelves. Similarly for any other 
divisor. 

II. Every divisor of a number is a divisor of any mul- 
tiple of that number. 

If, for example, any number is divisible by 12, it can be arranged 
in groups of twelves, and so also can any number of repetitions of 
the number. 

III. Every divisor of two numbers is a divisor of the 
sum, or of the difference, of any multiples of the numbers. 

If, for example, two numbers are both divisible by 12, they can 
both be arranged in groups of twelves, and so also can any multiples 
of either. These multiples can then be added, or one can be taken 
from the other, without taking to pieces any of the groups. 

To make the above theorems quite clear to a beginner, 
it would be well to have actual counters to deal with, 
which could be tied up by twelves in bags or bundles. 
The pupil would then see that the different additions 
and subtractions could be performed tvithout undoing any 



62 FACTOBS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. UL 

of the bags or bundles, and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves. 

78, The^ieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16, 

11, 12, 13, ii, 15, i6, 17, Is, 19, 20, 

21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 

31, 32, 83, 34, 36, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 3. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 6 ; and, leaving 5 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 5 : we thus mark all multiples of 5. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 6, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are struck out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 37, 41, 
43, 47, 53, 59, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Abts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. Is 233 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 6, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -r- 17 gives tf quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors. 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


11 


143 



13 



1089 



663 



221 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

2 3978 
3 
3 
13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



64 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

EXAMPLES XVn. 

Express the following numbers as products of prime 
factors : 

Oral Exercises. 

1. 6, 9, 10, 15, 24, 30, 36, 39, 45, 48. 

2. .6, .9, 1.5, 2.4, 3.6, 3.9, 4.5, 4.8. 

3. .09, .15, .24, .36, .39, .45, .48. 

4. 49, 50, 54, 60, 5.4, 75, 81. 
6. 3.2,100,120,130. 

Written Exercises. 

6. 184, 196, 275, 273, 391, 525. 

7. 350, 459, 715, 728, 792, 999. 

8. 1092,3885. 

9. 51051,74613,462462. 

10. Obtain two factors of (6 + 15). 

11. Obtain three factors of (30 -f 70). 

12. Obtain two factors of(2x6-f4x5 + 2x 17). 

Square Root. 

8L Obtain the two equal factors of 4 ; of 9 ; of 25 ; 
of 0.4. 

Obtain the three equal factors of 8; of 27; of .008. 

Obtain the four equal factors of 16 ; of 81. 

One of the equal factors of a number is called a Root 
of the number ; thus, 3 is a root of 9 ; 5 is a root of 25 ; 
3 is a root of 27 ; .2 is a root of .04 ; .2 is a root of .008. 

If a number is the product of two equal factors, its root 
is called a second root, or Square Root. 

If a number is the product of three equal factors, its 
root is called a third root, or Cube Root. 

Likewise we have/owr^^ and,^^ roots, etc. 



Akts. 81-86.] SQUARE ROOT. 65 

82. It was shown in Art. 52 that a square is obtained 
when the multiplicand equals the multiplier. 

Here it is seen that a square root is obtained when the 
quotient equals the divisor. 

83. The squares of the first 12 whole numbers should 
be known : they are 

1, 4, 9, 16, 25, 36, 49, 64, 81, 100, 121, 144. 

It will be seen at once that the square root of an integer is by 
no means always an integer ; in fact the only numbers between 1 
and 100 which have an integral square root are 4, 9, 16, 25, 36, 49, 
64, and 81. 

It will be seen later on that the square root of all integer which 
is not the square of a whole number can be found approximately 
only. 

An integer (or a decimal) which is the square of 
another integer (or decimal) is called a Perfect Square. 

Thus, 16 and .09 are perfect squares ; namely, the squares of 4 
and .3, respectively. 

84. The sign y is used to indicate a root, and is called 
the Radical Sign. 

If any other root than the second is to be indicated, 
a small figure called an Index is placed just above the 
radical sign ; thus, 

■yj^ indicates the square root of 9 ; 
^8 indicates the cube root of 8 ; 
^243 indicates the fifth root of 243. 

85. In simple cases, the square root of a given number 
can be found by separating it into factors which are 
squares, and making use of the principle that the product 
of the squares of two or more quantities is equal to the 
square of the product of those quantities. 



66 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. HL 

For example, to find v'324. 

324 = 4 X 81 = 22 X 92 = (2 X 9)2 ; 
hence, y/S2i = V(2 x 9)2 = 2 x 9 = 18. 

Also, y/lM = ^(22 X .62) = V(2 X .6)2 = 2 x .6 = 1.2. 

EXAMPLES XVin. 
Written Exerciseg. 

Find the square roots of the following numbers : 

1. 196; 1.96. 6. 576; 5.76. 11. 2601. 

2. 225; 2.25. 7. 676; 6.76. 12. 3969; .003969. 

3. 324 8. 1089;. 1089. 13. 4225; 42.25. 

4. 400; 4.84. 9. 1225; 12.25. 14. 7056. 

5. 441; 4.41. 10. 2025. 15. 11025. 

In each of the following numbers, what is the least 
multiplier that will produce a perfect square ? 

16. 12. 18. 24. 20. 126. 22. 1176. 

17. 20. 19. 52. 21. 140. 23. 1344. 

24. State a number which has a second and a fourth 
root ; a second, third, and sixth root. 

86. The above method cannot be easily used in all 
cases, but the method which can be used will be under- 
stood from the following explanation. [Arts. 86, 87, 88.] 

Let it be required to find 631 This may be done in 
the usual way, and the square is found to be 3969. 

Now 632 may \^q written (60 + 3)2, which equals the square of 
60 + twice the product of 60 by 3 + the square of 3. 

60 + 3 
60 + 3 



60 X 3 + 32 
602 -t- 60 X 3 

602 + 2(60 x3)+32 



Abts. 86-88.] SQUARE ROOT. 67 

The square of the sum of any other pair of numbers 
can be expressed in a similar form. 

Hence, the square of the sum of any two numbers is equal 
to the sum of their squares plus twice their product. 

87. Since 

.012= 0001, 102= 100^ 

.V = .01, 1002= 10000, 

V. = 1, 10002 = 1000000, 

and so on, it follows that if a number has one digit, its 
square has either one or two digits ; if a number has two 
digits, its square has either three or four digits; if a 
number has three digits, its square has either five or six 
digits ; and so on. 

Hence, if we mark off the digits of a given number, 
beginning" at the units' digit, into periods of two, the last 
of the periods on the left containing either one or two 
digits ; then the number of these periods will be equal to 
the number of digits in the square root of the given number. 

For example, by pointing off the numbers, 961, 64.76, 36.8449, 
1622766, thus, 9'61, 64'.76, 36'.84'49, 1'52'27'66, we see that the square 
roots of these numbers contain 2, 2, 8, and 4 figures, respectively. 

8& To find the Square Root of Any Number. 

The method will be seen from the following examples : 

Ex. 1. To find the square root of 3969. 

39'69'r60 4- S ^^ pointing off the digits into periods 

86 00 of two, we see that there are two digits 

2 X 60+3=123 "^3 69 ^ ^^® required root ; and, since 60^ = 

3 69 3600 and 70^ = 4900, we see that the 

root lies between 60 and 70. The tens' 

digit must therefore be 6, and we have now to find the units* digit. 

If we subtract 60^ from the given number, the remainder is 369 ; 

and, by Art. 86, this remainder is equal to (2 x 60) times units* 

digit + (units' digit) 2, or units' digit times (2 x 60 + units' digit) ; 



•• 



68 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

i.e., 369 is the product of the unknown digit by (2 x 60 + the 

unknown digit). 

Hence, if we use 2 x 60 as a trial diyisor, we obtain a quotient, 

namely 3, which is either equal to or greater than the required digit. 

Put this quotient for the unknown digit, and we have (2 x 60 + 3), 

or 123, as a true, or complete, divisor. Now dividing 369 by 123, 

we find that 3 is the correct digit for units* place. 
QCitQQUQQ T^^^ process is shortened, as in ordinary division, 

30 by the omission of zeros ; the periods, of two figures 

123)369 each, are brought dovm one at a time, one figure of 

369 the root corresponding to each period. 

Ex. 2. Find the square root of 114244. 

11'42'44'(300 + 30+8 11'42'44(338 
900 00 ^ 

600 + 30)2 42 44 63)2 42 

18900 189 



660 + 8) 63 44 668) 63 44 

63 44 63 44 

There are here three periods and therefore three digits in the root, 
the first of which is 3, since 114244 is between 300^ and 4002. Using 
300 X 2 as a trial divisor in order to find the second figure in the root, 
we obtain the quotient 40 ; this, however, is too great, for (600 + 40), 
the complete divisor, is not contained 40 times in the dividend ; we 
therefore try 30, which proves to be correct. 

The process is usually indicated in the shortened form, any 
trial divisor being the product of the quotient already found by 
2 and 10 continuously, while the corresponding complete divisor is 
the trial divisor with its naught displaced by the quotient figure 
obtained in using the trial divisor : thus, in Ex. 2, the first trial 
divisor is 3 x 2 x 10 = 60, while the complete divisor is 63 ; also 
the second trial divisor is 33 x 2 x 10 = 660, while the complete 
divisor is 668. 

Ex. 3. Find the square root o/ 60126400. 

Here there are four periods and therefore 
60'12'64'00'(7080 four figures in the root. A figure of the 

root corresponds to each period brought 
1 12 64 dovm in the shortened process ;, and in the 

QQ present case two figures of the root are 

naughts. 



Abts. 88, 89.] SQUARE ROOT. 69 

Ex. 4. Find ^14.44. 

In the case of a decimal, the pointing must be begun at the 
decimal point, and carried to the left for the integral part, and to 
the right for the decimal part. 

14. '44' (3.8 
_9 

68)5 44 
5 44 

Ex. 6. Find V315. 

Having used both periods of the given 

3'15.'00/00'(17.74 + number, there is a remainder of 26. We 

1 place a decimal point after the units' figure 



27)2 16 of both dividend and quotient, and then 

^ continue the periods by using naughts. 

24 29 ^^^ process would never terminate, hence 

ofiAA \ 1 7100 ^^^ ^^ ^^^ ^ perfect square. We obtain, 

\ 41 75 however, an approximate answer by stop- 

29 24 piJig after the second or third decimal 

place. 

89. Since the square of a number cannot end with a naught 
unless the number itself ends with a naught, it follows that, if the 
process of finding a square root does not terminate when the 
last significant figure is brought down, the process will never 
terminate. 

Expressions such as -^3, ■v/2.6, which cannot be found exactly are 
called Surds. 

Although no definite number can be found whose square is exactly 
equal to 3, the process of Art. 88, Ex. 6, if contini^d far enough^ 
will enable us to find a decimal whose square differs from 3 by as 
small a quantity as we please. 

EXAMPLES XIX. 
Written Exercises. 

Find the square roots of 

1. 729. 4. .1849. 7. 16.81. 

2. 34*81. 5. 2209. 8. 66169. 

3. 11.56. 6. 6084. 9. 4157521. 



70 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. m. 

10. 49126081. 13. 9346249. 16. 13.69. 

11. 26625600. 14. 934.5249. 17. 136.9. 

12. 182.493081. 16. 1369. 18. 1.369. 

19. .00022201. 20. 2.2201. 

Find, to three decimal places, 

21. V^- 24. V125.4. 27. V-O^l- 

22. V19. 26. ^S1M6. 28. V-O^'^^^- 

23. V^l-S. 26. V-4- 29. ^O^^- 

Highest Common Factor. 

90. A number Vhicli exactly divides two or more num- 
bers is called their Common Factor. 

For example, 2, 3, and 6 are common factors of 18 and 24. 

The largest number which exactly divides two or more 
numbers is called their Highest Common Factor (H.C.F.) ; 
called, also, the Greatest Common Measure (G.C.M.), and 
the Greatest Common Divisor (G.C.D.). 

Thus, 6 is the H.C.F. of 18 and 24, 
or the G.C.M. of 18 and 24, 
or the G.C.D. of 18 and 24. 

91. After numbers have been resolved into their prime 
factors, their H.C.F, can be found by inspection. 

Consider, for example, the numbers 30 and 42. 

30 = 2x3x6 ,, .«.„ 

42 = 2 X 3 X 7 ^^® ^® ®®® * ^ ^'^ ^^^ 

— — primes that are divisors of both 30 and 42. 

H.C.F. =2x3 Therefore the H.C.F. = 2x3 = 6. 

= 6. 

Again, 

720 = 2* X 32 X 6 

1080 = 28 X 38 X 5 Here 2 is a common factor three times, 
H.C.F. = 28 X 32 X 6 3 is common twice, and 6 is common once. 
= 360. 



Abts. 90-92.] HIGHEST COMMON FACTOR. 71 

The H.C.F. of two or more numbers must be the 

continued product of all the common prime factors of the 

numbers. 

Further Illustrations. 

Ex. 1. Ex. 2. 

792 = 28 X 32 X 11 2730 = 2 x3x5x7xl3 

4368 = 2* X 3 X 7 X 13 6304 = 28x3 x 13 x 17 

H.C.F. =23x3 780 = 22x3x6 x 13 



= 24. H.C.F.= 2 x3 x 13 

= 78. 

EXAMPLES XX. 
Oral Exercises. 

Find the H.C.F. of 

1. 12 and 18. 3. 30 and 42. 6. 60 and 84. 

2. 20 and 25. 4. 18 and 30. 6. 54 and 90. 

Written Exercises. 

7. 45 and 105. 10. 189 and 273. 13. 693 and 819. 

8. 72 and 90. 11. 132 and 252. 14. 792 and 924. 

9. 126 and 315. 12. 315 and 357. 15. 891 and 1221. 

16. 48, 60, and 72. 18. 264, 360, and 600. 

17. 72, 108, and 180. 19. 630, 756, and 1155. 

92. We must now show how to find the H.C.F. of two 
numbers without going through the troublesome process 
of expressing the numbers as the product of prime 
factors. 

The method depends on the following theorem, proved 
in Art. 77 : 

Any common factor of two numbers is also a factor of 
the sum, or of the difference, of any multiples of the 
numbers. 



72 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. HL 

Suppose that we have two numbers whose H.C.F. is 
required. 

If we divide the greater number by the smaller, then, 
by the nature of division, 

(i) the remainder is equal to the difference between 
the greater number and some multiple of the smaller ; 

(ii) the greater number is equal to the sum of the 
remainder and some multiple of the smaller. 

From (i) it follows that any common factor of the 
original numbers is a factor of the remainder, and there- 
fore is a common factor of the remainder and the smaller 
number. 

From (ii) it follows that any common factor of the 
remainder and the smaller number is a factor of the 
greater number also, and therefore is a common factor of 
the two original numbers. 

The H.C.F. of the two original numbers must therefore 
be the same as the H.C.F. of the smaller number and the 
remainder. 

Thus the problem of finding the H.C.F. of the two 
original numbers is reduced to that of finding the H.C.F. 
of the smaller number and the remainder. 

Ex. 1. Find the H.C.F. o/3663 and 5439. 

Divide the greater by the less. 

3663)5439(1 
3663 

1776 

Hence the H.C.F. required is the same as the H.C.F. of 1776 
and 3663. Divide the greater of these by the less. 

1776)3663(2 
3652 

111 



Art. 02.] fflGHEST COMMON FACTOR. Jg 

The problem is now reduced to finding the H.C.F. of 111 and 

1776. Again divide. 

111)1776(16 
111 

666 
666 

Thus, 111 is a factor of 1776, and therefore 111 is the H.C.F. 

of 111 and 1776. 

But the H.C.r. of 111 and 1776 is the H.C.F. required. 

The successive divisions are usually written in a more compact 

form, as follovra : 

3663)5439(1 
3663 

1776)3663(2 
3562 

111)1776(16 
111 

666 
666 

Ex. 2. Find the H, C. F. of 311 and 331. 

311)331(1 
311 

20)311(16 
20_ 

111 
100 

11)20(1 
11 

9)11(1 
9 

2)9(4 
8 

1)2(2 
2 

Here the H.C.F. of 311 and 331 is the same as the H.C.F. of 
1 and 2, so that the numbers are prime to one another. 

In this example, it would be a great waste of time to proceed to 
the end; for the H.C.F. required is the H.C.F. of any divisor and 
the corresponding dividend, and as soon as it is obvious that one 
such pair have no common factors it is not necessary to proceed 
further. Now the only prime factors of 20 are 2 and 5, and by 
inspection neither of these is a factor of 311. 



62 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. UI. 

of the bags or bundles, and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves, 

78, The -Sieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16, 

11, i2, 13, ii, is, 16, 17, is, i9, 26, 

2i, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 
31, 32, 33, 34, 36, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 3. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 6 ; and, leaving 6 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 5 : we thus mark all multiples of 6. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 5, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are stnick out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 37, 41, 
43, 47, 63, 59, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Arts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. Is 233 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 5, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -j- 17 gives n quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors, 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


11 


143 



13 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

3978 



1989 



663 



221 



2 

3 

3 

13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



62 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. UL 

of the hags or hundleSy and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves, 

78, The -Sieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16, 

11, 12, 13, ii, is, i6, 17, is, 19, 26, 

2i, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 80, 
31, 82, 33, 34, 36, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 8. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 6 ; and, leaving 6 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 5 : we thus mark all multiples of 6. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 5, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are struck out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 87, 41, 
43, 47, 63, 59, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Arts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. I8 233 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 5, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -r- 17 gives ^ quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors. 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


11 


143 



13 



1989 



663 



221 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

2 3978 
3 
3 
13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



62 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

of the bags or bundleSf and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves. 

78. The -Sieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 16, 

11, 12, 13, ii, i5, i6, 17, is, 19, 20, 

21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 

31, 32, 33, 34, 36, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 3. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 5 ; and, leaving 5 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 6 : we thus mark all multiples of 6. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 6, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are struck out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 37, 41, 
43, 47, 63, 69, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Arts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. I8 233 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 6, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -^17 gives tf quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors, 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


11 


143 



13 



1989 



663 



221 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

2 3978 
3 
3 
13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



62 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

of the bags or bundles, and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves, 

78. The -Sieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 0, 16, 

11, i2, 13, ii, 15, i6, 17, is, 19, 20, 

21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 

31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 3. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 5 ; and, leaving 5 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 5 : we thus mark all multiples of 5. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 5, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are struck out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 37, 41, 
43, 47, 53, 69, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Arts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. Is 238 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 6, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -r- 17 gives ^ quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors, 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


1 


143 



13 



1089 



663 



221 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

2 3978 
3 
3 
13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



62 FACTORS AND MULTIPLES. [Chap. IIL 

of the bags or bundles^ and therefore the final result must 
be a certain number of twelves. 

78. The -Sieve of Eratosthenes. — The different prime 
numbers can be found in order by the following method, 
called the Sieve of Eratosthenes. 

Write in their natural order the numbers from 1 to any extent 
that may be required ; thus, 

1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 6, 7, 8, 0, 16, 

11, 12, 13, ii, i5, i6, 17, is, 19, 20, 

21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 20, 3*6, 

31, 32, 33, 34, 36, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, etc. 

Now take the first prime number, 2, and over every second number 
from 2 place a dot : we thus mark all the multiples of 2. Then, 
leaving 3 unmarked, place a dot over every third number from 3 : we 
thus mark all multiples of 3. The number next to 3 left unmarked 
is 5 ; and, leaving 6 unmarked, place a dot over every fifth number 
from 5 : we thus mark all multiples of 6. And so for multiples 
of 7, etc. 

By proceeding in this way all multiples of the prime numbers, 
2, 3, 6, 7, etc., are struck out ; also multiples of all composite numbers 
are necessarily struck out at the same time : for example, all multi- 
ples of 6 are struck out as being multiples of either of its prime 
factors 2 or 3. Hence all the numbers which are left unmarked are 
primes, for no one of them is divisible by any number (except unity) 
which is smaller than itself. 

We can thus find in order as many prime numbers as we please. 

The primes less than 100 will be found to be 

1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 11, 13, 17, 19, 23, 29, 31, 37, 41, 
43, 47, 53, 59, 61, 67, 71, 73, 79, 83, 89, and 97. 

79. To find whether a given number is or is not a prime, 
we have only to see whether it is divisible by any one of 
the prime numbers, 2, 3, 5, 7, etc. 



Arts. 78-80.] PRIME FACTORS. 63 

Ex. 1. Is 233 a prime number f 

By trial it will be found that 233 is not divisible by 2, nor by 3, 
nor by 6, nor by 7, nor by 11, nor by 13, nor by 17. Now it is not 
necessary to try any other primes, for 233 -r- 17 gives ^quotient less 
than 17 ; if, therefore, 233 were divisible by a prime greater than 17, 
the quotient would be less than 17, and 233 would be divisible by 
this quotient, that is by a number less than 17, which we know is 
not the case. Hence 233 is a prime number. 

80. Resolution into Prime Factors. 

The following examples will suffice to show how to 
express any number whatever as the product of factors 
each of which is a prime. 

The method is applicable to all numbers however large, provided 
we find as many prime numbers as may be necessary by means 
of the * sieve ' ; the method would, however, be extremely tedious 
in the case of a very large number. 

Ex. 1. Express 28028 as the product of prime factors, 

28028 = 2 X 14014 These continuous divisions may 

= 2 X 2 X 7007 be thus expressed : 

= 2 X 2 X 7 X 1001 
= 2 X 2 X 7 X 7 X 143 
= 2x2x7x7x11x13. 



2 


28028 


2 


14014 


7 


7007 


7 


1001 


1 


143 



13 



1989 



663 



221 



Ex. 2. Find the prime factors of 3978. 

2 3978 
3 
3 
13 

17 

The answer is 2, 3^, 13, and 17. 

Ex. 3. Obtain two factors of 14 + 22. 

14 + 22 = 2 multiplied by (7 + 11). 



84 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chap. rCL 

}' 7. What is the price of a silver bowl weighing 60 
ounces, at 1.25 dollars an ounce ? 

8. Two equal sums were respectively divided among 
12 men and a certain number of boys. Each man received 
6 dollars, and each boy 1 dollar. How much was divided 
altogether, and how many boys were there ? 

N 9. Exactly 20 years ago, a man was four times as old 
as his son, whose present age is 28. What is the present 
age of the father ? 

10. Find 19x16; 656x125. 



11. A certain chapter of a book begins at the top of 
the 357th page and ends at the bottom of the 435th page. 
How many pages are there in the chapter ? 

\^ 12. After multiplying 375 by 29, and 131 by some 
other number, the results when added amounted to 13888. 
What was the other number ? 

13. Find the H.C.F. of 5610, 11781, and 1309. 

14. Find the least number by which 222 must be 
multiplied in order that the product may be a multiple 
of 1295. 

15. Four bells toll at intervals of 3, 4, 5, and 6 seconds, 
respectively. If they all begin to toll at the same instant, 
how long will it be before they again all toll together ? 



^ 



16. Add fourteen hundred seventeen, four thousand 
eleven hundred nine, six million fifteen thousand, and 
eighteen million twelve hundred nineteen. 

17. A certain number was divided by 35 by 'short' 
divisions ; the quotient was 72, the first remainder was 
2, and the second remainder was 6. What was the 
dividend ? 



Art. 107.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 85 

18. Multiply 700630.0003 by 1006.07, and prove by 
dividing the product by the multiplier. 

19. Pind the continued product of 18, 13, and 11; 
obtain the square root of the product to two decimal 
places. 

20. Divide 126819 by 21, using factors. 



/ 



21. What is the least number of times that 315 must 
be added to 1594 that the sum may exceed a million ? 

22. Multiply 67412 by 9997 as shortly as you can. 

23. Divide 789 by .10063 to 3 decimal places. 

>24. Find the H.C.F. of 10481 and 17617. 

2§. Four men can walk 30, 35, 40, and 45 miles a day, 
respectively ; what is the least distance they can all walk 
in an exact number of days ? 



^ 



\ 26. Find the L.C.M. of 12, 64, 80, 96, 120, 160. 

27. Find the prime factors of 1176 and 19404, and 
hence write down their G.C.M. and L.C.M. 

28. The quotient is twice the divisor, and the remainder 
which is 50 is one-fifth part of the quotient. Find tlie 
dividend. 

>29. Simplify --— — — — : obtain the answer in two 
f onus. 125 X 219 

30. Find the least number which can be divided by 
7, 20, 28, and 35, and leave 3 as remainder in each case. 



31. What number is that which after being subtracted 
19 times from 1000 leaves a remainder of 12 ? 

32. Multiply three thousand eighty-seven by seventy- 
two thousand nine hundred thirty. What numbers less 
than 12 will exactly divide the product ? 



\ 86 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chaps. IIL, IV. 

A 33. (a) Simplify 650 x 1.25 -h .5. 

(b) The answer is a multiple of which of the 
following numbers : 5, 15, 25, 65, 105, 125 ? 
Obtain (h) by first obtaining primes of the answer. 

)^ 34. Find 19 X 17 X 11 X 2.5 x 1.25. 
/.35. Pind652x.ll. 

36. Simplify (a) ^ X 4 - 2 -f- 6 (18 - 14). 

(P) ^X (4-2) +6(18-14). 
(c) 2(J^x 4) -{2 + 6(18-14)1. 



37. If a number when divided by 35 give a remainder 
27, what remainder will it give when divided by 7 ? 

38. What is the greatest and what is the least number 
of four digits which is exactly divisible by 73 ? 

39. Pind the H.C.F. and the L.C.M. of 21, 22, 24, 2S, 
32, 33 ; also of 16, 18, 20, 24, 30, 36. 

40. Find the number nearest to 1000 and exactly 
divisible by 39. 

41. Multiply 7863 by 999, and see if the product is 
divisible by 3. 

42. Find V4912.888464. 

43. FindV3*. 

(a) Divide the following numbers by 2. 

(b) Prove your answers by first simplifying the 
numbers, and then dividing by 2. 

44. 3(6 + 8); 3(6x8). 

45. 4(6 + 8); 4(6x8). 

46. 4 (18 + 6) ; 4(18 s- 6). 

47. (6x2) (8 + 10)^^ 

48. 6(12-1-3) + 8 6 + 4 + 2. 

49. 28 ^[7 -(3 + 2)]. 



Arts. 108-110.] FRACTIONS. 87 



y 



CHAPTER IV. 

FRACTIONS. 

108. If a unit be divided into 2, 3, 4, 5, etc., equal parts, 
these parts are called halves, third-parts, fourth-parts, 
fifth-parts, etc., or more shortly and more generally, halves^ 
thirds, fourths, fifths, etc. 

If the unit quantity be divided into any number of 

equal parts, one or more of these parts is called a Fraction 

of the unit. 

For example, if a unit. quantity, as one apple, be divided into 
sevenths, three of these parts constitute three sevenths^ and the 
three sevenths is ?k fraction of seven sevenths, the unit quantity. 

109. The number which indicates how many parts of 
the unit quantity are to be used is called the Numerator. 

The number which indicates into how many parts the 
unit quantity is divided is called the Denominator. 

HO. The expression formed by writing a numerator 
just above a denominator with a line between is called a 
Common Fraction. 

Thus, f, -f^ (eight-thirteenths), ^ (one twenty-third), are com- 
mon fractions (called briefly fractions). 

Common fractions are also called vulgar fractions. 

Note. A fraction is an expression of division, the numerator 
and denominator corresponding to the dividend and divisor respec- 
tively. What is true of dividend and divisor is true of numerator 
and denominator. When the indicated division is performed, the 
quotient is generally a decimal. 



gg FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

Ex. ^ = 3 + 24. 

24)3.000(.125 
24 

60 
48 

120 
120 

111. If we have 3 units, and divide each of them into 
5 equal parts, and then take one of the parts from each 
divided unit, we shall take one part out of every five, that 
is, one-fifth of the whole three units ; but each of the parts 
is one-fifth of a single unit and we take 3 of them : we 
therefore take 3 fifths of one unit. 

Thus, 3 fifths ofl unit is the same as 1 fifth of 3 uriits. 

Hence, f, which by definition denotes 3 fifths of 1 unit, 
may also be considered to stand for 1 fifth of 3 units. 

The same holds good for all other fractions ; for example, 

f of 1 dollar = ^ of 3 dollars ; 
and ^ of 1 foot = ^ of 7 feet. 

BXAMPLES XXVII. 

1. Write in figures the following fractions: five- 
ninths, six-elevenths, eleven twenty-thirds, sixteen twenty- 
sevenths, seventeen ninety-firsts, ninety-five one hundred 
fourths. 

2. Write in words: f, |, ^, ^, ^, |f, ^, ^, ^, 

119 



112. The numerator and denominator of a fraction are 
called its Terms. 

When the numerator is less than the denominator, the 
fraction is called a Proper Fraction ; and when the numera- 
tor is equal to or greater than the denominator, the fraction 
is called an Improper Fraction. 



Arts. 111-114.] MIXED NUMBERS. 89 

A number made up of an integer and a fraction is called 
a Bfixed Number. 

ThuB, 2\ (2 and \), which means 2 + }» is a mixed number. 

Changing the form of an expression, or changing the 
units in terms of which any quantity is expressed, is 
called Reduction. 

113. Reducing a mixed number to an improper fraction. 

Consider, for example, 3^. 

Each miit contains 7 sevenths^ therefore 3 units contain 3 times 
7 sevenths. 

Hence, 3f = 3 times 7 seventJis + 2 seventJis — ?5L±^ = ??. 
AgaiB, 7i = I><|±2 = f. 

From the above it will be seen that a mixed number is equivalent 
to an improper fraction whose denominator is the denominator of 
the fractional part, and whose numerator is obtained by multiplying 
the integral part by the denominator of the fraction and adding its 
numerator. 

It should be noticed that a whole number can be expressed as 
a fraction with any given denominator. For example, 

6 = 6x7 sevenths = ^ ; also, 6 = 6 x 13 thirteenths = |J. 

114. Conversely, reducing an improper fraction to a 
whole or mixed number. 

Consider, for example, ^. 

Since 7 sevenths make 1 unit, 

^ = 3x7 sevenths + 2 sevenths = 34-2 seventies = 3f 

Again, ^ = 6x4 fourths = 6, since 4 fourths = 1. 

From the above it will be seen that an improper fraction is 
reduced to a mixed number by dividing its numerator by its denom- 
inator ; the quotient will form the integral part, while the remainder, 
if ai^, will form the numerator of the fractional part, whose 
denominator must be the denominator of the improper fraction. 



90 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

BXAMPLBS XXVIII. 
Oral Exercises- 
Express as improper fractions : 

1. ^,^,2^,^, 2. 7^,^\,5m. 

3. 4VV, 9^, 12i, 11^. 

4 . Express 3, 5, and 9 as fractions with a denominator 7. 

Express as whole or mixed numbers : 

Written Exerclsei. 

Express as improper fractions : 
8. 4^,5^,18^. [Art. 55, 1.] 

10. Eeduce 13 to fifteenths, and 41 to twenty-fifths. 

11. Express 427 as a fraction with a denominator 99. 

Express as whole or mixed numbers : 

See Art. 70 for examples in 14. 

115. Reducing a fraction to its lowest terms. 
A fraction is said to be in its Lowest Terms when the 
numerator and denominator have no common factor. 

Thus, the fractions, f , f , ^f , are in their lowest terms ; but the 
fractions, |, ^f, J^, are not in their lowest terms, for in each case 
the numerator and denominator have 2 as common factor. 

The following is a very important truth : 

The value of a fraction is not changed by dividing the 
numerator and denominator by the same number. 

This truth is but a repetition of the principle stated in An. 103. 



Abt. 116.] REDUCTION TO LOWEST TERMS. 91 

Ex. Beduce ^^^ to its lowest terms. 

To reduce to the lowest tenns we most divide by the H.C.F. of 
the numerator and denominator ; for we thus obtain an equivalent 
fraction whose numerator and denominator have no common factors. 

In the present case the H.C.F. will be found to be 55. 

825 825 -^ 55 15 



Thus, 



1540 1540 -4- 55 28 



Instead of reducing a fraction to its lowest terms by dividing 
the numerator and denominator by their H.C.F., we may divide 
by any common factor, and repeat the process until the fraction is 
reduced to its lowest terms. Thus, 

We see at once that 5 is a common factor ; we therefore divide 
the numerator and denominator by 5, and obtain the equivalent 
fraction ^|. We now see that 11 is a common factor, and having 
divided t^e numerator and denominator by 11, we have the equiva- 
lent fraction ^, which is at once seen to be in its lowest terms. 



BXAMPLBS XXIX. 
Oral JSxerciset. 

Reduce to their lowest terms : 

!• h h TS9 16> IT* ^* tti TT? T7> M* 

^' M? 1T> A^ ifj lo* ^* To? 7 5> TO"? W W' 

Written Exeroiiet. 

Reduce to their lowest terms : 



92 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

116. Reducing fractions to equivalent fractions having 
the lowest common denominator. 

The following is a very important truth : 

The value of a fraction is not changed by multiplying the 
numerator and denominator by the same number. 

This truth is but a repetition of the principle stated in Art. 67. 

Consider the fractions, f , |, and f . 

The L.C.M. of the denominators 4, 6, and 9 is easily seen to 
be 86. Since 36 is a multiple of each denominator, all the fractions 
can be reduced to equivalent fractions which have 36 for denom- 
inator, provided the numerator and denominator of each of the 
fractions be multiplied by a suitable number, namely, by the num- 
bers 36 -i- 4, 36 -^ 6, and 36 ^ 0, respectively ; that is, by 9, 6, and 
4, respectively. 

Thus, 



3. 
4" 


_3 
"4 


x9 
x9 


27 
= 36' 


6. 
6" 


.5 
"6 


x6 
x6 


30 
=^36' 


8. 
9" 


_8 
"9 


x4 
x4 


32 
36 



and 

Again, reduce ||, ^, ^, to equivalent fractions having the lowest 
common denominator. 

Full Work Illustrated. 

18 = 2 x82 
30 = 2 x3 x 5 
24 = 2« X 3 



L.C.M =28x32x6 



11 

18 


11 X 23 X 5 
18 X 22 X 5 


220 
360' 


7 _ 
30 


7 X 22 X 3 
30 X 22 X 3 


84 
360' 


5 


6x3x6 


76 


24 


24 X 3 X 6 


360 



117. Comparison of Fractions. 

Of two fractions which have the same denominator, the greater 
is that which has the greater numerator ; for, the parts being the 
same, the greater fraction is that which has the most of them. 



Arts. 116, 117.] EXAMPLES. 98 

Again, of two fractions which have the same numerator, the 
greater is that which has the smaller denominator ; for, the number 
of parts being the same in both, the greater is that in which the 
parts are the greater ; that is, in which the unit has been divided 
into the smaller number of equal parts. 

We can therefore see at once which of a number of fractions is 
the greatest, and which is the least, provided the fractions are first 
of all reduced to equivalent fractions with the same denominator. 
For this particular purpose it would do equally well to reduce the 
fractions to equivalent fractions with the same numerator, but it 
is for other purposes much less convenient to reduce fractions to 
equivalent fractions with the same numerator. 

Ex. Which is the greatest and which is tfie least of the fractions, 

As in the preceding article, the fractions are equivalent to f j, f J, 
and }j, respectively; they are therefore in ascending order of 
magnitude. 

EXAMPLES XXX. 

Written Exercises. 

Reduce to equivalent fractions with the lowest common 
denominator, and arrange in ascending order of magni- 
tude: 

2. it, A. 6. A,tt.|f 10. I, I, A- 

^' Ty Ta> "Za* • • 8' T? i' ^^' iT? T8> 2T* 

4* if T5J TS' °' A? TB"' H' ^2. -j-f, -Jifj -Jf. 

^^' T> T> h A? T6* ^'* h Tl9 TS9 TO' 

15. /:f, f^, |-0^, ff. 18. f, -jSj-, -ff, ^, ^. 

Reduce to equivalent fractions which have the lowest 
common numerator : 



36 



30 
21 
16 



94 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

lia Addition of Fractions. 

Fractions whicli have the same denominator are called 
Similar Fractions. 

If fractions are dissimilar they must be made similar 
[Art. 116] ; then their numerators may be added, and the 
sum written as a numerator for the common denominator. 
[Compare Art. 32.] 

Ex. 1. Find f + A + f 

6_ 6 X 6 __30 Or, 5- 

6 6 x6 86 ' 6" 

7 _ 7 x3 ^21 T__ 
12 12 X 3 86 12 " 

. 4_ 4 x4 _16 4_ 

9 9x4 _86^ 9" 

Sum=|=lJi. Suin= | = IJi- 

After a little practice the middle column might be omitted. 

Ex. 2. Find 2i -\- S^^. 

2f = 2H 

3A = 3A 
Sum = 6^^ 

Here the 12ths are added, and 1 is carried to units. The pro- 
cess is similar to that represented in Ex. 2, Art. 29. 

The result should in all cases be reduced to its lowest 
terms, and an improper fraction should be expressed as a 
mixed number. 

EXAMPLES XXXI. 
Oral Exercises. 

Find the sum of the following fractions : 

1. \ and f. 4. ^ and ^. 7. ^ and |. 

2. f and |^. 5. | and |. 8. f and f. 

3. -^ and ^. 6. \i and |f. 9. f and |. 



Abt. 118.] tUiitPLta. % 

10. I audi. 14. 20^ and 10^. 

11. |aiid|. 16. 3^and4§. 

12. 2|aiid3|. 16. 8fand6^. 

13. 4^ and 6^. 17. 12^ and 6^. 

18. 4^ and 6^. 

Written Exercises. 

!Find the svun of 

19. -^and^. 22. 2f and l^V- 26. 2|and3f. 

20. ^ and ^. 23. d| and 2^. 23. 3f and 1^. 

21. /^and^. 24. Tfandf. 27. Iff and 7^. 

28. I, I, T^s, and if . 30. T^, ^, ,3^, ,1^, IJ, and If. 

29. iifandf 31. ^, ^, ^, ^, ^, and ff . 

32. Find f + t"^ + 3V + ^ + VV. 

33. Find^ + T^ + ^ + ^ + ^. 

34. Find 3f + T^ + 6tV + T^iir. 

36. Find 3i + t!^ + 5^ + 3^ + 7f|. 

36. Find 3i + 6f + ii + 3^. 

37. Find 1^ + 2^ + n^ + 6i|. 

38. Find 3| + TtV + A + 2^ • 

39. Find2^-+6T^. 

40. Find 3,% + 5,^ + lliH- 

41 . Find lOHi + 11^ + 7|ff . 



96 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

119. Subtraction of Fractions. 

Subtraction can be performed with fractions only when 
they are similiar. [Compare Art. 39.] 

Ex. 1. Subtract f /rom jj. Ex. 2. Find 6|J - 3f 

ii = a m = m 

Difference = -^f. Remainder = 2^. 

Ex.8. Subtract S{1 from b^. 

Here ff cannot be subtracted from ^{, 

^i = Hi therefore we take 1 unit from the 5 units and 

m = Hi add it (changed to 24ths) to J{, making }} ; 

Remainder = IJ}. ^ow f} from f} equals i{, and 3 from 

4 equals 1. 
The operation is similar to that represented in Ex. 2, Art. 38. 

Ex. 4. Simplify 3} - 2f + 8} - b^^ -2^-\- JJ. [See Art. 41.] 

H= 3^y 2f= 2fJ 

i2tt - iOH=iH. 

BXAMPLES XXXII. 
Oral Bxerclses. 

Simplify (give lowest terms in your answers) : 

2. l-f 6. f-f. 10. S^-1^. 

3- A-A- 7. l-f 11. 6J-4|. 

Written Bxerdies. 

Simplify ; 

14. A-irV- 16- A-A- 18. T^f-f 



Arts. 119, 120.] MULTIPLICATION. 97 

19. A-^. 23. 3f-2f 27. 7^-&^\, 

20. A -A- 24. 7^-5^. 28. 19^1^-1235^. 

21. A--H- 26. 2f5_2if. 29. 1^-^^. 

22. A--H- 26. 31-232^. 30. 3^-2^. 

31. 6i-2|f. 33. 16^-5ii. 

32. 5t^-3^. 34. 9^-4Vy^,. 

Find the difference between 

36. 3^ and 5^. 39. 8|^ and 12^. 

36. 77ft- and 83^. 40. 6|^ and 12^. 

37. 6^andl5|4. 41. 143^ and 127^. 

38. 7i|and5|f. 42. 85^ and 72^. 

Simplify : 

43. 2| + 3i-4i. 

44. 6H-2i + l^. 

46. 5f-3^ + tt-232^- 

46. 15^ _ 13^ + 16^3^ _ 9|:f . 

47. 12^-10 + 7^^-1-5^. 

48. 41-2,2^^ + 2^-3^. 

120. Multiplication by a Whole Number. 

Fractions may be treated as concrete numbers ; therefore, 

as 3 times 6 tons = 15 tons, 

so 3 ** 6 sevenths = 16 sevenths ; 

t.e., 3 " ^ =^T^. 

Again, 3 ** ^y = || = J (by cancellation) 

5 5 



i.e., 3 - tv 



18 -f- 3 6 



Hence, to multiply a fraction by a whole number, we must 
multiply the numerator, or (when possible) divide the denomina- 
tor, by that whole number. 



98 FRACTIOKS. t^^HAP. tV. 

The product should always be reduced to its lowest terms, and 
an improper fraction should be expressed as a mixed number. 

Ex. Multiply ^g by 15. 

18 18 18 6 • 

BXAMPLES XXXin. 
Oral Exercises. 

Multiply and reduce to their simplest forms : 

1. I by 2. 3. ^by3. 6. f by 4. 

2. A by 3. 4. T^by4. 6. A by 4. 

7. I by 3. 9. ^ by 6. 

8. i^bylT. 10. 3^ by 8. 

Written Exercises. 

Perform the following examples (see Art. 107) : 

11. y^xl^- -15- 7^x26. 19. V^x22. 

12. T^ff X 8. 16. ^ X 16. 20. 44^^ X 26. 

13. 2f x6. 17. 9^x26. 21. 99 x^. 

14. 5| X 10. 18. If X 16. [Art. 55.] 22. f^^ x 9. 

121. Multiplication by a Fraction. 

We understand multiplication to be the taking one 
number as many times as there are units in another. 
Thus, to multiply 5 by 4, we take as many fives as there 
are units in 4. Now 4 is l-hl + l-hl, and 5 x 4 is 
5 + 5 + 5-1-5. 

Thus, to mvltiply one number by a second is to do to the 
first what is done to the unit to obtain tJie second. 

For example, to multiply ^ by f , we must do to ^ what is done 
to the unit to obtain | ; that is, we must divide ^ into 4 equal parts 



Art. 121.] MULTIPLICATION. 99 

and take 3 of those parts. Each of the 4 parts into which ^ is 

divided will be , and by taking 3 of these parts we get -^^• 

7x4' ^ ^ ®7x4 

Thus. 5x? = ?2i^. 

7 4 7x4 

Hence, the product of any two fractions is another fraction 
whose numerator is the product of their numerators and whose 
denominator is the product of their denominators. 

The continued product of any number of fractions is 
obtained by continued application of the above rule. 

Thus, to find the continued product of J, ^, and f . 

2 V 4 V 8 - 2 x^ ^8_2x4x8 64 



3 5 9 3x6 9 3x6x9 136 

Hence, the product of any number of fractions is another frac- 
tion whose numerator is the product of their numerators and 
whose denominator is the product of their denominators. 

It should be noticed that the product of one fraction by 
a second is equal to the product of the second by the first 

It should be noticed also that an integer x a fra^ction 
equals (the integer x the numerator) -^ the denominator, 

Ex. 1. Multiply -fs by ^^. 

2 1 

^ X - = ^^^ = ^. [Art. 107.1 

36 27 3^x;z;r 46 

6 9 

Ex. 2. Simplify f x | x J. 

Ill 

2x?x2-l. 
?'^^'^6~6 

1 
Ex.3. Multiply 2\ by Zi, 

The mixed numbers must first be reduced to improper fractions. 

Thus, 2ix34=?x?? = ?^^ = ?51 = 8A. 

**484x8 32'^ 



100 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

EXAMPLBS XXXIV. 
Simplify : «"> BxercUe.. 

1. ixi..- ' 7. I X |. 13. I X ^. 

2. |xf 8. |X4|. 14. fix**- 

3- fx|. «.'fxH. 16. MxA- 

4. ^Xf 10. |xii. 16. IfX:^. 

6. 1^X2^. 11. T^rXH- "• (I)'- 

6. 2i X 3|. 12. f X H. 18. (t)». 19. (|)». 

Written Exercises* 

20. StVxSVV- 27. VVxSAxif- 

21. I X I X f 28. 2,1,^ X 3| X 6|. 

22. Ixixf 29. l^Jp X 2| X It^t- 

23. fXT»rX5^. 30. 6TJVx||xl|f. 

24. fxljx5|. 31. T«^ X 2^ X 6^ X TV\r- 

26. 2ix3ix4^. 32. 1^ X lii X i^ X 1^. 

26. S^XT^XT^ff. 33. ||X1|X6AX2^. 

34. (|)». 36. (^)« 36. (^y. 

122. Division by a Whole Number. 



Just as 


15 tons -=-3=6 tons. 


so also 


15 sevenths -^ 8 = 5 sevenths, 


that is, 


J^ + 3 = f. 



Again, to divide { by 3. 

Here 5 is not a multiple of 3. But, since - = , 

6 6x3 

5^3 = 5J<^^3= '^ 



6 6x3 6x3 18 



Art. 122.] EXAMPLES. 101 

We see at once, that a fraction is divided by a whole number 
by multiplying its denominator by the whole number. For 

example, in there are the same number of parts as in 

6x3 ^ 

^, namely five, but the unit in the former case is divided into 3 
times as many parts as in the latter, and therefore each of the 

parts in — ^— is one-third of each of the parts in 4. 

Hence, to divide a fraction by a whole number, we must divide 
the numerator, or multiply the denominator (only when neces- 
sary), by that whole number. 

Ex. 1. Divide SI by 7. 



> 



^ 5 6 X 7 36 

Ex. 2. Divide 215f by 9. 

When the integral part of the dividend 
216 J -5-9 = 23 + 8f-f-9 ^ ^^^^^ ^^ ^^^ ^.^.^^ ^^^ integer by the 

~ + -7- ~ ^ divisor ; then the remainder + the frac- 
= ^*>th tional part is to be divided by the divisor. 



EXAMPLES XXXV. 



Simplify : 


Oral Exercises. 


• 


1. iH-2. 


5. ^^8. 


9. 


ff : 26. 


2. fH-3. 


6. ^-^4. 


10. 


H -5-17. [Art. 65.] 


3. VV-4- 


7. l^-f.6. 


11. 


A-^12. 


4- ^ + 3. 


8. tl-^7. 


12. 


fi-^9- 



Written Exercises. 

13. |f-^6. 17. 2^-^ll. 21. 6f^6. 

14. ff-^16. 18. 7|-h6. 22. 7|^6. 

15. fl-f-30. 19. 91-^-8. 23. 8^-f-15. 

16. |i-^■7. 20. ^-J-16. 24. 12f-f-ll. 



102 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

26. 85f-!-9. 26. 214^^ -?-<'. 27. 174^-$- 18. 

28. 711^15. 29. 254^ -h 25. 

123. Division by a Fraction. 

If the fraction ^ be divided by 1 (unity), the quotient 
is ^; but, if the unit be separated into thirds, and one 
of these thirds be used (instead of unity) as the divisor, 
the quotient is 3 times as large as before. 

Thus, J^l = }; buti-i-J = ix3 = JyL. • 

Now, if the second divisor (|) be multiplied by 2, the quotient 
(^) must be divided by 2 ; thus, 

}^|= Jx3-2 

».e., 1 -^ I = 1 X f = H- 

The same reasoning v^ill apply to all cases. 

Hence, to divide by a fraction, we must multiply by the fraction 
inverted. 

Note. Sometimes a short method of dividing a fraction by a 
fraction is to divide the numerator and denominator of the dividend 
by the numerator and denominator of the divisor, respectively ; 

thus, I - J = f. 

Ex. 1. Divide i by ^f . 

1 16 

. - 6 • 32 ^ ;? 9 *• 

3 3 

Ex. 2. Dimde 2\ by 1|{. 

The mixed numbers must first be expressed as improper fractions. 

Then M^?7^|^|^^^ 

7 14 7 JJ7 9 " 
1 9 



Arts. 123-126.] COMPOUND FRACTIONS. 



103 



EXAMPLES XXXVI. 



Simplify : 


Written BzerclseB. 






1. 


l-s-f 


12. 


*-^f 


23. 


i¥ir-^«- 


2. 


f+f 


13. 


2f-^.2i. 


24. 


Hi-^W 


3. 


* + !• 


14. 


^-^lA. 


26. 


2A - li^- 


4. 


i+f 


15. 


6|-^■lf 


26. 


^A-^IH- 


5. 


i-^i- 


16. 


^-^lA. 


27. 


ifi ^ 1 A- 


6. 


h "^ H- 


17. 


6|-^11. 


28. 


ifW-^-iA^. 


7. 


i-^f 


18. 


6f-5-9. 


29. 


IH-^2f|- 


8. 


tV-»-A- 


19. 


M-^H- 


30. 


5^-2^8. 


9. 


i+1- 


20. 


2H-^7. 


31. 


11^^12^ 


10. 


i-^i- 


21. 


«-^A- 


32. 


2ilf^5|H. 


* 


i+f 


22. 


H-^M- 







124. When unity is divided by any number, the quo- 
tient is called the Reciprocal of the number ; thus, 

\ is the reciprocal of 6 ; | is the reciprocal of } ; 5 is the re- 
ciprocal of \. 

Any number x its reciprocal = 1. 



A fraction of a fraction is called a Compound 
Eruption. 

Thus, J of ^ is a compound fraction. 

To take } of ^, we must divide f into 3 equal parts and take 2 of 
those parts. 

Hence, f of ^ is the same as ^ x }. 



Ex. 1. Multiply f of 2^ by f of 1}. 

f of 2i = f X Yi and f of If = 

« 11 s t 11 

hence the required product = 2x-ix"x- = — 

/ ? JK 4 13 

9 



«xj; 



104 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

BXAMPLBS XXXVU. 
Written Bxerclse*. 

1. State the reciprocals of 12, ^, |f , ^, and |^. 
Simplify : 

2. f off 9. f of^of^a^. 

3. I off. 10. 2^ of 3J off 

4. f of A. 11. 6? of 2,^ of If 

5. lfof2f 12. foff x\^of2f 

6. 3| of 6f 13. ^ of 2f X lA of ^' 

7. 7|of2f 14. l|of3ix|f X5f 

8. 3| of 3f 16. 1| of 3f X 6^ of 7f 



K A fraction whose numerator, or denominator, or 
both, are fractional is called a Complex Fraction. 

Thus, i, i, and ii-I are complex fractions. 

^ ^ i + i 

Complex fractions are simplified by dividing the numer- 
ator (simplified) by the denominator (simplified). 



Ex. 1. Simplify 1- 



^ 3 ■ 7 3 5 16 



Ex. 2. Simplify i±i- 

J+i 

= « + * 

2 

? ? 3 
3 

Caution. Dividing by the sum of two fractions is not equivalent 
to multiplying by the sum of the reciprocals of those fractions. 



Art. 126.] COMPLEX FRACTIONS. 105 

In solvisg the above example the following would be wrong : 



i+i 



= (i + 4)x(* + *)- 



A complex fraction is unchanged in value by multi- 
plying its numerator and denominator by the same 
number. 



For 


example, 




-fx 


11 
11 










For 

d 




5x11-. 
7 


fx 

-1^ 


f = 

11 


6 
"7 ""h 


46 

28 
















4 





and 



Ex. 1. Simplify i_i. 

Multiply the numerator and denominator by 24, the L.C.M. of 
3, 4, 6, 8. Then we have 



(f-f)24 _18-j6,2_^ 
(J-f)24 21-20 1 



Ex, 2. Simplify 



6 + 



7- 



4 + i 
3 3 3 



5 + ?— 5 + -1- ^ + W 

y 3 7- 

4 + i 



— Jot -- T(rr* 



First, multiply the numerator and denominator of the lowest 

complex fraction, namely , by 2, and we get f . Next, multiply 

^ + i 2 
the numerator and denominator of the fraction by 9, and we 

7-1 o 

get H. Then multiply the numerator and denominator of — - — 

6 + H 
by 67, and we get m, which is then reduced to its lowest terms. 

A fraction of this type is called a Continned Fraction. 



106 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 



EXAMPLES XXXVni. 
Written Bxerclse*. 

Simplify : 

2. I- 6. 1. 8. 4- 11- ^• 

3. 1. 6. 1. 9. ?i. 12. JX- 

13. i±i. 17. ^1^1^. 21. 3i Of H 

l + i 2i-| 2iof6i 

14. iini. 18. ^A-y. 22. f-^21 

H + l 6^-2* 1,^-^21 

16. t±A. 19. 1^-10^ 23. 3^ + 4i 

i + T^r 18f-16V^ 6^ + 1,^ 

16. A-A 20. ^ - H . 24. i+t+i . 

A-A |of| A+dk+TiV 



26. i^ + H-A — i. 



29. 



1 



22 3 + 



26. — ^:^. 2-t 

8 + f 30. ^ 



1+ ^ 



36 "^„ 4 

27. —• 2+ * 



6 ^ '3 + 4 

7-f 7 



31. 



28. g^-gf ■ 6 + — 3- 

2 19 j_ 1 



6 3J + 2i 3-^ 



Art. 127.] COMPLEX FRACTIONS. 107 

32. ^i . 33. ^ 



3 + ^ ^ 

6-^^ 3- 



1-1 4+i 

127. We now proceed to give examples of a more 
complicated nature; it will be well, however, for the 
student to consider carefully the following cases in which 
mistakes are frequently made in the meaning of the signs 
employed. 

I. Operations of multiplication and division are to be 
performed in order from left to right, and each sign is a 
direction to multiply or divide what precedes the sign by 
the number that follows next after it. 

For example, 36 x 6 ^ 3 = 216 -4- 3 = 72, 

36-^6-5-3 = 6-5-3 = 2, 

and 86 -?- 6 X 3 = 6 X 3 = 18. 

01 28 8 2x3 8 2x3 15 3 

So also, - X - -5 — = -5- — = X ~ = -, 

36 15 3x6 16 8x5 8 4' 

Z 6 5"8^6' 5"3^6'^4" ' 

, 254264 16 

and S-^^X7 = «X7Xt = ^- 

3 6 6 3 6 6 25 

II. Numbers connected by the sign * of ' must be con- 
sidered as a single number, just as if they were enclosed 
in brackets. 

Thus 11^2 f7^14^22^_14 5j<^_8 
inns, 15 • 50^8-15 • 5^8-i5X2x7"3* 

Again. ?of5^5of5 = 32<1^3j<^ = 3_2i6^ 8216^3 
^'4886 4x8 8x6 4x8 3x6 2 

III. Before performing any operations of addition or 
subtraction, all multiplications and divisions must be 
performed, and complex and compound fractions must 
be reduced to simple fractions. 



108 



FRACTIONS. 



[Chap. IV. 



'3 4 6 4 3^4x6 4 

"§"*" 8 "^4 24 24-^^- 

It is a very common mistake to work a question of this kind as 
if it meant (|+j)of(j + j). 



Simplify: 

2- i + ixf 

3- i + l + f 

6. li + f-!-2i. 

6. H + ix2i. 

7. i + f xW + f 

8- A -<- * X VV + 3f 

9. 6|x4| + 6i + 2|. 

10. i + ^ofVV- 

11. ^ofl + V^. 

12. |of3i-i-f 

13. -^of3f + 2f 

14. 2i + l|of3i. 



BXAMPIiBS XXXTX. 



Written BzeroUe*. 



16. 284f of H -!- 17|f . 

16. iV+Hof^iofif 

17. I of I -*■ 13^ of f 

18. 4f of If ^- 4| of 2J. 

19. 2i-i-fof|| + % 

20. li + 3ioffx6J. 

21. 2i + lfoflTV-i-lTfe. 

22. ^ + |off-|. 

23. ^of^ + f-f. 

24. i_iofi-i. 
26. lofi-ioff 

26. 2| + liof2i-3f 

27. 2^ of H + 2^ of 3J. 

28. 3| - ,1^ of 2i - If 



29. I of 3f - 2i of A of 2T«r. 

30. l^of| + 3J-A- 

31. I of 2| - 4^ of 6f -t- 2^ of 3^. 



Abt. 128.] EXAMPLES. 109 

32. | + l|of2|-i-!-^. 

33. 3i0flTlj + 7i-n + |0f^. 

34. (f + gof2|_|)-.3m. 



36. 



86. 



87. 



2^ - 1 of If 
iofSi + H 

i + lif • 2 + 1 






39. 



2i-iofH + i 



12& To express one number or quantity as a fraction of 
another, we proceed as follows : 

Ex. 1. Express 174 as a fraction 0/I88. 

Now 1 = xH ot 188 ; 

.-. 174 = III of 188 
= ff of 188. 

Ex. 2. Express 2| dollars as a fraction ofS dollars. 
Now 1 dollar = } of 8 dollars ; 

.'.2^ dollars = -^^ of 8 dollars 

^ 8 

= ^i^ of 8 dollars. 

That number or quantity which is the part must be the numerator, 
while the other number must be the denominator, of the required 
fraction. 



110 FRACTIONS. [Chxp. IV. 

BXAMPIiBS Xli. 
Oral Exercises* 

1. Express 27 as a fraction of 81. 

2. Express 140 pounds as a fraction of 280 pounds. 

What fraction of 

3. 9 is 3? 6. 49 is 7? 9. 9 is2i? 

4. 11 is 7? 7. 56 is 49? 10. 16 is 2^? 
6. 20 is 5? 8. 88 is 4? 11. 2\is^? 

Written Exercises. 

12. How many times does 8^ feet contain 2| feet ? 

13. Express ^ of 4 dollars as a part of 7 dollars. 

14. Reduce 2\ of 11 cents to the fraction of 5^ of 15 
cents. 

15. What would be the measure of ^ of 23 tons, if ^ of 
4 tons were used as the unit ? 

16. If the income of A is i^ of ^ of 1260 dollars, and the 
income of B is ^ of -g^ of 5440 dollars, how large is A's 
income compared with B's ? How large is B's income 
compared with A's ? 

What fraction of 



17. (8-2 + 3)(6+7-3^is2«? 

18. ^^^ •^'^ is 4[6- {11 -(3 + 11)1 + 21? 

K20|-6|-2) ■- ^ ^^^ ■• 

,^ 488x11-1 of 75 00 . ,^ .,, o n* i T^Tr-p 
^' 32x5+1 is(6+14)-^|of J^xi22-5. 

129. Reduction of Decimals to Common Fractions. 

Decimals may be considered as fractions with powers 
of 10 for denominators. 

Thus, .6 = T^^^ ; M = ^s%; .002007 = y^^Vyft^. 



Artb. 129, 130.] REDUCTION TO DECIMALS. HI 

Ex. I. Beduce .76 to a common fraction. 

•78 = T^ = If 

Ex. 2. Beduce 4.012 to a mixed number. 

4.012 = 4 4- tMt = 4rfzr- 

130. Reduction of Common Fractions to Decimals. 

Ex. 1. Express ^ as a decimal. 

Since ^ may be considered as the quotient obtained by dividing 
4 by 25, we have only to perform this division. Thus, 

26)4.00(.16 
26 

1 50 
150 

Ex. 2. Beduce t to 3 places of decimals, the common fractions j 
}, il, and f ; and thus show that the fractions are in ascending 
order of magnitude. 

The decimals required are .75, .854..., and .857.... 

EXAMPLES XLI. 



Oral Ezercite*. 






Beduce to decimals : 








1. i. 4. |. 


7. f. 


10. 


f 


2. \. 5. •. 


8. if. 


11. 


*. 


3. i. «. f 


9. |. 


12. 


tt- 



Written Exercises. 

14- Hi- ". T^. 20. tV- 23. ISriJiV^nr- 
16. tIt- 18. V^ir- 21. 3tHv. 



112 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

Circulating Decimals. 

13L We have hitherto considered examples of division 
of decimals in which by proceeding far enough an exact 
quotient is found with no remainder. This, however, is 
by no means always the case ; in fact, it is very rarely 
the case. 

Consider, for example, the division of 6 by 3. 

315.0000 



1.6666... 

We may here continue the process of division to any extent, but 
each figure of the quotient will be 6, and the remainder will always 
be 2. 

Again, divide 2 by 7. 

7 12.000000000 
.285714286... 

Here the six digits, 2, 8, 5, 7, 1, 4, come over and over again in 
the same order, and we shall never arrive at a stage at which there 
is no remainder. 

When a decimal ends with digits which are repeated 

over and over again without end in the same order, the 

decimal is called a Recurring or Circulating decimal, and 

the digit, or set of digits, which is repeated, is called the 

Circulating Period, called also the Repetend. 

Thus, 2.45655..., .014141414..., and 6.1246246246... are circu- 
lating decimals with circulating periods of one, two, and three 
figures, respectively. 

A circulating period is denoted by placing dots over 
the first and last of the figures which recur. 

Thus, 2.45 denotes 2.45665..., .0i4 denotes .014141414..., and 
6.1246 denotes 5.1246246246... 

A circulating decimal is said to be Pure or Mixed, 
according as all the figures after the decimal point do or 
do not recur. 



Art. 131.] EXAMPLES. 118 

■ • • • • 

Thus, 5.6, 31.24, and 14.135 are pure circulating decimals ; and 
.56, 3.124, and .14135 are mixed circulating decimals. 

A decimal which contains a definite number of figures 
is called a Terminating decimal, to distinguish it from a 
circulating decimal, which contains an unlimited number 
of figures.' 

Note. Although it is not possible to reduce any common frac- 
tion to a terminating decimal, it is always possible to find a decimal 
which is equal to the common fraction to any degree of accuracy 
that may he required. 

For example, ^ lies between .333 and .334, so that the difference 
between \ and .333 is less than one one-thousandth, so also the 
difference between | and .333333 is less than one one-millionth; 
and so on. 

Now there is no species of magnitude which can be measured 
with perfect accuracy. It would, for instance, be difficult to deter- 
mine the length or the weight of a body without a possible error as 
great as one one-thousandth of the whole. Hence the measure of 
any quantity can be expressed as accurately by means of decimals 
as by means of fractions. 

EXAMPLES XLn. 
Written Exercises. 

Express the following quotients as circulating decimals : 

1. 1.5-^2.7. 4. .035 -h. 072. 7. 3.1-5-7. 

2. 10-f-.03. 5. .316-^2.4. 8. 15.6 -5- .07. 

3. 1.7-^.09. 6. .312 -^ 8.8. 9. 1.25-?- 13.2. 

10. 5.193 -5- .0168. 13. .3157 -i- .259. 

11. .0235-^.00616. 14. 27.31 -f. 6.475. 

12. 16.72 -^ .0143. 16. 693.11 -^ .011396. 

.Reduce the following common fractions to circulating 
decimals : 

16. |. 18. f 20. ^. 22. j^. 

17. f 19. ^. 21. W. 23. ^. 



114 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

24. 2^. 26. 5^. 28. 11^^. 30. 2f|f. 

25. 3H-. 27. 7^. 29. 13^^^, 31. 5^. 

132. Reduction of a Circulating Decimal to an Equivalent 

Common Fraction. 

• 

We have seen (Art. 129) that a terminating decimal can 
be expressed as a common fraction. We have now to show 
that a circulating decimal may be expressed as a common 
fraction. 

• • • • • • 

Consider the decimals, .31, .6216, and .15607. 

In each case multiply the decimal by that power of 10 which will 
move the decimal point to the end of the first recurring period ; also 
(if necessary) multiply the decimal by that power of 10 which will 
move the decimal point to the beginning of the first recurring period. 
Subtract the second product from the first, and notice the result. 

(i) 



M 


X 


100 


= 31.^1 


• • 

.31 


X 


1 


= .31 


• • 

.31 


X 


99 


= 31. 




* 
• • 


• • 

.31 


31 
99 



No advantage will be gained by repeating the .31 in the minuend 
or subtrahend ; we obtain only an integer in the remainder. 

(ii) .5216 X 10000 = 5216.6216 
.6216 X 1 = .5216 



.6216 X 9999 = 5216. 
. •. .6216 = 



(iii) .15607 x 100000 = 15607.607 
.15607 X 100 = 15.607 

.15607 X 99900 = 15592. 

.-. .15607 = J1 



Art. 132.] CIRCULATING DECIMALS. US 

Three facts concerning the fraction equivalent to a cir- 
culating decimal are easily noted ; 

1. The numerator is the whole decimal minus the number 
expressed by the non-recurring digits. 

2. The number of 9's in the denominator equals the 
number of recurring digits. 

3. The number of naughts in the denominator equals the 
number of non-recurring digits. 

Ex.1. .6 = 4. Ex.3. .166 = if J = ^. 

Ex. 2. .07 = A. Ex. 4. 3.3i2 = 3f J^ = 3JJJ. 

It should be noticed that by the above rule .9 = f = 1. This 
result can be seen independently ; for the differences between 1 and 
the decimals, .9, .99, .999, etc., are respectively .1, .01, .001, etc., 
each difference being one-tenth of the preceding, and therefore 
when a large number of nines is taken, the difference between 1 and 
.99999... becomes inconceivably small. 

• • • 

Since .9 = 1, .09 = .1, .009 = .01, and so on, a recurring 9 
can always be replaced by 1 in the next place to the left ; for 
example, .79 = .8 and .249 = .25. 

EXAMPLES XLIII. 
Written Exercises. 

Find common fractions in their lowest terms equivalent 
to the following circulating decimals : 



1. 


.3. 


7. 


.185. 


13. 


.04878. 


2. 


.09. 


8. 


.396. 


14. 


.07317. 


3. 


17.27. 


9. 


.142857. 


16. 


9.23. 


4. 


.15. 


10. 


.285714. 


16. 


.79. 


6. 


1.027. 


11. 


.428571. 


17. 


6.36. 


6. 


.037. 


12. 


.012987. 


18. 


.3i6, 



116 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

19. .116. 23. .2027. 27. 11.3021976. 

20. .0254. 24. .19324. 28. .5428571. 

21. .016. 25. .402439. 29. .012345679. 

22. .749. 26. .304878. 30. .135802469. 

It should be noticed that if a common fraction in its 
lowest terms be equivalent to a terminating decimal, the 
denominator of the fraction can contain only the prims 
factors 2 and 5. 

133. Addition, Subtraction, Multiplication, and Division 

of circulating decimals are performed after first reducing 
to common fractions. The answer in each case should 
be reduced to a circulating decimal. 

134. An exact divisor of a number is sometimes called 
an Aliquot Part of the number. 

2^ is an aliquot part of 10 ; 16} is an aliquot part of 100. 

This enables us to use a short process of multiplication 
(or division) in cases where the multiplier (or divisor) is 
an aliquot part of some power of 10. 

To X 3J, X 10 and h- 3. To -j- 3J, ^ 10 and x 3. 

To X 12 i, X 100 and -f- 8. To -f- 12^, -s- 100 and x 8. 

To X 16|, X 100 and -^6. To -4- 16|, -^ 100 and x 6. 

To X 26 , X 100 and -5-4. To -j- 26 , -;- 100 and x 4. 

To X 33J, X 100 and -^3. To -r- 33|, ^ 100 and x 3. 

To X 126, X 1000 and -j- 8. To -^ 126, -*- 1000 and x 8. 

Read the signs * multiply by ' and * divide by '. 

135. Square Roots of Fractions. 

G- .. /SV 3x3 3^ 

it follows conversely that 

9 ^3^ V9. 
16 4 V16 



Vi 



Arts. 133-135.] SQUARE ROOT. HJ 

Thus, the square root of a common fra/stion is equal to a 
fra^ction whose numerator and denominator are respectively 
the square roots of the numerator and denominator of the 
given fraction. 

Ex. 1. Find the square roots 0/ jJJ, 1^^, .4, and 2.086419763. 
jl44^,,^144^12. VlA=^.'?5 = :sZ25^5. 
\169 Vl^9 13' ^' \16 Vl^ 4' 

^- \9-V9^3' 

and V2.686419763 = V2^^VWW = ^^t 

_ /169 _ V169 _ 13 __ . ; 
"\ 81" V81 "T"" 

Ex. 2. Find^ to four places of decimals, 

(0 VI' ("> aI' ("') ^•^' *""* (*'^ ^ 

(i) -J- = ^ = - v'5, which can be found as in Art. 88. 

(ii) In examples in which the denominator is not a perfect 
square, the fraction should be expressed as a decimal. In the 

present case -*/- = ^^.8 = ..., etc. 

(iii) .3 = .33'33'83'33' ... Then proceed as in Art. 88. 

(iv) A. = _^2<js^ = 6^ = ..., etc. 
^ ^ V3 V3XV3 3^ 

The change of form from -^ to | V^ will save labor. 

•y/O 3 

EXAMPLES XLIV. 
Written ExeroiseB. 

Find the square roots of 

1- T^f- 3- iff- 6. 39tV. 7. .004. 

2. 1^. 4. 11^. 6. .i. 8. .134. 

9. 1.36i. 10. 4.38204. 



118 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

Find, to four places of decimals, the square roots of 

11. ^. 13. 3^. 15. 2.4. 17. .083. 

12. ^. 14. 8f 16. .041. 18. 3.5i62. 

136. The H.C.F. and L.C.M. of Fractions. 

By the H.C.F. of two or more fractions we mean a frac- 
tional H.C.F. The qiLotients, however, are integral. 

A fraction -f- a fraction = an integer only when the numerator 
and denominator of the dividend divided by the numerator and 
denominator of the divisor respectively, produce an integer and 
the reciprocal of an integer ; thus, 

27 81 \ 

Here, 14 -s- 2 is an integer, and 27 -s- 81 is the reciprocal of an 
integer; i.e., the numerator of the divisor is a factor and the 
denominator of the divisor is a multiple ; also, the numerator of 
the dividend is a multiple, and the denominator of the dividend is 
a factor. 

Hence, the H.C.F. of two or more fractions must have for Us 
numerator the H.C.F, of the given numerators^ and for its denom- 
inator the L.C.M. of the given denominators. 

Also, the L.C.M. of two or more fractions must have for its 
numerator the L. CM. of the given numerators^ and for its denom- 
inator the H.C.F. of the given denominators. 

Note. Before obtaining the H.CF. or the L.C.M., the given 
fractions must be in their lowest terms, and mixed numbers 
must be reduced to improper fractions. The L.C.M. may be 
integral. 

r The H.C.F. of I and H = :,iV ; 
\ The L.C.M. of f and ^^ = i^. 

r The H.C.F. of f and { = ^ ; 
\ The L.C.M. of j and ^^ = 6, 



Art. 136.] EXAMPLES. 119 

EXAMPLES XLV. 
Written Exercises. 

Find H.C.F. and L.C.M. of 

1. |,^,ajidij^. 4. ^,||,aiid||. 

2. A, ^V. and If 5. |2jaiid|i^. 

3. iii, and^. 6. ^andl|^. 

7. 1^, T%, and 39^^. 

EXAMPLES XLVI. 
Miscellaneous Examples. Chap. IT. 

1. Reduce 5^, 8^, and 25^ to improper fractions. 

2. Simplify 1-1 + A- A + A- A- 

3. What must be added to 5 J that the sum may- 
be 12f ? 



4. Multiply 2| of 5f by 3| -5- 6f 

5. Simplify ?tlliAi±A. 



6. Arrange, in ascending order of magnitude, the 
fractions, ^, |, ^, |f . 

7. From the sum of ^ and ^ take the difference be- 
tween \ and ^. 

8. Simplify 2| of 4f of 5|. 

9. Simplify ei+fLii X T^. 

10. What fraction of 350 equals f of 168 ? 

11. Reduce 4^^f and ffH^ *^ *^®^^ lowest terms. 

12. Reduce to a common denominator 3^, -g^, ^^, 
and yl^. 



120 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

13. Simplify 3| + 2| of 1^ - 4^. 

14. Simplify t'ttt"^ ' 

15. A and B started on a tour with 192 and 156 dollars 
respectively, and they had equal sums left at the end. 
A spent ^ of his money ; what fraction did B spend of his ? 



16. Add ^V, ^, Aj T^, ^, and ^. 

17. Subtract 5ff from 7^ ; also, 5f + 2f from 12J. 

18. Divide 2^^ + 2f| - 3^ by 2^ + 3i - 4^. 
,o Q- v^ H + 2Jof5^-12| 

20. What is the value of f of a property, if | of it is 
worth 750 dollars ? 

21. Keduce ffj^, \^^, and |^f to their lowest 
terms. 

22. Show that \-\-- — \ — - + ^ ^ T — =— ;: is less 

2^2x3x4 2x3x4x5x6 

than -j^, but greater than ■^, 

23. Simplify f|| x f f X fj- 

25. Find the G.C.M. of b\ and 4| ; express the answer 
as a circulating decimal and obtain the square root. 

26. Simplify ^ + | + f + |-J/--2V. 

27. Subtract 2|f from 5^, and 8Jf from 12^. 

28. Multiply 3\ of 5^^ by 4^ of f , and divide the result 
by ^ of If 



Art. 136.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 121 

«,. Simplify l±|.j§j,a.d^-^|f=fi^. 

30. Find the L.C.M. of ^ and |. 

31. By how much does the sum of 1^, f, and ^^ fall 
short of the sum of ^, ^, J, and |-J- ? 

32. Simplify2i-iof4^ + 2J^3ix2J-^. 

33. How many pieces each f of 1 inch can be cut from 
a wire whose length is 5^ inches ; and what will be the 
length of the piece left over ? 

34. Simplify ^j ^Sj + 5^ __ llf - 5^ 

35. Find L.C.M. and H.C.F. of ^, -J^^, and yf^^- 



36. Take the sum of f and ^ from the sum of f and ^. 

37. After taking away ^ and | of a certain quantity, 
what fraction of the whole will be left ? 

38. Multiply 1^ + 3| by 3^ + 2^, and divide the result 
by 5 J of 5f . 

39. Simplify ^H^ A o^4^ + 3H^7f 

P ^ 3,^ofl0^-3i^4| 

40. Find the value of 3^ of 44 of 11 of ^. 



41. Add ^, II, ^, tI^, and ^f^. 

5 



42. Simplify 



V3 



43. Simplifv ^ » ? J^, and 



2+ 1 



3-i 



122 FRACTIONS. [Chap. IV. 

44. There are three partners in a certain business, one 
of whom provided ^ of the whole capital, and another 
provided f . What fraction of the whole was supplied 
by the third partner ? 

45. A man gives J of his money to his wife, \ of the 
remainder to his son, and \ of what then remains to his 
daughter ; and has still left a sum of 1350 dollars. How 
much was there at first ? 

1~^- 

^^' ^^^P^^^ 9|-6X+7V ^^^jf— 1^' 

2 + i 

47. Divide IJ of 5| by 2f of 7^^^. 

48. Simplify iizi^i±^ ^ ll^LZ^. 

49. Find the value of J of f of 5 dollars - -f of | of 2 
dollars, and express the difference as a fraction of 11.25 
dollars. 



50. Reduce to its simplest form 

61. After spending ^ of his money, a man found that 
^ of the remainder was 63 cents ; how many cents had he 
at first ? 

52. I purchased some square tiles for a room 483 
inches long and 266 inches broad ; the manufacturer sent 
me the largest tiles I could use ; how long was each tile ? 

53. A man travelled f of a certain distance by railway, 
-^ of the whole distance by coach, and walked the rest 
of the way, which was 15 miles. What was the length of 
the whole journey ? 



Art. 136.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 123 

54. By what must 7f of 3| be multiplied that the prod- 
uct may equal 4f of 2f ? 

56. Simplify 6f - ^ of 15f + 2^^!^. factor the 

I of 7f - 5| -5- 3^ 

answer into two fractions so that one factor shall be a 

perfect square. 

56. Find the H.C.F. and the L.C.M. of ^ and ^, 

57. Subtract 10|| from 23f, and 15|f from 20||. 

58. Simplify (3| + 2^ + ^) ^ (^ + |) of (^ - f). 

59. Simplify 

(i) l-|xi-i — ^ 



(4^ - 2i) -s- (3i - H)' '^ '' 2i 



4-f 

60. A man gives away f of his money and afterwards 
^ of the remainder. What fraction of the whole had he 
then left ? 

61. Eeduce to a common denominator, and arrange in 
order of magnitude the fractions, -^^ ^, ^, ^, \^. 

62. Multiply the difference between 3^ of 1-j^ + 7^ 
and 21 -^ 4 of tA- by the sum of — and — 

63. Simplify | of ^in^ ^ K^ + lff) , 

64. After spending f of his money, a boy found that ^^ 
of the remainder was 2^ dollars. What had he at first ? 

65. Eeduce to their lowest terms |^, -J-ff^, and 

28907 
15V2 41- 

66. A gave ^ of his marbles to B, ^ to C, | to D, ^ 
to E, and then had 105 left. How many did each 
receive ? 



124 



FRACTIONS. 



[Chaps. IV., V. 



67. Fiiid2||of{2M-^of(3iof2|-5|)ofH-^{ 



68. 64 feet of brass rods cost 12^ cents a foot; what 
was tlie cost of the rods ? 



69. 

J. S. Gushing & Co. 



Nashville, Tenn., Jan. 1, 1896. 
To H. A. Armstrong, Dr, 



For 2 lb. Sugar @ 7 cents 

" 6 " Tea « 50 " 

" 11 " Coffee " 34 « 

" i7 " Starch « 14 " 



Find the amount of the above bill ; answer in dollars 
and cents, letting 100 cents equal one dollar. 

What would be the answer in dollars, and the decimal 
of a dollar ? 

70. Find the H.C.F. and L.C.M. of 1.485 and 12.6. 

71. Simplify ^H^^XH 

^ ^ 8^x32x34 

72. Add, without changing positions: 67.04, 12, 6^, 
9^, 4.17, 243^, 14, 8^. 

73. A certain lake is .327 of a mile long; what is its 
length compared with the length of a second lake 2^ miles 
long? 

(Answer must be reduced to a circulating decimal.) 

74. Three tanks contain 924, 1500, and 2520 gallons of 
water respectively ; what is the largest number of gallons 
that can run from each of the tanks per minute and allow 
all to be emptied in a whole number of minutes, the rate 
of flow from each tank being the same? How many 
minutes are required to empty each tank ? 



Akts. 137, 138.] MAGNITUDE — QUANTITY. 126 



CHAPTER V. 

DECIMAL MEASURES. 

137. Anything which, can be increased or diminished 
is called a Magnitude. 

Lengths, areas, weights, etc., are magnitudes. 

To measure a magnitude is to compare it with some 
known magnitude of the same kind, which is taken as 
a unit, and to say how many times the unit must be 
repeated in order to make up the magnitude in question, 

For example, to measure any given length of string, is to find 
how many times some known length, say a foot, must be repeated 
to make up the given length ; and this number of times is called 
the measure of the length. 

A measured magnitude is called a Quantity. 
Thus, any quantity is expressed by a number and a 
unit of the same kind as itself, 

13& Numbers are first used in connection with distinct 
objects, and are afterwards used in measuring continuous 
magnitudes of any kind. If the continuous magnitude 
cannot be measured by one unit, a series of units smaller 
and smaller in value may be used. 

For example, to measure a string, some definite length, say a 
yard, is fixed on as a unit. Suppose the given string contains 
6^ yards. We may use a second unit, say a foot, to measure the 



126 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. V. 

i yard. If there are 3 feet in one yard, the J yard will be IJ feet, 
and the string will measure 6 yards 1^ feet. This ^ foot may be 
expressed in a smaller unit still, say an inch ; if there are 12 inches 
in a foot, the \ foot will be 6 inches, and the string will measure 
6 yards 1 foot 6 inches. 



). Quantities expressed in terms of a single unit 
are called Simple Quantities, and quantities whicli are 
expressed in terms of more than one unit are called 
Compound Quantities. 

To measure every different kind of quantity, some 
standard unit is employed, and also other units whicli 
are obtained by subdivisions and repetitions of the 
standard unit. 

Units which require 10 of one to make one of the next 
higher are the simplest to use. Such units are called 
Decimal Units. 

In numeration of quantities, units of different kinds 
are called units of different denominations. 

Tables op Decimal Units. 

140.^ Table of United States Money. 

Money is a measure of values. 

10 mills (m.) = 1 cent (ct.). 
10 cts. = 1 dime (d.). 

10 d. =1 dollar (f ). 

10 f =1 eagle (e.). 

The eagle is usually called ten dollars, and the dime is 
usually called ten cents; so that the only names generally 
used are dollars and cents. 

* It is advisable to study numeration and notation of decimal 
measures at the same time. 



Arts. 139-143.] - U. S. COINS. 127 

Thus, $25.35 is read, * 25 dollars 35 cents,* and not, * 2 eagles 
5 dollars 3 dimes 5 cents ' ; also, $.20 is read, * 20 cents.' 

The notation is as follows : 

The figure representing eagles is put in tens' place, 
** ** dollars " *' units' place, 

** *' dimes *' " tenths' place, 

** ** cents ** " hundredths' place, 

" " mills ** '* thousandths' place. 

141. A sum of money represented in any denomina- 
tion may be represented in higher denominations by 
moving the decimal point to the left, one place for each 
denomination. A reduction is made to lower denomina- 
tions by moving the decimal point to the right ; thus, 

6742 mills = 67.42 dimes = 6.742 dollars ; 
4671 dollars = 46.71 cents = 467.1 mills. 

142. We have already shown how to perform the 
operations of addition, subtraction, multiplication, and 
division of decimals ; and the application of these rules 
to sums of money will require no further explanation, 
except to state that in cases of addition and subtraction 
care must be used in writing units of the same denomina- 
tion in the same vertical column. This is not a necessity 
— only a convenience. 

143. The coins in use are as follows : 

Gold coins : the dollar, the quarter-eagle, the kalf-ea^gle, 
the ea^le, and the double-eagle. 

Silver coins: the dollar, the half-dollar, the quarter- 
dollar, and the dime. 

Nickel coin : the Jive-cent piece. 

Bronze coin : the cent 

The mill is used only in computation. 



128 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. V. 

EXAMPLES XLVII. 
Written £xercigeg. 

1. Write tlie following in figures : two dollars thirteen 
cents, sixty dollars forty cents, three hundred dollars two 
cents, sixteen cents, six cents, three cents five mills. 

2. Add $14.15, $37.24, $156.50, $.75, and $1204.06. 

3. Add $2.04, 26.7 ct, 49.62 m., and 4.338 ct. 

4. By how much is $1507.45 greater than $1429.78 ? 

5. After spending $145.45 a man had $13.55 left; 
how much had he at first? 

6. A man had originally $1345.40. How much had 
he left after paying away $135.25, $416.67, and $575.48 ? 

7. What will 250 barrels of apples cost at $2.75 per 
barrel ? 

8. A man bought 150 horses at $125 each. He sold 
50 at $145 each and the rest at $137.50 each. How 
much did he gain ? 

9. What is the value of 1400 bushels of wheat at 67 
ct. a bushel ? 

10. A man bought 1250 bushels of oats at 38^ ct. a 
bushel, and 1500 bushels of wheat at 65^ ct. a bushel. 
What was the whole cost ? 

11. A man bought 15 pounds of cheese at $.14 a 
pound, 9 pounds of coffee at $.25 a pound, and 13 
pounds of butter at 18 ct. a pound. How much did the 
whole cost? 

12. Two men had between them $1595, and one had 
$155 more than the other. How much had each ? 



Art. 144.] THE METRIC SYSTEM. 129 

13. Multiply $684.93 by 6.75. 

(Give answer to two decimal places, remembering that 5 or 
more mills increase the number of cents by one ; anything under 
5 mills is not considered.) 

14. Multiply $71.41 by .23. 

15. Divide $5687.98 by 27.3. 

(Be sure in the answer to find out whether or not the mills will 
be as many as five.) 

16. A man spent $4.86 in buying beef at $.09 per 
pound. How many pounds did he buy ? 

17. A man bought wheat at 64 ct. a bushel, and spent 
$736 altogether. How many bushels did he buy ? 

18. How many d. in $560.1 ? 

19. How many e. in $270? 

20. How many m. in $41.90 ? 

21. How many ct. in 86420 m. ? 

22. How many $ in 86420 m. ? 

23. Divide 784 d. by 2.75, and write the answer as e. 

24. Multiply $76 by .0025; of what denomination 
is the answer ? 

The Metric System. 

144. In almost all civilized countries, the United 
States and England being unfortunately exceptions, the 
different weights and measures have been arranged on 
the decimal system. 

In France, Belgium, and Switzerland all sums of 
money are expressed in terms of the Franc, with its sub- 
unit the Centime (yj^ of a franc). In Italy, Spain, 
and Greece the standard unit of money is of exactly 
the same value as the franc, but is called by different 
names. 



130 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. V. 

In Germany the standard unit is the Mark, with its 
sub-unit the Pfennig; (y^^ of a mark). 

In Austria the standard unit is the Gulden, with its 
sub-unit the Kreutzer (y^ of a gulden). 

In the United States the Metric System is used in 
scientific investigations and is authorized to be used in 
the Mint and Post Office. 

145. In the Metric System of weights and measures, 
the fundamental unit is called a Meter. The meter is 
approximately the one ten-millionth part of the distance 
from the equator to the north pole. (A slight error was 
made in obtaining the meter, but its length remains as at 
first calculated.) 

The standard units of area^ volume, capacity, and weight 
are derived from the meter. 

Decimal divisions of a standard unit are distinguished 
by the Latin prefixes deci-, centi-, milli-. 

Decimal multiples of a standard unit are distinguished 
by the Greek prefixes dekory hekto-y kilo-, myrior. 

Tables op Decimal Units. — Continued, 

146. Table of Linear Measures. 

Length is distance in a straight line between two 
points. 
The unit of linear measure is a meter. 

10 millimeters (mm) = 1 centimeter (cm). 

10*™ =1 decimeter (dm). 

10*™ =1 meter (m). 

10° =1 dekameter (Dm). 

10^™ =1 hektometer (Hm). 

10^™ = 1 kilometer (Km). 

10^° =1 myriameter (Mm). 



Arts. 145-148.] 



LINEAR MEASURES. 



181 



If the figure representing meters is put in units' place, 
then ** " dm " ** tenths' place, 

" ** cm u u hundredths' place, 

• " " Dm " »' tens' place, 

" ** Hm ** ** hundreds' place, etc. 



147. Length represented in any denomination may- 
be represented in higher denominations by moving the 
decimal point to the left, one place for each denomina- 
tion; a reduction is made to lower denomi- 
nations by moving the decimal point to the 
right; thus. 



14.45^ 

1256.4 cm 
2 Km 

24.6 Hm 



144.5 dm 

12.564 "» 

200 o™ 
2.46 Km 



14450™"; 
1.2564 Dm J 

20000 dm; 

.246 Mm. 



The same methods are used in operations here as 
in decimals [Arts. 29 and 49]. Units of the same 
denomination should be in the same vertical column. 

The teacher should have a meter stick, properly 
graduated, and keep it constantly before the class. 
Not a word should be said about any other linear 
measure, known or unknown to the class. 

148. Figures representing decimal measures 
of any kind are read just as figures represent- 
ing integral and decimal numbers are read, 
and then the name of the denomination repre- 
sented is read ; thus, 

14.45m is read 'fourteen and forty-five hundredths 

meters,' (which means the same as if it were read * one 

dekameter four meters four decimeters and five 

centimeters'). 

.246 Km ig read *two hundred foi*ty-six thousandths 
kilometers.' 





I ': 


- 




* : 


- 




5 : 


- 


• 

o 
o 

i-H 


U : 


- 


II 

o 

1-i 


5 : 


- 


II 

B 


^ : 


- 


•3 


7 : 


■ 




8 


■ 




9 \ 


■ 




10 ': 


■ 



182 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. V. 

EXAMPLES XLVIIL 
Written £xerciseg. 

1. Cut from cardboard a narrow strip, 1*™ long, and 
mark it accurately into tenths and hundredths. 

2. Obtain the measure of the length of a book, and 
state the answer in dm and mm. 

3. Mark your height on the wall, and obtain its 
measure in m ; also in dm. 

4. Measure a room in m; obtain length, breadth, and 
height. 

5. Express 25™ as Dm ; as Mm ; as cm ; as mm. 

6. Write 126.73^™ as m; as Km; as dm; as mm. 

7. Add 14™, 6*™, 5027™™, and 6.5^™. Answer in m. 

8. Find the number of Dm in 12.62»*™ + 4267™4- 
845«™. 

9. How much longer is a room 12.65™ than a room 
106*™ long? 

10 . Find 8469 ™ + 46892 ™™ - 468 ^™ -f 12 *™ - 186 ^™ in m. 

11. Multiply 78.6*™ by 125. Answer in m; also in 
Hm. 

12. Four m of ribbon cost 16f ct. per m; find total 
cost [Theorem I, Art. 47 ; also Art. 50]. The answer is 
what fractional part of $1 ? 

13. Divide 7469™™ by 11. Answer in three denomi- 
nations. 

149. Table of Surface Measures (Square Measures). 
That which has length and breadth, but no thickness, 
is called a Surface; thus. 

The surface of a book has length and breadth. 



Arts. 149, 160.] SQUARE MEASURES. 



138 



A portion of a surface bounded by lines is called a 
Figure. 

A plane figure bounded by four equal sides, 
and whose four angles are equal, is called a 
Square. 
Any square may be used as a unit of surface 
measure ; for instance, a square centimeter, or a square 
meter. 



Square 
Centimeter. 



100 square 


millimeters 


(qmm) — 1 sq. centimeter (qcm). 


j^OO^m 






= 1 . " decimeter (qdm). 


j^QQqdm 






= 1 " meter (qm). 


100*1° 






= 1 " dekameter (qDm). 


100 ^"^ 






= 1 " liektometer(qHm). 


100 ^Hm 






= 1 " kilometer (qKin). 



For Land Survetino. 
l*!™ is called a centar (ca). 

IqHm « cc a licktar (Ha). 
Sq. cm, etc., are often used instead of qcm, etc. 

150. It is evident from the figure that, if one square 

is 10 times as long as .« . , , .*, 

, ^ 10 units long. I unit long. 

another, its surface is 100 r ■ . ■ i i i i i i » i r-i 
times as large; there- 
fore, 

A surface represented 
in any denomination may 
be represented in higher 
denominations by moving 
the decimal point to the 
left, two places for each 
denomination; a reduction is made to lower denomina- 





















— 






































— 











































































































































184 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. V. 

tions by removing the decimal point to the right, two 
decimal places for each denomination; thus, 

15.e<Jn» =.166<iDmj l0626«J«»n» = 1.0626Qdm ; 12*=.12H». 
1.49q<lin := 149qcm J 1.00251H™ =106254™; 1.6* =160<«. 

16.64m is read * fifteen and six-tenths square meters.' 



EXAMPLES XLIX. 
Written Exerciges. 

1. Cut from cardboard a piece to represent one qdm, 
and mark it accurately into qcm. 

2. How many qcm in ^ a qdm ? How many in the 
square of ^ a dm ? 

3. Mark out on the floor a qm. What would that be 
called if it were marked on the ground ? 

4. Write SO**™ I5<idm 21i«n ^ qj^; as qHm'; as qmm. 

5. Express SI**"* as qcm; 14.1*^™ as qdm; .5'*'" as qcm; 
120.7 <iKin as qm. 

6. Eead 15.14'*^ as qm ; as qcm. Eead l.!**^™ as 
qDm; as qmm. Eead 121* as ca; as Ha. 

7. Multiply 78.141'^™ by 16, and answer in qmm. 

8. Eepresent 15.6789^™ as qmm; 140'*=™ as qHm. 

9. In 1.49^*'" what might the .49 be called ? 

10. Eead IS-G**™ as qDm and qdm. 

11. Eepresent l**^", 12 ^H", 1% 4*1™™ as qm. 

12. Eead, stating the number of units of each denomi- 
nation represented, 167.08193 'i^™. 

13. Divide 78965 '*^™ by 5, and answer in qm. 

14. Add 167% 200^^'", 18.67^^", and 160003'>"™. 



CCBIC MEASURES. 



ig 400' is 2000*^ long; 



16. From 12.6' subtract 4". 
16. A piece of ground contain: 
what is its breadth ? 



15L Table of Volnme Heasnres (Cubic Measures). 

A solid bounded by six equal square sur- 
faces is called a Cube. 

Ani/ cube may be used as a unit of cubic 
measure ; for instance, a cubic centimeter or 
cmiimrtw. a cubic meter, 
1000 cubic millimeters (cmm) = 1 cubic centimeter (ecm), 
1000 "^ =1 cubic decimeter (cdm), 

1000 "^ =1 cubic meter {cu m). 

For measuring wood, 1 cubic meter is called a st«T (et). 

1^. It is evident from the figure that, if one cube is 

10 times as long as an- _^ 

other, its volume is 1000 
times as large; there- 
fore, 

A volume represented in 
any denomination may be 
represented in higher de- 
nominations by moving 
the decimal point to the 
left, three places for each 
denomination; areduction 
is made to lower denomi- 
nations by moving the 
decimal point to the right, three places for every denomi- 
nation. 

Thus, 4a78'^" = 4.«78'™"; 8.67"" = 8670000™. 

4.678='"" is read • four and aix hundred seventj-elght thousandths 
cubic meters,' which is equivalent to saying four cubic meters and 
six hundred seventy-eight cubic decimeters. 




10 vnltl Ions. 



136 



DECIMAL MEASUBES. 



[Chap. V. 



EXAMPLES L. 



Written Exercigeg. 



1. Cut from wood (or rubber, or cork) a piece to rep- 
resent 1"". 



/. -^ 



(Each student should carry in his 
pocket such a piece of wood, so that 
he can constantly refer to it.) 



y[ 



^ 



2. Cut from bristol board a 
piece shaped like the figure, 
having each of its six squares 
ld« long. Cut nearly through 
the cardboard in places repre- 
sented by dotted lines, and 
make small flaps as shown. 
Such pieces can be made into cubes ; a little mucilage on 
the flaps will keep the cubes in shape. Flaps should be 
out of sight in the finished cubes. 

3. Mark the sides of the cube into qcm and learn 
how many ccm, like the one in your pocket, would be 
required to make a block as large as the cardboard cube. 

4. How many ccm in ^ a cdm ? How many ccm in 
the cube of ^ a dm; i.e., in a cube 5*™ on an edge? 

5. Write 105^"™ 215*^° as cum; 27*^^" as cum. 

6. Eead 10.516 "^^ as cdm; as cDm. 

7. Eead 10067 ''*™ as st. 

8. Eead 100601.41^""^, stating the number of units of 
each denomination represented. 

9. Add 14.1'^""», 14.1^'", and 14.1«^™. 

10. Divide 14.4 "^^ by 12, and write the answer as ccm, 
and as cmm. 



Arts. 153, 164. ] LIQUID — WEIGHT. J 87 

153. Table of Volume Measures (Liquid Measures). 

The cubic decimeter is used as the unit of measure, 
and is called a Liter. 

10 milliliters (ml) = 1 centiliter (ol), 
10-^ = 1 deciliter (dl). 

10^ = 1 liter (1). 

10 » =1 dekaliter (Dl). 

10^1 =1 hektoliter (HI). 

10 H^ = 1 kiloliter (Kl), 

Comparing the above table with the one in Art, 151, 

we find that 

icdm ^ i\^ 

i ocm __ 1 ml 
j[oum_. -j^Kl 

EXAMPLES LI. 
Written Exeroisei. 

1. Add 4.5 ^ 2^\ 47 ^ and 673™'. 

2. Express the answer to Ex. 1 in Kl, HI, and cl. 

3. How many liters of water in 4""™? 

4. Change 46.0949'^' to 1; to ml; to dl; to ccm. 

6. Multiply .678®' by 2693; express the answer in 
cdm, and in cu m. 

154. Table of Measures of Weight. 

The attraction which the earth and any other body (on 
or off the earth) have for each other is called Gravity. 

The amount of this attraction is called the Weight of 
the body. 

The weight of 1**" of water is the unit of weight, and 
is called a Gram. 



138 DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chaps. V., VL 

10 milligrams (mg)= 1 centigram (eg). 

10 ** =1 deeigram (dg). 

10^ =lgram(g). 

10« = 1 dekagram (Dg). 

10^ = 1 hektogram (Hg). 

10^« = 1 kilogram (Kg). 

10"^ = 1 myriagram (Mg). 

10**« =1 quintal (Q). 

10<^ = 1 tonneau (T). 

Observe, in the case of water, that 

jmi (^iccm^ weighs 1«; 
11 (=:1«»"») weighs 1*«; 
1» (= icum^ weighs 1*^. 

155. Kilogram is called £[llo. Quintal is not often used. 

The cubic centimeter of water, which is used as the standard 
unit, must be distilled, must be at a temperature of 39.2° F. 
(4° C), and must be weighed in a vacuum at the level of the sea. 

EXAMPLES LII. 
Written Exercises. 

1. Read 64.95^ as dg, eg, mg, and Mg. 

2. Eead 1256 "« as Kg, Q, T, and g. 

3. What is the weight of 1""^ of standard water? Of 
10"^! ? Of 1^^ ? Of lO^'i ? Of 3*^ ? Of 31 ? Of 1000«" ? 

4. Iron is 7.8 times as heavy as water ; what is the 
volume (in cdm) of 29.25 ^k ? What is the weight of 2«'i°» ? 
Of 55'^ ? Of 7.2««" ? Of 1.67 <^'='"? Of 125~™ ? 

6. Find the value (in grams) of 4«k-18*« + 18« 
+ 67.896 ">« - 126.73^ + 4^ - 11.6 m«. 

6. Gold is 19.5 times as heavy as water; what is the 
weight of 1^^ ? Of one cubic meter ? 



Arts. 165^57.] NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. 139 



CHAPTER VI. 

NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. 

K The simplicity of calculations when using decimal 
measures is due to the facts that changes can be easily 
made from one denomination to another by moving the 
decimal point, and that several denominations can bs 
expressed together in one set of figures. 

In Non-Decimal measures, called also Denominate num- 
bers and Compound Quantities, a variety of divisors is 
used in the different tables in order to change from low 
denominations to higher ones ; also, it is unusual to ex- 
press several denominations together in one set of figures. 

For example, consider the case of the string mentioned in Art. 
138. There, 12 inches equal 1 foot, and 3 feet equal 1 yard ; and 
the length of the string must be expressed, not with the denom- 
inations together in one set of figures, but each denomination 
separately, — 6 yards, 1 foot, 6 inches. 

To express a compound (Art. 139) quantity, express the number 
of units of each denomination separately, indicating the denomi- 
nations, as in the above illustration. 

To read compound quantities, read them exactly as expressed. 

157. Table of Measures of Time. 

The Standard Unit of Time is the Mean Solar Day; 
that is, the mean interval between two successive pas- 
sages of the sun across the meridian of any place. A 
day is supposed to begin at midnight. 



140 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

60 seconds (sec.) = 1 minute (min.). 
60 min. = 1 hour (lir.). 

24 hr. = 1 day (da.). 

7 da. =1 week (wk.). 

365 da. = 1 common year (yr.) 

366 da. = 1 leap year. 

The year is divided into 12 months, called Calendar 
Months, which contain an unequal number of days, 
namely: January 31, February 28, March 31, April 
30, May 31, June 30, July 31, August 31, September 30, 
October 31, November 30, and December 31. 

Every fourth year contains 366 days, and is called Leap 
Year, and in these years February has 29 days. It is a 
Leap Year when the number of the year is exactly di- 
visible by 4 ; thus, 1896 wwfeS a Leap Year. 

The Solar Year contains 365 da. 5hr. 48 min. 46 sec, very 
nearly. Now it would clearly be very inconvenient to reckon by 
years which did not contain an exact number of days ; hence, as 
the Solar Year contains very nearly 365J days, we have 3 years 
(called Civil Years) of 366 days each, and then one year of 366 days. 
The Solar Year is, however, somewhat less than 365 J days, and the 
necessary correction is made by omitting three Leap Years in every 
400 years, the years which are not counted as Leap Years (although 
divisible by 4) are the years which end the Centuries, and are such 
that the number of the Century is not divisible by 4. Thus, 1800 
was not a Leap Year, and 1900 will not be a Leap Year ; the year 
2000 will, however, be a Leap Year. 

158.^ Reduction of Compound Quantities. 

The method by which a compound quantity can be 
expressed as a simple quantity will be seen from the 
following example. 

* The methods of reductions of compound quantities, also ad- 
dition, etc., will be illustrated by the use of the above table because 
the different units are familiar to all. 



Arts. 168-160.] COMPOUND ADDITION. 



141 



Ex. 

7 

168 
3 

171 
60 

10260 
12 

10272 min. 
60 



Eeduce 7 da. 3 hr. 12 min, 26 sec, to seconds. 
da. 3hr. 12 min. 26 sec. 



hr. 



616320 
26 

616346 sec. 



7 da. 
Adding the 3 hr., 7 da. 3 hr. 

171 hr. 
Adding 12 min., 171 hr. 12 min. 

10272 min. 
Adding 26 sec, 10272 mm. 26 sec. 



= 168 hr. 
171 hr. 
= 10260 min. 
= 10272 min. 
= 616320 sec. 
= 616346 sec. 



159. To reduce a Simple Quantity to a Compound Quantity. 

Ex. Beduce 14678 sec, to hr., min,, and sec. 

6,0 )1467,8 sec. Since 60 sec. make Imin., if we 

6j) )24,4 min. 38 sec. divide the number of sec. by 60, 

4 hr. 4 min. 38 sec. we shall obtain the number of min. 

equivalent to 14678 sec, i.e., 244 
min. , but shall have 38 sec over. We then divide the number of 
min. by 60 and obtain the number of hours with 4 min. over. 

160. Addition, Subtraction, Multiplication, and Division 
of Compound Quantities. 

It will be seen that no new principle is involved. 
Care, however, must always be taken in regard to the 
number of units of one denomination required to make 
one unit of the next higher. 

(a) Compound Addition [see Art. 142]. 

Ex. Find the sum of 14 da. 41 min. 11 sec, 121 da, 18 hr. 16 min. 
29 sec, 201 da, IS hr. 4 sec, and II hr. 2Smin. SO sec 

da. hr. rain. lec. 

14 41 11 

121 18 16 29 

201 13 4 

11 23 30 

387 19 21 14 



142 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

Here the sum of the seconds equals 74 = 1 min. 14 sec. ; write 
the 14 and carry the 1. The number of min. = 81 = 1 hr. 21 min. ; 
write the 21 and carry the 1. The number of hr. equals 43 = 1 da. 
19 hr. ; write the 19 and carry the 1. The numb^ of days = 337. 

(b) Compound Subtraction. 

Ex. From 16 da. 12 min, and 50 sec. subtract 4 da. 12 hr, 13 min. 
and 54 3ec. 



da. 


hr. 


min. 


iee. 


16 





12 


50 


4 


12 


13 


54 



11 11 58 56 

Here 54 cannot be subtracted from 60 ; therefore we take 1 min. 
from the 12 min., change it to sec, and we have with the 50 sec. 
110 sec. in all ; subtract 54 sec. from 110 sec, and we have 56 sec 
remainder. Now 13 from 11 we cannot take, therefore we take 
1 hr. from the next column and proceed as before. 

(c) Compound Multiplication. 

Case I. When the multiplier is not greater than 12. 
Ex. Multiply 9 da. 10 hr. 31 min. 14 sec. by 7. 

da. hr. min. lec. 

9 10 31 14 

7 



66 1 38 38 

Here 14 sec. x 7 = 98 sec = 1 min. 38 sec ; write the 38 and 
carry 1. 31 min. x 7 = 217 min. ; 217 min. -f 1 min. = 218 min. = 
3 hr. 38 min. ; write the 38 and carry the 3. 10 hr. x 7 = 70 hr. ; 
70 hr. + 3 hr. = 73 hr. = 3 da. 1 hr. ; write the 1 and carry the 3. 
Finally, 9 da. x 7 = 63 da. ; 63 da. -f 3 da. = &i da. Ans. = 66 da. 
1 hr. 38 min. 38 sec. 

Case II. When the multiplier can be seen to be the 
product of factors each not greater than 12. 

Ex. Multiply 9 da. 10 hr. 31 min. 14 sec. by 35. 



da. 


hr. 


min. 


wc. 


9 


10 


31 


14 

7 


66 


1 


38 


38 
5 



330 8 13 10 



Art. 160.] COMPOUND DIVISION. 143 

Case III. When the multiplier cannot be seen to be 
the product of factors each not greater than 12. 

The following example will explain the method to be adopted, 
which will be seen to differ very little from the method adopted 
in the multiplication of simple quantities, the only apparent dif- 
ference arising from the fact that we cannot at once write down 
the result of multiplying by 10, 100, etc. 

Ex. Multiply 9 da. 10 hr. 31 min. 14 sec, by 257. 

da. hr. min. lec. 



9 


10 


31 


14 
10 






94 


9 


12 


20 = 
10 


multiplicand 


X 10 


943 


20 


3 


20 = 
2 

40 = 
40 = 
38 = 


(i 


X 100 


1887 
2d line x 5 462 
1st »* X 7 66 


16 
22 

1 


6 

1 

38 


(4 
U 
i4 


x200 
X 50 
X 7 


2416 


15 


46 


58 = 


(i 


x257 



(d) Compound Diyision. 

In division there are two cases to consider, according 
as the divisor is an abstract number or a concrete 
quantity of the same kind as the dividend [Art. 59]. 

Case I. To divide a compound quantity by an abstract 
number. 

Ex. 1. Divide 22 da. 1 hr. 13 min. 1 sec. by 6. 

da. hr. min. tec. 

6 )22 1 13 1 
3 16 12 lOJ 

Here, dividing 22 da. by 6, we have 3 da. with an undivided re- 
mainder of 4 da., which must be reduced to hr. ; then we have 97 
hr. in all to be divided by 6 ; the quotient equals 16 hr. with 1 hr. 
over. One hour and 13 min. = 73 min. ; 73 min. -^ 6 = 12 min. with 
1 min. over. Finally, 1 min. = 60 sec. ; 61 sec. -^ 6 = lOJ sec. 

Ex.2. Divide dwk. 6 da. 21 hr. IS sec. by SS. 

wk. da. hr. min. lec 

3 )9 6 21 13 
11 )3 2 7 4t 
2 2 49 5|t 



144 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 

Case II. When the divisor is a concrete quantity of 
the same nature as the dividend. 

Ex. Divide 37 da. 20 hr. 6 min. 48 sec. by 12 da. 14 hr. 42 min. 
16 sec. [Compare Art. 60. ] 

37 da. 20 hr. 6 min. 48 sec. = 3260208 sec. 
12 da. 14 hr. 42 min. 16 sec. = 1089736 sec. 
3269208 sec. -^ 1089736 sec. = 3 (an abstract number). 

(e) To multiply or divide by a fraction. 
[Arts. 121 and 123.] 

Ex. 1. Multiply 14 da. 2 hr. 12 sec. by ^. 



da. 
14 


hr. 

2 


min. lec. 

12 
6 


7)70 


10 


1 


10 
la. 2hr 

da. 
6)14 


1 
. 12 

hr. 

2 


26 61 f 
sec. by ^. 

min. lec. 

12 


2 


19 


36 2f 
7^ 


19 


17 


12 164 



Both operations are understood because the nature of a fraction 
has been explained. 

EXAMPLES LUI. 
Written Exercises. 

1. Add 17 da. 14 hr. 22 min. 12 sec, 13 da. 11 hr. 24 
min. 18 sec., and 15 da. 33 min. 40 sec. 

2. From 6 da. 12 sec. subtract 2 da. 4 hr. 12 min. 59 
sec. 

3. Multiply 7 da. 12 hr. 14 min. 25 sec. by 5. 

4. Multiply 7 da. 12 hr. 14 min. 25 sec. by 18. 
6. Multiply 7 da. 12 hr. 14 min. 25 sec. by 347. 



Art. 161.] AVOIRDUPOIS WEIGHT. 145 

6. A steamer makes a trip of 800 miles in 4 da. 8 hr. 
12 min. 20 sec. ; how many sucli trips could she make in 
18 da. 10 hr. 52 min. 25 sec? 

7. Multiply 8 da. 5 hr. 8 min. 48 sec. by f . 



Measubes of Weight. 

The units of measure for all weights are derived from 
the weight of a kernel of wheat taken from the middle of 
a ripe ear. 

The name of such a weight is one Grain (gr.). 

161. Table of Ayoirdupois Weight. 

The unit is a pound consisting of 7000 grains, 

16 drams (dr.) = 1 ounce (oz.). 
16 oz. = 1 pound (lb.). 

100 lb. = 1 hundred-weight (cwt.). 

20 cwt. = 1 ton (t.). 

112 lb. = 1 long hundred-weight. 
22401b. = 1 " ton(l.t.). 



English I 



Avoirdupois weight is used in weighing all ordinary substances. 

The long ton is used in the Custom House, and in certain whole- 
sale transactions. 

The English Standard unit of weight is the Imperial Pound 
(Avoirdupois), and is the weight of a certain piece of platinum 
kept in the Exchequer Office. 

EXAMPLES LIV. 
Written Exeroisei. 

1. Reduce 2 cwt. 15 lb. 12 oz. to dr. 

2. How many gr. in an oz. avoirdupois ? 

3. Add 4 cwt. 72 lb. 14 oz. 11 dr., 34 lb. 12 oz. 2 dr., 
8 cwt. 14 dr., 14 cwt. 561b. 3oz., and 81b. 2oz. 6 dr. 

L 



146 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 

4. Reduce 1687649 dr. to units of higher denominar 
tions. 

6. Reduce 16000 oz. to long tons, etc. 

6. One boy weighs 125 lb. 10.5 oz. ; how many such 
boys together weigh 22 cwt. 61 lb. 13 oz. ? 

162. Table of Troy Weight. 

The unit is a pound consisting of 5760 grains, 

24 grains (gr.) = 1 pennyweight (pwt. or dwt.). 
20 pwt. = 1 ounce (oz.). 

12 oz. = 1 pound (lb.). 

Troy weight is used in weighing gold and silver. 
Diamonds and other jewels are spoken of as weighing so many 
carats. The carat is a little more than 8^ grains. 

The United States Standard unit of Weight is the Troy 
Pound (same as the English Pound Troy), and is the 
weight of a certain piece of brass in the custody of the 
Director of the U. S. Mint. 

BXAMPLES liV. 
Oral Exerolsei. 

1. How many gr. in 3 pwt. ? In 1^ dwt. ? 

2. How many gr. in 2 oz. ? 

3. How many oz. in 3 J lb. ? In 5^ lb. ? 

4. How many oz. in 70 pwt. ? In 45 dwt. ? 
6. How many oz. in 480 gr. ? 

6. How many lb. in 78 oz. ? In 43 oz. ? In 400 pwt. ? 

Written Exeroliet. 

7. Reduce 7563 dwt. to lb., etc. 

8. Reduce 6 lb. 14 gr. to gr. 



Arts. 162, 163.] APOTHECARIES' WEIGHT. 147 

9. How many bronze cents weigh 1 lb., the 1 ct. piece 
weighing 48 gr. ? 

10. One hundred gold dollar pieces weigh 5 oz. 7 pwt. 
12 gr. ; what is the weight of one piece ? 

163. Table of Apothecaries' Weight. 

The unit is a pound consisting of 5760 grains, 

gr. 20 = 1 scruple (3). 
» 33 = 1 dram (3). 
38 = 1 ounce (S). 
S 12 = 1 pound (ft).). 

Apothecaries' weight is used by physicians when writing pre- 
scriptions and by druggists when selling drugs in small quantities. 
Avoirdupois weight is used by them when dealing in large quantities. 

The symbols are always written at the left of the figures. 

BXAMFLBS LVI. 
Oral Exerciies. 

1. How many gr. in 3 3 ? In S 1 ? In 3 1^ ? 

2. How many S in lb. 2^ ? In lb. 3f ? 

3. How many S in gr. 480 ? In 3 48 ? 

4. How many 3 in S 2 ? In gr. 60 ? In lb. 1 ? 

6. How many lb. in S 42 ? In 396 ? In SIO 3 16 ? 

Written Exeroisei. 

6. Reduce 3 7563 to lb. 

7. Reduce lb. 4 52 to gr. 

8. Multiply Ib.6 S 7 3 1 3 2 gr. 15 by 16. 

9. Divide lb.l2 53 37 32 gr.4by4. 



148 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 

Measures of Length, Surface, and Volume. 

164. Table of Linear Measures. 

The English Standard unit of Length is the Imperial 
Yard fixed by Act of Parliament to be the distance between 
two marks on a bar of metal kept in the Exchequer Office. 

The U. S. Standard unit of Length is the same as that 

of England. 

12 inches (in.) = l foot (ft.). 

3 ft. =1 yard (yd.). 

320 rd. =1 mile (mi.). 

For Land Surveying. 

7.92 inches = 1 link (li.). 
100 li I ^ ^ ^j^^.^ ^^^. 

4 rd. ) 

80 ch. = 1 mi. 

1 mi. = 1760 yd. = 5280 ft. = l statute mile. 

Rods are sometimes called poles and perches. A furlong (fur.) 
= 40 rods = } mi. Civil engineers use a chain 100 feet in length. 

EXAMPLES LVn. 
Oral Exercises. 

1. Express 4 yd. as in. ; 7 ft. as yd. 

2. Eeduce 18 ft. to rd., ft., and in. 

3. How many in. in 2 yd. 1 ft. ? 

4. How many ft. in a surveyor's chain? 
6. How many li. in 1 rd. ? 

6. How many yd. in 7 rd. ? 

7. Practise frequently the drawing (freehand) of a 
straight line 1 ft. long. 



Arts. 164, 166.] SQUARE MEASURES. 149 

Written Exerelset. 

8. Eeduce 40 rd. 6 ft. 7 in. to in, 
9." Reduce 1 mi. to ft. 
10. 803 in. to rd. and in. 

165. Table of Square Measures. 

The unit is any square, usually a square which is 1 ft. 
long. 

144 square inches (sq. in.) = 1 square foot (sq. ft.). 
9 sq. ft. =1 square yard (sq. yd.) 

2n\n'tt:} =1 square rod (sq-rd.) 

160 sq. rd. = 1 acre (A.). 

640 A. =1 square mile (sq. mi.). 

1 A. = 160 sq. rd. = 4840 sq. yd. = 43560 sq. ft. 

For Land Surveying. 

16 sq. rd. = 1 square chain (sq. ch.). 
10 sq. ch. = 1 A. 

Square measure is used for measuring land, flooring, and in fact, 
everything in which length and breadth have to be taken into 
account. 

EXAMPLES LVIII. 
Written Exercigeg. 

1. Draw on the board (freehand) a figure representing 
a square foot, marking it accurately into square inches. 

2. How many sq. in. in ^ a sq. ft. ? How many in 
the square of ^ a ft. ? 

3. Having in mind a square 1 yd. long, how many 
sq. ft. in such a square? 

4. Find by a figure the number of sq. yd. in 1 sq. rd. 



150 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

6. Find by multiplication the number of sq. yd. in 
1 sq. rd. 

6. How many sq. in. in a square 2 ft. long ? Jn a 
square 3 in. long? 

7. Represent 3 A. 4 sq. rd. 50 sq. ft. as sq. ft. 

8. Divide 58 A. 84 sq. rd. 3 sq. yd. 4 sq. ft. by 8. 

166. Table of Cubic Measures. 

The unit is any cube, generally a cube 1 in. long, or a 
cube 1 ft. long. 

1728 cubic inches (cu. in.)= 1 cubic foot (cu. ft.). 
27 cu. ft. = 1 cubic yard (cu. yd.). 

For Measubii^g Wood. 

16 CU. ft. =1 cord foot (cd. ft.). 

8 cd. ft. = 1 cord (cd.). 

Cubic measure is used for measuring solid bodies in which 
length, breadth, and thickness have to be taken into account. 

EXAMPLES lilX. 
Written Exercises. 

1. Make two cubes similar to the one in Ex. 2, p. 136, 
one cube an in. long, the other 4 in. long. 

2. Mark the sides of the large cube into sq. in., and 
calculate how many cubes equal to the small cube might 
be cut from a block equal to the large cube. 

3. Keduce 2 cu. yd. 1201 cu. in. to cu. in. 

4. How many cu. in. in a cube 2 in. long? Sin. long? 

6. How many cords of wood in a pile containing 1541 
cu. ft. ? State answer to two decimal places. 

6. Multiply 18 cu. yd. 9 cu. ft. 1063 cu* in. by 4. 



Arts. 166-169.] LIQUID— DRY— FLUID. 151 

167. Table of Liquid Measures. 

The unit is a Gallon of 231 cu. in. (the old English 
wine gallon). 

4 gills (gi.)= 1 pint (pt.). 
2 pt. =1 quart (qt.). 

4 qt. =1 gallon (gal.). 

31^ gal. = 1 barrel (bbl.). 

2 bbl. = 1 hogshead (hhd.). 

A gallon of water weighs 8.33 lb. 

The quart is a volume of 57 1 cu. in. 

The English Imperial Gallon contains 277.274 cu. in. 

168u Table of Dry Measures. 

The unit is a Bushel of 2150.42 cu. in. (the old English 
Winchester bushel). 

2 pints (pt.) = 1 quart (qt.). 
8 qt. =1 peck (pk.). 

4 pk. = 1 bushel (bu.). 

The quart is a volume of 67 1 cu. in. 

The English Imperial bushel is 8 Imperial gallons = 2218.102 
cu. in. 

169. Table of Apothecaries' Fluid Measures. 

60 minims, or drops ("l)= 1 fluid dram (f3). 
f38 =1 fluid ounce (f5). 

fS16 =lpint(0). 

08 =1 gallon (Cong.). 

EXAMPLES LX. 
Oral £xerciM«. 

1. How many pt. in 5 qt? In 3 gal.? 

2. How many pt. in 3 pk.? In 1 bu.? 

3. Is the pt. in Ex. 1 equal to the pt. in Ex. 2 ? 

4. Reduce 3 qt. 1 pt. to gi. 5 1 bu. to qt. 



152 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 



6. How many "l in fjl? 
6. How many f S in "i960 ? 



9 



Written Bxercises. 

7. Reduce Cong.l to "l. 

8. Divide 14 bu. 3pk. 5qt. 1 pt. by 5. 

9. Divide 07 fSlO f36 ni59f by f 

10. Reduce 760 dry qt. to liquid qt. 

11. How many bushels of potatoes in a bin 4 ft. x 3 ft. 
X 2 f t. ? 

12. How many piles of 3bu. each could be made out 
of a pile containing 8 cu. ft. ? 

13. Reduce Ihhd. to cu. ft. 

Foreign Monies. 

170. Table of English Money. 
The unit is the Pound (£). 

4 farthings (/ar.)=l penny (d). 
12d. = 1 shilling («.). 

20«. = 1 pound (£). 

21«. = 1 guinea (ga.). 

One farthing is written ^d. ; two farthings, or one half -penny, 
is written \d. ; and three farthings is written Id. Thus, eightpence 
farthing is written S\d. 

The coins in use in England are as follows : 
Gold coins : the sovereign (20«.) and half-sovereign (10s.). 
Silver coins: crown (5«.)» half-crown (2«. 6(1.), florin (2s.), 
double florin (4s.), shilling, sixpence, and threepence. 
Copper coins : penny, half-penny, and farthing. 

171. German Money. 

100 pfennigs (pf,) = l mark (m.). 



Arts. 170-174.] FRENCH MONEY. 158 

172. French Money. 

100 centimes (c.) = 1 franc (/.). 
Note. See Art. 262 for equivalents in American money. 

173. The value of a given fraction of a given concrete 
quantity is found as follows : 

For example, to find ^^ of 3 lbs. 4oz. Troy, we must divide 
3 lbs. 4 oz. into 18 equal parts, and then take 5 of those parts ; 
that is, we must divide by 18, and then multiply by 6. We may, 
however, first multiply by 6 and then divide by 18. Thus, 



18 



lb. OS. pwt. gr. 

3 4 

1 8 




lb. 

3 


OS. 

4 
5 


2 4 10} 


"U 


16 


8 


8 


4 



12 



11 2 5} 11 2 6} 

174. The value of a given decimal of a given concrete 
quantity is found as follows : 

Ex. Find .64376 of 1 lb, Troy in lower denominations. 

.64376 jj^^ ^^^g ^j ^ j^ ^ ^^g^g ^j ^2 oz., 

which = 6.626 oz. ; 

.626 of 1 oz. = .626 of 20 pwt., 
which = 10.6 dwt. ; 

.6 of 1 dwt. = .6 of 24 gr., 
which = 12 gr. 

. *. 6 oz. 10 dwt. 12 gr. = Ans. 

EXAMPLES liXI. 
Written Bxereli«(k 

1. Find 2| of 3 da. 12 hr. 

2. Find 4f of 3 cwt. 36 lb. 

3. Add I of 2«. 6d, 2| of Is, 8d, and l^^^ of 6«. M, 



oz. 


= 6.626f9|l 




20 


dwt. 


= lO.50fJ 




24 


gr. 


= 12.0 



164 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

4. Find 1.625 of 1 da. - .02 of 1 wk. 

6. Express 4.3125 lb. Troy in lb., oz., etc. 

6. Find .436 of 1 mi. 

7. By how much does f of 1 mi. exceed ^ of 310 rd. 

1yd.? 

175. To express one quantity as a fraction of another, 

we proceed as follows : 

Ex. 1. Express 148. 6d. as a fraction o/16a. 8d. 

14«. 6d. = 174d. 
168. Sd. = 188d. 
Now Id. = ?Jt of ISW. 

.-. 174rf. = jJJ of 188d. 

Ex. 2. Exprus 2\ of Is. 1\d. as a fraction of £1. 

2\ of la. 7id. = V of ¥<^- = W^- 

£1 = 240(1. 
Now Id. = 7^ of £1. 

• •• W^- = W X Tiij of £1 = £ ,«fiF 



176. To express one quantity as a decimal of another, 

we proceed as follows : 
The method here is the reverse of that in Art. 174. 



24 
20 
12 



Ex. Express 10 oz. lldtot, 12 gr, as the decimal of lib. Troy, 
12 gr. Divide the grains by 24 to reduce to pwt.; add 



11.5 the 11 pwt. and divide 11.6 pwt. by 20 to reduce 



10.576 to oz ; add the 10 oz. and divide 10.676 oz. by 12 



.88125 to reduce to lb. 



An excellent method is to express one quantity as a 
fraction of the other [Art. 175], and then reduce this 
common fraction to a decimal [Art. 130] ; thus^ 



Arts. 176, 176.] EXAMPLES. 166 

10 oz. lldwt. 12 gr. = 5076 gr. 

1 lb. = 6760 gr. 



jjow **** =.88126. 



BXAMPLBS LXII. 
Written Exercises. 



1. Express 25 lb., 60 lb., 12 lb. 8 oz., and 6 lb. 4 oz. as 
fractions of 1 cwt. 

2. What would be the measure of 4yd. 2ft. Sin. if 
1 yd. 1 ft. 7 in. were taken as the unit ? 

3. Express 1 oz. 6 dwt. 6 gr. as a decimal of 1 lb. Troy. 

4. What decimal of an acre is 20 sq. rd. 6 sq. ft. 72 
sq. in.? 

6. Express £5, 128. 6d. as a decimal of £10. 

6. Express 2 mo. 7 da. as a decimal of 1 yr. 

7. Express 7 mo, 12 da. as a decimal of 1 yr. 

8. Express 10 mo. 15 da. as a decimal of 2 yr. 

EXAMPLES LXIII. 
Simple Bxamples In Reduction for Written Work. 

Beduce : 

1. It. 3 cwt. 101b. to pounds. 

2. 3 1. 12 cwt. 16 lb. to pounds. 

3. 6 hr. 12 min. 10 sec. to seconds. 

4. 12 hr. 5 min. 24 sec. to seconds. 
6. 13 yd. 2 ft. 11 in. to inches. 

6. 17 yd. 2 ft. 7 in. to inches. 

7. 12 mi. 3 fur. 10 rd. to rods. 

8. 13 mi. 5 fur. 26 rd. to rods. 

9. 8 bu. 3 pk. 4 qt. to quarts. 



166 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

10. 5 gal. 3 qt. 1 pt. to pints. 

11. 5 A. 27 sq. rd. to square rods. 

12. 17 A. 135 sq. rd. to square rods. 

13« 13 sq. yd. 6 sq. ft. 100 sq. in. to inches. 

14. 8 sq. yd. 7 sq. ft. 90 sq. in. to inches. 

16. 61b. 7oz. lOdwt 15 gr. to grains. 

16. 18 lb. 9 oz. 15 dwt. 20 gr. to grains. 

17. 3 wk. 6 da. 12 hr. to hours. • 

18. 16 da. 22 hr. 40 min. 35 sec. to seconds. 

19. 12 1. 13 cwt. 75 lb. 7 oz. to ounces. 

20. 6 1. 17 cwt. 68 lb. 14 oz. to ounces. 

21. 2 mi. 3 fur. 80 yd. 2 ft. to feet. 

22. 12 mi. 1200 yd. 1ft. 7 in. to inches. 

Reduce to tons, cwt., etc. : 

23. 14621b. 26. 115971b. 27. 67812 oz. 

24. 135741b. 26. 56214 oz. 28. 81974 dr. 

Beduce to acres and square rods : 

29. 315sq. rd. 31. 1674sq.rd. 

30. 6142 8q.rd. 32. 3725sq.rd. 

Reduce to yards, feet, etc. : 

33. 156 in. 34. 342 in. 36. 417 in. 36. 1179 in. 

Reduce to lb., oz., dwt., gr. : 

37. 517 dwt. 41. 13407 gr. 

38. 574 dwt. 42. 24709 gr. 

39. 3156 gr. 43. 35937 gr. 

40. 4215 gr. 44. 51940 gr. 

Reduce to bushels, pecks, etc. ; 

46. 156 pt. 46. 1472 pt. 47. 416 qt. 48. 1875 pt. 



Art. 177.] DIFFICULT REDUCTIONS. 157 

Reduce to square yards, etc. ; 

49. 1462 sq. in. 50. 2156 sq. in. 51. 3564 sq. in. 

Reduce to days, hours, etc. : 

52. 31572 sec. 53. 257672 sec. 54. 7142169 sec. 

Calculate the number of 

55. Sq. rd. in 1 sq, mi. 56. Sq. rd. in 1 A. 

57. A. in 1 sq. mi. 

58. Change 3.12 rd. to the decimal of a mi. 

59. Change .2 sq. rd. to the fraction of an A. 

60. Change lb. .00694 to the fraction of a 3. 

61. How many cd. of wood might be packed into a 
shed the size of your school-room ? 

177. The following cases are somewhat more difficult 
than those previously considered because one rod does 
not equal an exact number of yards. 

Ex. 1. Beduce 81 rd. Syd. 2 ft. 11 in. to inches, 

31rd. 3yd. 2ft. 11 in. 
5.5 



16 5 

155 Here we have 31 rods to be multi- 

173.6 yd., the 3 yd. included, plied by 6 J = 6.6. We might have 

§ multiplied by ^. 

622.6 ft., "2 ft. " 
12 



6281.0 in., " 11 in. " 

Caution. In adding the yards or feet of the example while 
multiplying, care must be used in regard to the decimal point. 

Ex. 2. Reduce 1886 sq. rd, 16 sq. yd, 6 sq.ft. to sq,ft. 

1886sq.rd. 
30.26 



67037.26 sq. yd., including the 16sq.yd. 
9 



613341.26 sq. ft., " ** 6 sq.ft. 



168 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 

Ex. 3. Reduce 6281 in. to units of higher denaminationa. 

First Method. 

1 2)6281 Id. 6.6 J 174.0^31 

3)523 ft. 6 in. M 

6.6)174 yd. 1ft. ^ 

31 rd. 3.6 yd. |f ^^ .^ oo-. 

36 [See Art. 68.] 

rd. yd. ft in. 

Integral part of answer = 31 3 1 6 
Decimal •* " ♦♦ =.6yd. = 1 6 

Sum = 31 3 2 11 An8. 
Second Method. 



12)6281 in. 
















3)623 ft. 


6 in. 














174 yd. 


1ft. 




It is 


shorter to 


multiply by ^ 


2 

4 




than to 


divide by 


6.6. 




11)348 
















31 rd. 


. . . ^ yd. [Art. 


68.] 


















rd. 


yd. 


ft 


in. 






Integral part 




= 31 





1 


6 






Fractional part = 


= iyd. 


zz 


3 


1 


6 








Sum 


= 31 


3 


2 


11 


Ans, 



Ex. 4. Seduce 613341.26 8g./l(. to sq. rd,, sq. yd., and sq.ft. 

9)613341.26 
30.26 )67037 sq. yd. 8.26 sq. ft. 
1886 sq. rd. 16.76 sq. yd. 

•q. rd. §q. yd. sq. ft. iq. in. 

Integral part = 1886 16 8 

T% . 1 -X r -26 sq. ft. = 36 

Decimal part <--, /.^ao 

^ l.76sq.yd. = 6 108 

Sum = 1885 16 6 Ans. 

Here it is shorter and easier to divide by 30.26 than to divide by 
^JJ- {i.e., to multiply by jij). 

It will be noticed that only the integral part of any dividend is 
to be divided ; the decimal part, if any, is to be regarded as a 
decimal part of the remainder. 



Abt. 178.] MISCELLANEOUS MEASURES. 159 

178. In some cases of Eeduction we cannot pass 
directly from one denomination to the other. 

Ex. How many lb. Troy are there in 144 lb. Avoir, f 

Since 1 lb. Avoir. = 7000 gr., 

144 lb. Avoir. = 7000 gr. x 144. 

These grains are now reduced to lb. Troy in the usual manner. 



Miscellaneous Measures. 


Numbers. 


3 barleycorns = 1 in. 


12 units = 1 dozen. 


4 in. =1 hand. 


12 dozen = 1 gross. 


40 rd. =1 furlong. 


12 gross = 1 great { 


1 geographic ^ J ^^^» 
calmi.=6080ft. / 

3 knots = 1 league. 


20 units = 1 score. 
Stationery. 


6 ft. =1 fathom. 


24 sheets = 1 quire. 



20 quires = 1 ream. 
1 cu. ft. of pure water weighs 2 reams = 1 bundle. 

1000 oz. = 62| lb. 5 bundles = 1 bale. 

EXAMPLES LXIV. 
Reduce : written Sxerclges. 

1. 10 rd. 2 yd. 1ft. to feet. 

2. 5 rd. 3 yd. 2 ft. to inches. 

3. 1 mi. 3 fur. 20 rd. 1 yd. to yards. 

4. 6 mi. 5 fur. 30 rd. 3 yd. to yards. 

6. 18 mi. 11 rd. 3 yd. 1 ft. 6 in. to inches. 

6. 27 mi. 273 rd. 2 yd. 2 ft. 7 in. to inches. 

7. 6 mi. 52 yd. to yards. 

8. 18 mi. 5 rd. 160 yd. 2 ft. 11 in. to inches. 

9. 3 A. 16 sq. rd. to square yards. 
10. 15 A. 24 sq. rd. to square yards. 

* The knot recognized by the U. S. Coast and Geodetic Survey 
equals 6080.20 ft. 



160 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 

11. 3 A. 85 sq. rd. 16 sq. yd. 6 sq. ft. to square inches. 

12. 16sq. rd. 18sq. yd. 5 sq.ft. 100 sq. in. to square 
inches. 

Reduce to miles, etc. : 

13. 6974 yards. 16. 6315 feet. 

14. 21571 yards. 17. 51621 inches. 
16. 15737 yards. 18. 158743 inches. 

Reduce to acres, sq. rd., etc. : 

19. 20812 sq. yd. 21. 5172400 sq. in. 

20. 38599 sq. yd. 22. 8156179 sq. in. 

Reduce : 

23. 36 lb. Avoir, to lb. Troy. 

24. 720 lb. Avoir, to lb. Troy. 
26. 1 cwt. Avoir, to Troy weight. 

26. 11 lb. 8 oz. Avoir, to Troy. 

27. 350 oz. Troy to oz. Avoir. 

28. 4 lb. 3 oz. 20 gr. to lb. and oz. Avoir. 

29. Icwt. 91b. to lb., S, etc. 

30. lb. 9 S 6 3 6 3 2 gr. 5 to lb., etc., Avoir. 

EXAMPLES LXV. 
Written Exeroiseg. 



3. 



Add: 






(U. 


hr. 


mio. 


1. 6 


17 


42 


3 


11 


63 


7 


19 


37 


11 


7 


21 


hr. 


mln. 


we. 


2. 1 


41 


15 


6 


17 


39 


7 


35 


42 


5 


16 


13 



<U. 


hr. 


min. 


MC. 


5 


17 


27 


45 


6 


11 


39 


66 


17 


21 


49 


40 


6 


11 


11 


31 


cwt. 


lb. 


oz. 




5 


16 


10 




3 


39 


6 




7 


47 


14 




1 


25 


9 





Art. 178.] EXAMPLES. 161 

lb. oz. dr. lb. oz. dwt gr. 

5. 5 12 8 12. 5 11 16 18 

4 13 12 2 9 11 13 

7 9 15 7 10 16 21 

3 11 14 3 7 9 16 





t. 


cwt. 


lb. 


OS. 




yd. 


ft. 


in. 






6. 


5 


15 


17 


3 


13. 


5 


2 


9 








1 


12 


67 


12 




11 


1 











15 


17 


20 


11 




13 


2 


7 








3 


9 


21 


7 




6 





11 








•lb. 


OZ. 


dr. 






yd. 


ft. 


in. 






7. 


5 


9 


13 




14. 


16 


1 


7 








7 


14 


12 






9 


2 


10 








18 


6 


9 






20 





8 








3 


11 


11 






11 


2 


11 








t 


cwt. 


lb. 


oz. 




yd. 


ft. 


in. 






8. 


16 


17 


19 


14 


15. 


15 





9 








119 


16 


47 







3 


2 


7 








72 


12 


37 


13 




18 


1 


11 








66 


15 


24 


8 




8 





9 








cwt. 


lb. 


oz. 






mL 


rd. 


yd. 






9. 


6 


24 


10 




16. 


6 


100 


2 








17 


78 


12 






3 


140 


4 








14 


7 


14 






18 


97 


3 








11 


41 


2 






2 


15 


2 








lb. 


oz. 


dwt 






mi. 


Id. 


yd. 


ft. 


in. 


0. 


6 


4 


19 




17. 


1 


190 


2 


1 


4 




13 


9 


7 


• 






3 


3 





11 




2 


11 


17 






2 


84 


4 


2 


7 




7 


10 


13 






3 


180 


3 


1 


9 




oz. 


dwt 


St- 






mi. 


Id. 


yd. 


ft. 


in. 


1. 


1 


17 


23 




18. 


5 


300 


2 


2 


1 




2 


8 


11 








15 


3 


1 


9 




5 


15 


7 






1 


187 


4 


2 


11 




7 


4 


21 






2 


74 


5 





9 



M 



162 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VX 





A. 


iq.yd. 








bu. 


Pk. 


«■ 


p<- 




19. 


5 


12 






23. 


3 


2 


6 


1 






17 


26 








1 


3 


3 









3 


18 








* 10 





6 


1 






4 


30 








2 


3 


4 


1 






A. 


•Q.yd. 








ft. 


S 


3 


3 


gr- 


20. 


1 


27 






24. 


4 


10 


6 


2 


5 




16 


19 








3 


8 


6 


2 


16 




8 


22 








1 





1 


1 


6 




19 


7 
It. pt. 








2 





7 





19 




Cong. 


0. 


ii 


tl 




21. 


5 


2 1 






26. 


1 


6 


12 


4 






6 


3 1 








2 


5 


13 


7 






4 


1 








1 


2 


3 


6 






1 

gal. 


2 1 

«■ pt 


|L 






2 


1 


6 


3 






lb. 


S 


3 


3 




22. 


18 


3 1 


2 




26. 


1 


11 


7 


2 






4 


1 


3 






2 


9 


1 


1 






6 


2 1 


1 






3 


6 


6 









1 


1 1 


1 


cn. yd. 


cn. ft. 


5 

cn. in. 


4 


5 


1 








27. 


5.2 


22.1 


16.4 


















1.3 


19.2 


126.9 


















3.3 


3. 


14.3 


















5.4 


8.2 


9.2 











Answer in exact units. 

BXAMPLES LXVI. 
Written Bxerciies. 

Subtract : 

1. 5 da. 161ir. 22min. from 11 da. 18 hr. lOmin. 

2. 15 da. 17 hr. 13miii. 42 sec. from 31 da. 91ir. 11 
min. 40 sec. 

3. 5cwt. 731b. 11 oz. from 7cwt. 111b. 9oz. 



Akt. 178.] EXAMPLES. 168 

4. 61b. 10 oz. 11 dr. from 161b. 9oz. 5 dr. 

6. 7t. IScwt. 151b. 12 oz. from 10 1. 11 cwt. 10 oz. 

6. 3 lb. 4 oz. 10 dwt. from 9 lb. 1 oz. 5 dwt. 
Find: 

7. I31b,4^J^jpwt,__2(51b. 10 oz. ISpwt. 10.5 gr.). 

8. 10 yd. -5 yd. 1ft. 10 in. 

9. 29 yd. 1ft. 4 in. -17 yd. 2 ft. 11 in. 

10. 17 mi. Ifur. 150 yd. -6 mi. 3 fur. 164 yd. 

11. From lb. 4 56 gr.l7 subtract lb. 2 57 33 gr.l5. 

12. From 18 sq. yd. 3 sq. ft. 17 sq. in. take 6 sq.yd. 
7 sq. ft. 100 sq. in. 

13. From 215 sq. yd. 3 sq. ft. 84 sq. in. take 118 sq.yd. 
6 sq.ft. 112sq. in. 

14. From 25 A. take 15 A. 120 sq. rd. 10 sq. yd. 

16. From 23 A. 40sq.rd. 10 sq.yd. take 6 A. 125 
sq. rd. 25 sq. yd. 

16. Find 6cu.yd. 24cu.ft. 1200 cu. in. - 3 cu. yd. 25 
cu.ft. 8cu. in. 



bn. pk. qt. pt gL 

17. 7 1.2 1 3.6 
3 2.4 1.3 2.4 




18. 


10 
5 


qt pt 
1 

2 1 


Answer in exact units. 










0. fs 
19. 7 10 


f3 
5 


"I 
50 






3 14 


6 


51 







EXAMPLBS LXVII. 
Written Bxercisei. 



Multiply : 

1. 5 hr. 10 min. 33 sec., (i) by 5, (ii) by 7, (iii) by 9. 

2. 5 cwt. 39 lb., (i) by 7, (ii) by 8, (iii) by 9. 



164 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

3. 6 1. 17 cwt. 64 lb. 6 oz. 5 dr., (i) by 4, (ii) by 6, 
(iii) by 9. 

4. 8 lb. 10 oz. 15 dwt. 20 gr., (i) by 5, (ii) by 7, (iii) 
by 12. 

6. Ib6 S4.1 32.3 31.2 gr.ll by 5. 

6. 10 yd. 1 ft. 7 in., (i) by 8, (ii) by 11, (iii) by 12. 

7. 8 mi. 215 yd., (i) by 5, (ii) by 8, (iii) by 12. 

8. 1 mi. 20 rd. 4 yd., (i) by 7, (ii) by 56. 

9. 15 sq. yd. 7 sq. ft. 100 sq. in., (i) by 6, (u) by 11. 

10. 4 cu. ft. 163 cu. in., (i) by 8, (ii) by 11., 

11. 3 bu. 2 pk., (i) by 5, (ii) by 11. 

12. 3 gal. 2 qt. 1 pt., (i) by 5, (ii) by 7. 

13. 3 da. 17 hr. 10 min. 15 sec, (i) by 35, (ii) by 46. 

14. 15 1. 12 cwt. 16 lb., (i) by 42, (ii) by 72. 

16. 8 lb. 11 oz. 15 dwt. 18 gr., (i) by 49, (ii) by 84. 

16. 3 yd. 2 ft. 10 in., (i) by 44, (ii) by 132. 

17. 3 yd. 1ft. 7 in. by 350. 

18. 5bu. 2pk. by 420. 

19. 12 da. 13 hr. 14 min. 12 sec. by 65. 

20. 5 1. 7 cwt. 15 lb. by 94. 

21. 31b. 4oz. 12 dwt. 12 gr. by 124. 

22. 3 cwt. 75 lb. 5 oz. by 257. 

23. 15sq.yd. 7 sq. ft. 82 sq.m. by 1212. 

24. 6 1. 15 cwt. 7 lb. 3 oz. by 2341. 

25. 21b. 4oz. 16 dwt. 18 gr. by 3124. 

26. 1 mi. 2 fur. 15 rd. 4 yd., (i) by 5, (ii) by 9. 



Akt. 178.] EXAMPLES. 166 

BXAMPLES LXVni. 
Written £xerclse». 

Divide : 

1. 22 da. Ihr. 12miii. by 6. 

2. 37 cwt. 3 lb. by 7. 

3. 441b. 2oz. 8 dr. by 8. 

4. 52 lb. 10 oz. 13 dwt. by 9. 

5. 153 yd. 2 ft. lin. by 11. 

6. 95 A. 64sq.rd. by 12. 

7. 185 lb. 8 oz. 17 dwt. by 54. 

8. 123 da. 10 hr. 45 min. by 50. 

9. 1052 yd. 1 ft. by 132. 

10. 251 A. 133 sq. rd. by 121. 

11. 19 1. 14 cwt. 81b. 3oz. 4 dr. by 500. 

12. 214 1. 10 cwt. 44 lb. by 196. 

13. 12 1. 3 cwt. 91b. by 37. 

14. 309 1. 12 cwt. 141b. by 47. 

15. lot. 6 cwt. 701b. loz. by 57. 

16. 37 yd. 2 ft. 3 in. by 151. 

17. 35 1. 2 cwt. 631b. 2oz. by 289. 

18. 2237 bu. 1 pk. 7 qt. by 253. 

19. 61 1. 1 cwt. 75 lb. by 2896. 

20. 24 mi. 58 yd. 2 ft. 4 in. by 1234. 

21. 36 mi. 4 fur. 23 rd. 3 yd. 1ft. 6 in. by 10. 

22. 55 mi. 7 fur. 26 rd. 1yd. 1ft. by 43. 

23. 298 A. 39 sq. rd. 18 sq. yd. 2 sq. ft. 108 sq. in. by 73. 



166 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

EXAMPIiBS liXIX. 
Written Bxerclses. 

1. Divide 2 tons 5cwt. by 9cwt. 

2. Divide 6oz. lOdwt. by 13dwt. 

3. Divide 3 A. 50sq. rd. by 19sq. rd. 

4. Divide 20 bu. 1 pk. by 2bu. 1 pk. 

5. How many pieces each 3 yd. 1 ft. long can be cut 
from a rope whose length is 180 yd.? 

6. A wheel revolves once every 2 m. 15 sec. ; how 
many times does it revolve in 1 hr. 48 m. ? 

7. The circumference of a tricycle wheel is 12 feet ; 
how many times does the wheel turn round in a journey 
of 10 miles ? 

8. A field of 13 A. 80 sq. rd. is divided into allot- 
ments, each containing 1 A. 20 sq. rd. ; how many allot- 
ments are there ? 

9. A man's average step is 2 ft. llin. ; how many 
steps does he take in walking 3^ miles ? 

10. How many jars, each containing 2 gal. 3 qt. 1 pt., 
can be filled out of a cask containing 46 gal. ? 

11. How many rails, each weighing 4cwt. 37 lb., can 
be made out of 58 1. 19 cwt. 90 lb. of iron ? What will 
each rail cost at 3 ct. a lb. ? 

12. How many times does 2 miles 76 yd. contain 14 
yd. 1 ft. 6 in. ? 

13. Each of a certain number of articles weighs 14 lb. 
1 oz., and the total weight is 3 t. 75 lb. ; how many are 
there ? 

14. How many times is 361b. 3oz. 3dwt. contained in 
543 lb. 11 oz. 5 dwt. ? 



Art. 179.] 



CIRCULAR MEASURES. 



167 



15. How many bullets, each weighing 2 J oz., can be 
made from a quantity of lead weighing 7 cwt. 35 lb. ? 

16. A sovereign weighs 123 grains; how many can be 
made out of 3 lb. 5 oz. of standard gold ? 

179. Table of Circular Measures. 

The plane figure whose bound- 
ing line is a curve everywhere 
equally distant from the centre 
is called a Circle. 

The bounding line of a circle 
is called its Circumference. 

Any part of a circumference 
is called an Arc. 

If the circumference be di- 
vided into 360 equal parts, one of these parts is called an 
arc of one Degree (1°). 

The unit is an arc of 1°. 

60 seconds (") = 1 minute C). 
60' = 1 degree Q. 

360° = 1 circumference (C). 




EXAMPLES LXX. 



Written Exercises. 



1. Add 



5" 


21' 


16" 


27° 


41' 


23" 


196° 


12' 


39" 


150° 


2' 


10" 



2. Prom 182'' 1' 49" 
Subtract 12° 50' 50'' 



3. How many seconds in 90° ? 

4. How many degrees in 5678" ? 

5. How many circumferences in 1800° ? 

6. Reduce 100000" to units of higher denominations. 



168 



NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. 



[Chap. VI. 



180. Longitttde and Time. 

EXAMPLES LXX. ^ Continued, 
Oral Kxercises. 

7. Let the figure represent a globe rotating on its 
axis ; how many degrees does c move towards the present 
position of g while the globe is making i oi dk rotation ? 
^ of a rotation ? -^^ ? 




8. The earth is a rotating globe, and a point, as c 
or r, moves once around its circle in 24 hr. ; how long 
does it take c to move to the present position of e, the arc 
ce being 30° ? To the present position of ^ ? Of d ? 

9. How long does it take r to move to the present 
position of 5 ? 

10. How long does it take the arc ac to reach the 
present position of the arc (meridian) ae ? 

11. How many degrees does the earth rotate in 1 hr. ? 
In 1 min. ? 



Abts. 180, 181.] LONGITUDE AND TIME. 



169 



12. How many arc minutes does the earth rotate in 1 
min. ? In 1 sec. ? 

13. How many arc seconds does the earth rotate in 
1 sec. ? 



Since 
and 
and 



15** rotation require 1 hr. 
15' rotation require 1 min. 
15" rotation require 1 sec., 




we may change time measure to circular measure by mvJr 
tiplying hr.y min,, and sec. by 15 ; 

we may change circular mea^sure to tims measure by dividing 
% ', and " by 15. 

The meridian distance (the difference in longitude) 
between two places is measured in units of circular meas- 
ure, or in units of time measure. 

IflL Difference in Longitude, and in Time. 

Longitude is reckoned either east or west from the merid- 
ian passing through Greenwich. It is evident that if two 



170 NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VI. 

places axe either east of, or west from, Greenwich, the dif- 
ference in longitude is found by subtraction ; if one place is 
east and the other west, the difference is found by addition. 

Ex. Fitid difference in time between Cleveland^ 81° 40' 80" W., 

and St. Paul, 93° 4' 66" W. 

930 4' 66" 
81Q 40' 30" 

16 )110 24' 26" 

46 min. 37 sec. Ans. 

BXAMPLB8 LXXI. 
Written Ezeroltes. 

Find the difference in time between 

1. Portland (Me.), 70* 15' 40" W., and Detroit, 82*» 
58' W. 

2. New York, 74* 0' 3'' W., and Chicago, 87* 37' 30" W. 

3. New York and Washington, 77* 2' 48" W. 

4. Berlin, 13* 23' 53" E., and Paris, 2* 20' 22. "5 E. 
6. Berlin and New York. 

6. Boston, 71* 3' 30" W., and San Francisco, 122* 24' 
15" W. 

7. Greenwich and Washington. 

8. What is the longitude of St. Louis, the difference 
in time between New York and St. Louis being 1 hr. 5 
min. 1 sec. ? 

9. The difference in time between Philadelphia and 
Chicago is 49 min. 50 sec. ; what is the difference in lon- 
gitude ? What is the longitude of Philadelphia ? 

10. When it is 4 o'clock (p.m.) at Greenwich, what 
time is it at Washington ? 

11. When it is 1 o'clock (a.m.) at New York, what time 
is it at Berlin ? 



Art. 181.] EXAMPLES. 171 

EXAMPLBS LXXII. 

Bedoction of Metric Numbers to Non-Metrlo Numbers; also, of 
Non-Metrlo Namibers to Metric Numbers. 

1. How many cm in 1 in. ? 

2. How many yd. in 17.6"* ? 

3. How many t. in 1^* of water ? 

4. How many sq. ft. in l**™ ? 
6. How many cu. in. in 1^ ? 

6. How many lb. in l''"" of water ? 

7. How many Mg in 1 l.t. ? 

8. How many ml in 1 qt. (liquid) ? 

9. How many g in lb 5 ? 

10. How many gr. in 15 *« ? 

11. How many gr. in 500**" of water ? 

12. How many HI in 5 pk. ? 

13. How many bu. in 3^ ? 

14. If either a qt. or a liter of milk cost 6 ct., which 
would you prefer to purchase ? 

16. Which would you prefer to buy, 1 A. or 2.5^ for 
the same money ? 

16. Find the value of S 13 in g. 

17. Find the value ofl^ in lb. 

18. Express 2 gal. Ipt. 3gi. as liters. 

19. How many sters in 100 cu. ft. ? 

20. How many A. in 7^ ? 

21. Express l^mi. as m and as Hm. 

22. What cost 4 kilos of sugar at 5^ ct. per lb. ? 

23. What costs i a kilo of gold at $1 a pwt. ? 



172 



NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 



Tables fob Convenient Befebencb. 



Square Mbasurbb. 

144 sq. in. = 1 sq. ft. 
9 sq. ft. = 1 sq. yd. 
30 J sq. yd. = 1 sq. rd. 
leo sq. rd. = 1 A. 
640 A. =lsq.mi. 

16 sq. id. = 1 sq. ch. 
10 sq. ch. = 1 A. 

Cubic Mbasurbs. 

1728 cu. in. = 1 cu. ft. 
27 cu. ft. = 1 cu. yd. 



Tun. 


60 sec. 


= 1 min. 


OOmin. 


= lhr. 


24 hr. 


= lda. 


366 da. 


= lyr. 


366 da. 


= 1 leap yr. 


Trot 


Wb;qht. 


24 gr. 


= 1 pwt. 


20pwt. 


= loz. 


12 oz. 


= llb. 


Avoirdupois Wbioht. 


16 dr. 


= loz. 


16 oz. 


= llb. 


1001b. 


= Icwt. 


20 cwt. 


= lt. 


112 lb. 


= 11. cwt. 


2240 lb. 


= ll.t. 


Apothecaries* Weight. 


gr. 2C 


> = ai 


3 8 


1= 31. 


3 8 


^=si. 


S12 


I = lb.l. 


Linear Measures. 


12 in. 


= lft. 


3 ft. 


= lyd. 


6iyd.i 

16ift. i 


= lrd. 




320 id. 


= lmi. 


7.92 in. 


= 1U. 


100 li. 


= lch. 


80 ch. 


= lmi. 



16 cu. ft. 


= 1 cd. ft. 


128 cu. ft. 


= lcd. 


Liquid Mbabubbs. 


4gi. 


= lpt 


2pt. 


= Iqt. 


4qt. 


= lgal. 


Sligal. 


= 1 bbl. 


2bbl. 


= lhhd. 


Iqt. 


= 67f cu. in. 


Dry Measures. 


2pt. 


= lqt. 


8qt. 


= lpk. 


4pk. 


= lbu. 


Iqt. 


= 67i cu. in. 


Apothecaries* Fluid 


Measures. 


Tii60 


= f31. 


f38 


= fSi. 


fS16 


= 01. 


08 


= Cong.l. 



Art. 181.] 



SYNOPTIC CONVERSION. 



173 



Synoptic Conversion of English and Metric Units.* 



English to Metric. 



lin. 

1yd. 

Imi. 



= 2.64 «". 
= .9144™. 
= 1.60936 Km. 



Metric to English. 

im =39.87 in. 

IKm _ 1093.61 yd. 
8Km= 5 mi. nearly. 



1 sq. yd. 
lA. 



= .83613 qm. 
= .404687 Ha. 



iqm = lea - 10.7639 sq. ft. 
1* = 1 19.699 sq. yd. 
. lHa=2.471A. 



leu. in. 
1 cu. yd. 
Iqt. (U. S.) 



16.3872 wm. 
.76466 cum. 

.946361. 



icum- 61023.4 cu. in. 
= 35.3146 cu. ft. 
= 1.30794 cu. yd. 

1 cdm *) 

II I = 61.023 cu. in. 

= .26417gal. (U. S.) 
= 1.05668 qt. (U. S.). 



Igr. = 


64.7989 ««. 


IK = 16.4324 gr. 


1 lb. avoir. = 


.46359Kg. 


1K« = 2.20462 lb. avoir. 


It. (20001b.) = 


907. 18 Kg. 


IT = 2204.62 lb. avoir. 


1 l.t. (2240 lb.) = 


1.01605T. 


IT =.98421 l.t. (22401b.). 




Weights. 


1 bu. wheat 


= 60 lbs. 


1 stone = 14 lbs. 


1 ** potatoes 


= 60 *' 


1 bbl. pork = 200 " 


1 " beans 


= 60 " 


1 *' flour =196 ** 


1 ** corn 


= 56 " 


1 cental of grain = 100 ** 


1 " barley 


= 48 " 


1 quintal of fish = 100 *« 


1 " oats 


= 32 " 





* Arranged from the Smithsonian Tables. Figures printed in 
black type should be memorized. 



174 



NON-DECIMAL MEASURES. [Chap. VL 



Inches. 




Illlllllll 



iiiiiiiii 



1 



Centimeters. 



lin. =2.64«n. 



D 



iQCm. 



1 sq. in. 



1 sq. in. = 6.469«™. 



XT~~7 1 






^ecm. 




1 CU. in. 



1 CU. in. = 16.887 «»°* 



Art, 181.] 



175 



Diameter and height of a cylindrical liter 
measure and of a cylindrical quart measure. 

V = 61.063 cu. in. = 1000 «c™. 
1 qt. = 67.76 " 




176 APPROXIMATION. [Chap. Vn. 



CHAPTER VII. 

APPROXIMATION. 

182. No continuous magnitude can be measured with 
perfect accuracy. When, for example, we endeavor to 
make two pieces of wire equally long, all that we can 
ensure is, that they shall be of the same length so far as 
the eye, or other instrument, can judge; however, they may, 
and probably will, differ by some thousandths or even 
hundredths of an inch. 

In all questions involving continuous magnitude, such 
as length, weight, etc., we must, therefore, be content 
with apxyroximations (more or less accurate) to the true 
measure. It follows that calculations dependent upon 
measurement can give only approximately accurate 
results. 

For example, if we are told that a slab of stone is 17.6 inches 
long, and 12.4 inches wide, we are not to conclude that these are 
perfectly accurate measurements, but only that the measurements 
are near enough ioi practical purposes, the real length and breadth 
being at any rate less than 17.7 and 12.5 respectively. 

If the given measurements were accurate, the area of the slab 
would be 17.6 x 12.4 square inches. The actual area may, how- 
ever, have any value between 17.6 x 12.4 square inches and 
17.7 X 12.5 square inches ; that is, between 218.24 square inches 
and 221.25 square inches. 

183. When the measure of any quantity is given, for 
example, as 3.628, it generally means that the measure is 



Abts. 182-184.] APPROXIMATION. 177 

not less than 8.628, and not greater than 3.629, the possible 
error made by stopping at the third decimal place being 
an error in defect less than one one^housandUh of the 
unit. Now, if the above measure had to be given as far 
only as hundredths of the unit, 3.63 would be more accu- 
rate than 3.62. This principle is often employed when 
approximate measures are given. Thus the quantity 
whose measure is 6.57684 would be most accurately given 
by 6.6768, 6.577, or 6.58 to four, three, or two decimal 
places respectively, the possible error in excess or defect 
being now not greater than half the unit represented by 
the last decimal place retained. 

184. To find the sum of any numbers to any given num- 
ber of decimal places, it would be necessary to consider 
the figures two places beyond, in order to see what had 
to be * carried.' 

Ex. 1. Find, to 3 places of decimals^ the sum of 14.61825, 
3.17924, .618479, and 164.017236. 

14.618 



3.179 

.618 

164.017 

172.333 



25 
24 
479 
236 



Ex. 2. Findj to voithin one one-thousandth of the whole, the sum 
of 5.3184, 27.5162, 18.4196, and 23.0136. 



5.31 
27.51 
18.41 
23.01 



74.27 



84 
62 
96 
35 



Here we have to find the sum correct to the first four figures. 
The sum of the numbers in the filth column is 27, which is nearer 
to 30 than to 20. Hence, the most accurate sum to four figures 
wUl be 74.27. 



N 



178 



APPROXIMATION. 



[Chap. VIL 



The method of finding a product or a quotient to 
any required degree of accuracy will be seen from the 
following examples. 

Ex. 1. Find, to two places of decimals, the product of 4.168 and 

6.784. 

4.1({ 3 

84 



4.1)3; 


3 




6.7 
6 


20.81 


2.91 


41 


.33 


30 


.01 


66 



24.08 

Arrange with the decimal point of the multiplier as above, and 
begin the multiplication from the left of the multiplier. The verti- 
cal line on the left gives the figures which are to be finally retained ; 
it is, however, necessary to go two places beyond to see what 
should be * carried * to the last column retained. 

Multiply as usual so long as all the figures are to be retained. 
In the present case all the figures in the first two rows are to be 
retained. 

Before multiplying by 8, cross out the last figure of the multipli- 
cand, namely 3 ; then multiply 416 by 8, putting down the first 
figure of the product (adding in mentally what would be carried 
from the multiplication of the figure crossed out) in the last 
column. Now cross out another figure of the multiplicand, and 
multiply what remains by 4, again putting down the first figure of 
the product (with what must be carried from the multiplication of 
the last figure crossed out) in the last column. Proceed in this 
way to the end. 

Since the sum of the figures in the fifth column is 18, the most 
accurate product we can give to two places of decimals is 24.08. 



Ex. 2. Find, to within one one-millionth 
of the whole, the product of 61.6243 and 
112.4167. 



Here we have to find the product, correct 
to the first 7 figures. 



11 



6162.43 

616.243 

130.248 

20.649 

.616 

.309 

.036 



6803.433 



2.4 



6 

72 

24 

74 
13 



167 



Art. 186.] EXAMPLES. 179 

Ex. 3. Find, to within one one-millionth, the quotient 

516.24176 -r- 123.456. 

123.^?^)616.24176(4.181685 
493 824 

22 4177 
12 3456 



10 07216 
9 87648 

19567 
12346 



7222 
6172 

1050 
987 

63 

61 

We have here to find the first seven figures of the quotient. Having 
found the first three figures in the ordinary way, the remaining four 
figures, being less by two than the number of figures in the divisor, 
can be found by a shortened process ; namely, instead of annex- 
ing a naught at every stage on the right of the remainder as usual, 
we strike out the last figure on the right of the divisor instead, 
taking care, however, to use the last figure struck out to see what 
should be * carried \ 

Ex. 4. Find, to the nearest penny, the value of 

£61.3126x17.1874. 

Since' \d. = £ .001 nearly, it will be unnecessary to retain more 
than four decimal places in the product. 

Thus, 



&b\,zm 




17 


.1874 


513.126 




369.1875 




6.1312 


6 


4.1060 





.3591 


8 


206 


2 



£881.9285 
20 

8. 18.5700 
12 



(2.6.84 An8, £881. 188. Id, 



180 APPROXIMATION. [Chap. VU. 

HXAMPLBS T.XXTIT. 
Written Bxerelses. 

Find the following to the nearest thmisandth of the 
whole : 

1. 14.626x31.867. 4. 138.714x89.47. 

2. 16.816 X 19.714. 6. 314.2108 -s- 18.306. 

3. 166.423x176.46. 6. 81.4623 + 129.64. 

7. 16.8193 x 6.7149 -«- 1.3426. 

8. 116.416 X 123.618 + 119.417. 

Find, to within a millionth of the whole : 
9. 198.4663x6.194238. 10. 8.10976429 + 16.623. 

Find, to within one one-thousandth of the whole, the 
areas of the rectangles whose dimensions are : 

11. 17.216 in. by 34.827 in. 

12. 184.27 yd. by 112.63 yd. 

13. Find, to 4 places of decimals : 

/|\ 1 _L ± I 1 J ± I ± I 

^^ "^I"^lx2'^lx2x3"^lx2x3x4'^'" 
(ii) i_U 1 ^,_1 ^ 1 



11x2 1x2x3 1x2x3x4 

Find the value, to the nearest farthing, of 

14. £31.626x12.8743. 16. £ 119.48126 x .46127. 

Find, to the nearest cent, the value of 

16. $16.23x18.24. 18. $316.80x176.297. 

17. $17.32x112.428. 19. $30.47x2180.3079. 



Art. 185.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 181 

EXAMPLES LXXIV. 

Misoellaneoas Bxamples, Chapters V, TI, YII. 

Written Bxerolses. 

1. Find 18 X 19 X 25 X 16|. 

2. Express .035, .625, .12288 as common fractions in 
their lowest terms. 

3. How many times is 14 yd. 1 ft. 6 in. contained in 
244 yd. 3 in. ? 

4. Reduce 3 lb. 5 oz. 16 dwt. to gr., and express 1 oz. 
16 dwt. 11 gr. in avoirdupois weight. 

5. Find H.C.F. and L.C.M. of 936 and 2925. 

6. Arrange /^, yj^, and -^ in order of magnitude. 

7. Find the cost of 25cwt. 251b. 12 oz. of a sub- 
stance at $ 16 per cwt. 

8. Find the value of 51 things, any four of which are 
worth £ 19. 38, Id. 

9. Simplify if(l-|f) + ^\xi(i + ^). 

10. What is the least number which must be added to 
1000000 that the sum may be exactly divisible by 573 ? 

11. Multiply 4 mi. 31 rd. 4^ yd. by 3, and divide the 
result by 37. 

12. The circumferences of the large and the small 
wheels of a bicycle are 143 in. and 40 in. respectively; 
how many more turns will the latter have made than 
the former in a distance of 13 mi. ? 

13. A man spends 7.75 francs a day; how much does 
he save in a year (of 365 days) out of a yearly income 
of 3000 francs ? 

14. A man spends 9.35 marks a day ; how much in 
English money does he spend in a year (of 365 days), 
taking a mark to be worth ll|d. ? 



182 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chap. VII. 

16. A field is 192'" long and 57.75" wide; how many 
Ha does it contain, and what would it cost at 7500 
francs per Ha ? 

16. Reduce 772642 sq. yd. to A., sq. rd., and sq. yd. 

17. Find, in hr., min., and sec., .6575 of a day. 

18. What fraction of 8 lb. 11 oz. 2 dwt. 17 gr. is 10 
lb. 9oz. 16 dwt. 11 gr.? 

19. Reduce fj^, ^i^, and ^m ^ to decimals. 

20. A certain number was divided by 105, by * short ' 
divisions ; the quotient was 192, the first remainder was 1, 
the second was 4, and the third was 6. What was the 
dividend ? 

21. Find by factors the square root of 23716. 



22. What is the greatest sum of money of which both 
$ 11.05 and $ 188.50 are multiples ? 

23. How much would it cost to put gravel to a depth 
of a dm all over a court-yard 7.5" by 5.75", the gravel 
and labor costing 8 francs per ster ? 

24. A grocer buys 15cwt. of goods for $24.50; at 
what rate per lb. must he sell to gain $ 5.50 ? 

26. A druggist buys 501b. of a certain drug; how 
many weeks will it last if he uses Ibl 56 3l 32 gr. 10 
per week in putting up prescriptions ? 

26. Find If of 8 bu. 1 pk. 

27. How many numbers, each 567, must be added that 
the sum may be greater than a million ? 

28. What is the greatest number of Sundays there can 
be in a year ? On what day of the week will the first of 
February fall when the number of Sundays in a year of 
365 days is greatest ? 



Abt. 186.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 183 

29. How many times can 3 yd. 1 ft. 7 in. be sub- 
tracted in succession from 115 yd. 2 ft. 11 in., and what 
will be the last remainder ? 

30. A bar of metal weighing 100 oz. 16 dwt. is made 
into coins, each weighing 1 oz. 8 dwt. ; how many coins 
are made from the bar ? 



31. Simplifyl|of^^+|2|-fof^}. 

32. A surveyor measured some ground and found it to 
be 10 ch. long and 4 ch. broad ; how many A. were there ? 

33. What is the smallest number of exact acres that 
can have the form of a square ? 

34. What decimal of 1 mi. is 119 yd. 2 ft. 4in. ? 

36. Find the value of 21b. 6oz. 10 dwt. 12 gr. of 
gold at $ 216 per lb. 

36.. Find 1052; 43 ^ 33^. 350 ^ i5|, 

37. Express lb. 1 as the decimal of 1 lb. Avoir. 

38. Having given that a meter is 39.37 in., prove that 
the difference between 5 mi. and 8^™ is nearly 51 yd. 



39. Add 

S «f Tm of «4.65 to ;^ of ?i±{4 of f 1.15. 

40. Find VMM ^^^ reduce the answer to lowest terms. 

41. Express .88125 cwt. in lb. and oz. 

42. Express 15 yd. 2 ft. 8 in. as the decimal of a mi. 

43. Reduce 11.2765625 lb. to lb., ox., pwt., and gr. 

44. Find to the nearest cent $ 48.96 x 72.8967. 
46. Reduce 1000 sq. yd. to qm. 

46. Reduce 1000^ to pt. 



f 



184 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chaps. VU., VIIL 

• • • • 

47. Express .136 x 7.3 + .43 as a decimal. 

48. Find the value of 43 sq. rd. 24 J sq. yd. of building 
land at $ 1815 per acre. 

49. Find the greatest length of which both 1 mi. 4 fur. 
16 rd. 2 yd. and 1 mi. 1 fur. 10 rd. 2 yd. are multiples. 

50. Subtract 16^ X -iL from ^-^LIl. 

61. Find y.004 to 4 decimal places. 

62. Reduce 4^ to pounds Troy. 

7 



53. Simplify 



5 + 



1- 



3-^ 

54. Find the annual cost of repairing a road 9 mi. 
120 rd. 177 yd. long at $ 88 per mi. 

66. A vessel steams 18 knots an hour; to how many 
statute miles is this equivalent ? 

66. If a ccm of iron weighs 7.788', what will be the 
weight of a cu. ft. ? 

67. How many pieces each .17 in. long can be cut from 
a wire 21.09 in. long; and how long will be the piece 
left over? 

68. Add .5125 of a yd., .62734 of a rd., and .018325 of 
a fur. ; subtract the result from .0049 of a mi., and ex- 
press the answer in yd., also in dm. 

69. Find V4900546043.21156004. 

60. What is the least number which when 
divided by 15 leaves a remainder 3, when 

« " 24 " " " 12? 



Arts. 186, 187.] 



AREAS. 



185 



CHAPTER VIII. 



AREAS — VOLUMES. 



186. A plane figure [Art. 149] bounded by four straight 
lines, and whose four angles are equal, is called a 
Rectangle. 

An equilateral rectangle is a Square. 



Rectangles. 



Square. 



The amount of surface included within the bounding 
lines of a figure is called its Area, and the area is measured 
by some square unit, — one sq. in., one sq. yd., or one 
qm, etc. 






F 



B 



187. To find the Area of a Rectangle. — Let ABCD be 

the rectangle whose area is required. 



186 AREAS— VOLUMES. [Chap. VIII. 

Suppose, for example, that AB is 4 in. and that AD is 3 in. 
Divide AB into four equal parts and AD into three equal parts, 
and draw lines parallel to the sides as in the figure on the left. 

Then the rectangle is divided into squares each of which is a 
sq. in. ; and the number of these squares is clearly the product 
of the number of in. in AB by the number of in. in AD. 

The above reasoning applies to all cases, both the length and 
the breadth of the rectangle being an integral number of in. 

Now suppose, for example, that in the figure on the right AB is 
f in., and that AD is { in. 

Let AEFG be one sq. in. Divide AE into two equal parts, 
and AG into five equal parts, and OD into two equal parts. 
Then the subdivisions of AB will be all equal, as also those of AD. 
Hence, if lines be drawn as in the figure, ABCD will be divided 

into 3x7 equal rectangles, such that the square inch AEFG will 

3x7 
contain 2 x 5 of these rectangles. Hence AB will contain 

square inches ; that is, (f x i) square inches. ^ 

From the above it follows that the ntunber of square 
inches (or square feet, etc.) in a rectangle is equal to the 
product of the number of inches (or feet, etc.) in the length 
by the number of inches (or feet, etc.) in the breadth. 

It should be noticed that the length and breadth must 
both be expressed in terms of the same unit. 

For example, the area of a rectangle whose length is 2 ft. and 
breadth 6 in. is (2 x ^) sq. ft , or (24 x 6) sq. in. 

The above rule for finding the area of a rectangle is often ex- 
pressed shortly by the statement that area = length x breadth. 

18ft Now that we find the area of a rectangle, we can 
see that the relations between the different units given in 
the Table for Square Measure, on page 149, follow at once 
from the relations between the corresponding units in 
linear measure. 

For, since 12 in. make 1 ft, (12 x 12) sq.in. make 1 sq.ft. 
Since 3ft. make 1yd., (3 x 3) sq.ft. make 1 sq. yd. 



Arts. 188, 189.] EXAMPLES. 187 

Since 5} yd. make 1 rd., (6} x 6}) sq. yd. make 1 sq. rd. 

Again, 22yd. make Ich., therefore/ (22 x 22) sq.yd. =484sq. 
yd. make 1 sq. ch. 

Thus, 4840 sq. yd. = 10 sq. oh. = 1 A. 

Also, 1 sq. mi. = (1760 x 1760) sq. yd. = 1760 x 1760 ^ 4840 A. 
= 640 A. 

Ex. Find the acreage of a rectangular field whose length is 132 
yd. and whose breadth is 38^ yd. 

The area = (132 x 38^) sq. yd. 

=:6082 8q.yd. = fJUA. 
= }4A. = 1A. 8sq.rd. 

189. If the area of a rectangle be known, and also the 
length, the breadth can be at once found. 

For example, to find the breadth of a rectangle whose length is 
15 ft. and whose area is 200 sq. ft. 

Since the product of the number of ft. in the breadth by the 
number of ft. in the length is equal to the number of sq. ft. in 
the area, we have 

breadth = (200 -- 16) ft. = 13J ft. = 13 ft. 4 in. 



BXAMPLES LXXV. 
Written Exerotses. 

Find the areas of the rectangles whose lengths and 
breadths are as follows : 

1. 14 ft., 12 ft. 6. 10 yd., 23 ft. 

2. 22 ft., 17 ft. 7. 5 yd. 1ft., 3 yd. 2 ft. 

3. 25 yd., 17 yd. 8. 21 yd. 2 ft., 18 yd. 

4. 122 in., 114 in. 9. 13 ft. 4 in., 9 ft. 2 in. 
6. 5 ft., 17 in. 10. 11 ft. 9 in., 8 ft. 7 in. 



188 AREAS —VOLUMES. [Ckjlt. YUL 

Find the acreage of the rectangular fields whose lengths 
and breadths are as follows : 

11. 319 yd., 275 yd. 16. 550 yd., 400 yd. 

12. 363 yd., 240 yd. 16. 125 yd., 49^ yd. 

13. 400 yd., 214^ yd. 17. Length x breadth = ? 

14. 178|yd., 162 J yd. 18. Area -+• length = ? 

19. Area -*• breadth = ? 

20. Find the area of a rectangular field whose length 
is 119.5™ and whose breadth is 96.2". 

21. How many stones having rectangular tops 2*" 
X 1.2'*" will be required to pave a street 5°" long and 
16.8" wide, provided no spaces are left between the 
stones ? 

22. Find the area of a rectangular field whose length 
is 9 ch. 12 li. and whose breadth is 6 ch. 25 li. 

23. Find the area of a rectangular field whose length 
is 9 ch. 25 li. and whose breadth is 7 ch. 75 li. 

24. The area of a rectangle is 925sq. in., and its 
breadth is 25 in. ; what is its length ? 

26. What is the length of a rectangular table the area 
of whose top is 71 sq. ft. 16 sq. in., and the breadth 6 ft. 
8 in.? 

26. The area of a rectangular court-yard is 52 sq. yd. 
2 sq. ft. 36 sq. in., and its length is 14 yd. 9 in. ; what is 
its breadth ? 

27. What will it cost to paint the ceiling of a room 
whose length is 24 ft. 6 in. and breadth 16 ft. 6 in. at 
$.60 per sq. yd. ? 

28. What is the area of a square floor 7" long ? 

29. What is the length of a square room whose area is 

4225 «dm? 



Abt. 190.] CARPETING, ETC. 189 



Carpeting, Pa.pering, Plastering. 

190. Examples like the following are of frequent 
occurrence : 

Ex. 1. How much will he the cost of a carpet for a room 16 ft, 
X 20 ft. 3 in. with carpet 27 in. wide at <^.76a yd., the strips running 
lengthwise f 

Number of strips = 20 ft. 3 in. ^ 27 in. = 9. 

Total length of carpet = 16 ft. x 9 = 144 ft. = 48 yd. 

Cost = 48 yd. x <^.75 = $36. [Art. 50.] 

Ex. 2. How much will he the cost of paper for the walls of a 
room \Qft. 3 in. long, lb ft. 9 in, wide^ and 12 ft. high, the paper 
being 21 in. wide and costing 6 ct. per yard ? 

Area of a wall = its length x its height. 
. *. Area of 4 walls = distance around the room x height 

= 70 ft. X 12 ft. 

= 840 sq. ft. 
Length of paper = 840 sq. ft. -4- f J ft. 

= 480 ft = 160 yd. 
Cost of paper = 160 yd. x 6 ct. 

= 88.00. 



Note. In the preceding questions we have found the quantity 
of carpet (or wall paper) which would be required if it were of 
one uniform color throughout. When, as is almost invariably the 
case, there is a pattern on the carpet or paper, there must be a 
certain amount of waste, if the different lengths are properly 
fitted together. Moreover, wall papers are sold in lengths of 8 
yards, called rolls ; if, therefore, as in Ex. 2, 160 yards of paper 
were required, 20 rolls would have to be bought. American wall 
papers are generally 18 inches wide. 

Ex. 3. A room 21 ft. by 19 ft. has a Turkey carpet in it, a border 
Bft, wide all round being left uncovered by the carpet. The 
border was stained at a cost of $ .45 a square yard, and the carpet 
cost 8 4.50 a square yard; what was the total cost f 

Since the border is 3 ft. wide all round the room, the length of 
the carpet must be 21 ft. — 3 ft. x 2 = 15 ft., and the breadth must 
be 19ft. -3ft. X 2 = 13ft. 



190 AREAS— VOLUMES. [Chap. Vlll. 

Area of carpet = 16 ft. x 13 ft. = ^^ sq. yd. 

Price of carpet = $4.60 x y = f 97.60. 

Border = area of room — area of carpet 

= (21 X 19) sq. ft. - (16 X 13) sq.ft 

= 204 sq. ft = Y sq. yd. 
Cost of staining = $.46 x ^3^ = $10.20. 
Total cost = $97.60 + $ 10.20 

= $107.70. 



EXAMPLES LXXVI. 
Written Exerolsea. 

1. How much carpet 27 in. wide will cover a room 
22 ft. 6 in. long and 15 ft. 9 in. wide, carpet running 
lengthwise ? What will be the cost at $1.20 per yd. ? 

2. A room is 8.3"" long and 5" wide; how many 
meters of carpet must be purchased for such a room, the 
strips being 7*" wide and running crosswise ? How much 
in width must be turned under ? In surface ? 

3. If you were carpeting a room 9" x6", which way 
would you have the strips run if they were 6.8^"° wide? 
How many less qm would be used than by running the 
strips the other way ? 

4. A room is 10 yd. 2 ft. long and 7 yd. 1ft. 6 in. 
wide ; find the cost of covering it with Turkey carpet at 
$1.25 a sq. yd. 

6. Find the cost of carpeting a room 8^ yd. long by 
6 yd. 2 ft. broad with carpet 2 J ft. wide at 84 ct. a yd. 

6. What would be the expense of carpeting a room 
24 ft. 6 in. by 18 ft. with carpet 27 in. wide, and which 
costs $1.20 a yd. ? 



Art. 190.] CARPETING, ETC. l91 

7. How mucli carpet 27 in. wide would be required 
for a room 32 ft. by 23 ft., a margin 4 ft. wide being 
left uncovered ? 

8. Find the area of the four walls of a room 15 ft. 
long, 14 ft. wide, and 10 ft. high. 

9. Find the area of the four walls of a room 16 ft. 
4 in. long, 13 ft. 8 in. wide, and 11 ft. 4 in. high. 

10. Find the area of the four walls of a room 10.5" 
long, 5"* wide, and 4.9™ high. 

11. Find the qm of the four walls of a room 7" x 4™ 
X 3.2", leaving out 3 windows, each 2" x 1.1", and one 
door 2.4" x 1.3". 

12. Find the area of the four walls of a room 14 ft. 
6 in. long, 13 ft. 10 in. wide, and 10 ft. 8 in. high. 

13. A room is 18 ft. long, 13 ft. 6 in. wide, and 12 ft. 
high ; how much paper 21 in. wide will be required to 
cover the walls, and what will be the cost at $ .75 per 
piece of 12 yd. ? 

14. How much will it cost to paper a room 17 ft. 6 in. 
square, and 14 ft. 3 in. high, with paper 1 ft. 9 in. wide 
at 12 ct. a yd. ? 

16. A room is 6.1" x 5" x 4.2"; find the cost of plas- 
tering at 62^ ct. per qm, allowing 7**" for windows, 
door, and base-board. Do not forget the ceiling. 

16. A room 8" x 5,6"^ x 4.2" has 4 windows, each 
2.1" X 1", 2 doors, each 2.8" x 1.4", and a base-board 
2.4*" high; find (i) the cost of plastering at 60 ct. per 
qm, (ii) the cost of paper 5^" wide at $3.50 per roll of 
10", (iii) the cost of a carpet 6.2^" wide at $2 per m, 
all for this room. Find the total cost, allowing $ 15 for 
labor in putting on the paper and laying the carpet. 



I 

i 



192 AREAS — VOLUMES. [Chap. VIIL 



BoABD Measure. 

191. A board which is one foot square and one inch or 
less in thickness has a measm^ement called one Board 
Foot. 

Boards and squared timber are sold by the Board Foot 



The number of boa7'd feet in a board one inch or 
less in thickness is the same as the number of square feet 
in tlie surface. 

The niunber of board feet in a stick of timber more 
than one inch thick is the number of square feet in the 
surface multiplied by the number of inches in the thick- 
ness. 

Ex. 1. How many board feet in a board 20/1. x 2 ft, x J of 

an inch f 

20 ft. X 2 f t. = 40 board feet. 

Ex. 2. How many boa)*dfeet in a board 16 ft. long, 18 in. wide 
at one end aiul 14 in, wide at the other end, and i an inch thick f 

15ft. X IJ ft. = 20 board ft. 

In this case the average width is used. 

Ex. 3. How many board feet in a stick of timber 21.6 ft, long^ 
14 in. wide, and 3| in. thick f 

21.6ft. X IJft. = 26.2 board ft., 

if the stick were 1 in. or less in thickness. But we must multiply 
this result by 3f , since the timber is 3| in. thick. Thus, 

21.6 ft. X J ft. X Y = 92.4 board ft. 

EXAMPLES T.XXVII. 
Written Exercises. 

Find the number of board feet in the following : 

1. A board 20 ft. x 2 ft. x 1^ in. 

2. A board 19 ft. 8 in. x 1 ft. 9 in. x -Jin. 



Abts. 191-193.] DIMENSIONS OF CIRCLES. 193 

3. A timber 13 ft. x 1.1 ft. x 4 J in. 

4. A joist 11 ft. X 5 in. x 2 in. 
6. A joist 16 ft. X 6 in. X 2^ in. 

6. Find the cost of each of the above five pieces at 
$20 per M; i.e., by the thousand (board feet). 

7. A hall 76 ft. x 50 ft. has two layers of boards for 
its floor, one kind costing $ 12 per M, and the other cost- 
ing $21 per M; the floor timbers, 70 in number, are 
placed crosswise, and cost $ 16 per M. How much is the 
cost of material, the boards being fin. thick, and the 
timbers 8 in. x 3 in. 

Dimensions op Circles. 

' 193. Cut from cardboard a circular piece having a 
known radius, as 3^™, or 3 in. Roll the circle (held 
upright) along a straight line and measure the line trav- 
ersed in one complete rotation of the circle. This line 
will be found to be about S^- times the diameter. 

We have no means of finding the exact measure of the 
circumference in terms of the diameter, but by means of 
geometry we learn that the measure is 3.1416 (nearly) 
times the diameter. This is more exact than S^. 

Hence, Diameter x 3.1416 = Circumference, 
and C -f- 3.1416 = D.* 

Using the results obtained in geometry for areas of 

circles, we have. 

Area = R^ x 3.1416, 

R* =Area ^3.1416, 

R = VArea -4- 3.1416. 

* D, B, and G stand for diameter, radius, and circumference, 
respectively. 



194 AREAS — VOLUMES. [Chap. VIII. 

Ex. 1. The diameter of a circle is 1(H«; find the cireun^erence 
and area, 

C = Dx 3.1416 Area = J2« x 3.1416 

= 10d» X 3.1416 = 25Q<»» X 3.1416 

= 31.416d». = 78.54 Qd«. 

Ex. 2. The area of a circle is 60.2666 sq. in. ; find the radius 
and the circumference. 

B = VArea^ 3.1416 C=D X 3.1416 

= V60.2666 + 3.1416 =8x3. 1416 

= Vl6 =25. 1328 in. 

= 4 in. 

EXAMPLES LXXVIU. 
Written Exercise*. 

Find the circumference when 

1. Z> = 14in. 3. i? = 15«». 6. i> = 56 yd. 

2. 2> = 75ft. 4. i? = 18». 6. i? = ^mi. 

Find 
7. R when C = 314.16"". 8. D when (7 = 1 mi. 
9. Z> when O ='153.9384 yd. 
10. R when C = 47.124«. 

Find area when 

11. i? = 14ft. 13. 0=37.6992^. 

12. i> = 20'". 14. C = 251.328 rd. 

16. How many sq. ft. in the floor of a circular room 
whose diameter is 28 ft. ? 

16. The bottom of a round liter measure has a surface 
of 500*^^"*; find the approximate radius. 

17. Find the cost of concreting a circular fountain 
basin whose diameter is 20 ft., the work and material 
costing $ 3.27 per sq. yd. 



Abts. 194, 195.] RECTANGULAR SOLIDS. 



195 



Rbctangulab Solids. 

194 That which has length, breadth, and thickness is 
called a Solid. 

A solid bounded by six rectangular [Art. 186] faces is 
called a Rectangular Solid. 

A cube [Art. 151] is one form of a rectangular solid. 

Any substance (water, air, wood, etc.) may be a rectan- 
gular solid in form. 

The space included between the bounding surfaces of 
a solid is called its Capacity (or Volume), and the capacity 
of a solid is measured by some cubic unit — one cu. in., 
one cu. ft., 1**", or 1*^", etc. 

195. To find the Capacity of a Rectangular Solid. 

Suppose, for example, that the dimensions of the solid 
are 5 in. by 4 in. by 3 in. We can divide the edges re- 
spectively into 5, 4, and 3 parts, each being one inch; and 
if planes be drawn thi'ough the points of division parallel 
to the outer faces of the solid, as in the figure, the whole 
solid will be divided into equal cubes each of which is a 
cubic inch. 




There will be as many layers of cubes as there are inches 
in the height of the solid, and the number of cubes in each 
layer will be the product of the number of inches in the 
length by the number of inches in the breadth. 



196 AREAS — VOLUMES. [Chap. VIDL 

Thus, the number of cubic inches (or cubic feet, etc.) in a 
rectangular solid is equal to the continued product of the 
number of inches (or feet, etc.) in its length, breadth, and 
thickness. 

196. Now that we can find the capacity of a rectangular 
solid, we can find the relations between the cubic yard, 
the cubic foot, and the cubic inch. 

For 1 cu. yd. = (3 X 3 X 3) cu. ft., 

and 1 cu. ft. = (12 x 12 x 12) cu. m. 

Ex. 1. Find the volume of a rectangular block of stone 12 ft. 
longj 1ft, wide, and 1ft, 6 in, high. 

Volume = (12 X 7 X li) cu. ft. = 126 cu. ft. 

Ex. 2. A beam 1ft. 6 in. wide and 1ft. Sin. high contains 46^ 
cubic feet of timber; what is its length 9 

Since volume = length x breadth x thickness, 

length = I2!HES 

breadth x thickness 

Hence, length required = _ 1__ = 24} ft, 

Ex. 3. Hovo many gallons of water will a cistern hold if it is 
6 ft. long, ^ft. 6 in. wide, and Zft. 6 in. high f [A gallon con- 
tains 231 cu,in.'\ 

The cistern will hold 

(72 X 64 X 42) cu. in. = 163296 cu. in. 
Hence, the number of gallons required = 163296 -^ 231 = 706.90. 

Ex. 4. The external dimensions of a rectangular stone tank are : 
length 12 ft. 6 in., breadth Sft., and height ^ft. The interior is also 
rectangular, and the sides and bottom are 3 in, thick. Find the 
number of cu.ft. of stone in the tank. 

The internal length = 12 ft. 6 in. - 3 in. x 2 = 12 ft., 
the internal breadth = 8 ft. — 3 in. x 2 = 7 ft. 6 in., 

and the internal height = 4 ft. - 3 in. = 3 ft. 9 in. 



Art. 196.] EXAMPLES. 197 

Now the volume of the stone is the difference between the 
volumes given by the external and internal dimensions. 
Hence, volume required 

= (12i X 8 X 4 - 12 X 7i X 3|) cu. ft. 
= (400 - 337i) cu. ft. = 62i cu. ft. 

EXAMPLES LXXIX. 
Written Exercises. 

Find the volumes of the rectangular solids whose 
dimensions are 

1. 5 ft. by 4 ft. by 2 ft. 

2. 12 ft. by 6 ft. by 4 ft. 

3. 3 yd. by l^yd. by 2 ft. 

4. 5 yd. by 2^ yd. by 4 ft. 

5. 6 ft. 4 in. by 4 ft. 3 in. by 2 ft. 6 in. 

6. 7 ft. 9 in. by 5 ft. 3 in. by 3 ft. 6 in. 

7. 5 yd. 1ft. by 3 yd. 2 ft. by 2 ft. 9 in. 

8. 6 yd. 9 in. by 2 yd. 1 ft. by 2 ft. 7 in. 

9. A rectangular block of stone 4 ft. long and 2 ft. 
6 in. broad contains 17|cu. ft. of stone; what is its 
height ? 

10. Find the length of a rectangular beam which con- 
tains 98 cu. ft. of timber and whose cross-section is 2 ft. 
square. 

11. How many loads (cu.yd.) of gravel would be 
required to cover a path 150 yd. long and 4 ft. wide to 
a depth of 2 in. ? 

12. A school-room whose floor is 60 ft. by 40 ft. has 
accommodation for 360 children, allowing 100 cu. ft. of 
air for each child; what must be the heiglit of the room ? 



198 AREAS — VOLUMES. [Chap. VIII. 

13. If 1 gal. = 231 cu. in. and 1 gal. of water weighs 
8.355 lb. Avoir., find the number of gal. and the weight 
of the water which would fall on an area of an A. during 
a rainfall of one in. 

14. A tank is 21ft. 4 in. long, 3 ft. wide, and 2 ft. 
deep ; it is filled with water to within 3 in. of the top. 
What is the volume of the water, and what is its weight ? 
[A cu. ft. of water weighs 1000 oz.] 

16. What weight of water will fall on a road ^ a mi. 
long and 30 ft. wide during a rainfall of an in.? 

16. A level tract of land 20 mi. long and f of a mi. 
broad is flooded to a depth of 4 ft. Given that a cu. ft. 
of water weighs 62.51b., find in t. the weight of the 
water on the land. 

17. What is the capacity of a tank 20"» x 8" x 2"? 
How many T of water will it hold ? Reduce the T to 
t. (tonneaux to tons). 

18. Find the total surface of the stone in Ex. 9. 

19. Find the inner surface of the tank in Ex. 17. 

20. A square room is 5" long and 3" high ; how many 
cu. in. of air will the room contain ? 

21. A square room 9 ft. 3 in. high has a capacity of 
1563 J cu. ft.; what is the length of the room ? 

Cylinders. 

197. A solid T^^hose ends are circles and whose curved 
surface is perpendicular to the ends is called a Right 
Circular Cylinder. 

The ends are called Bases. 

For example, a common lead pencil is a right circular cylinder; 
and some tin measures used for liquids are right circular cylinders. 

Note. When cylinders are mentioned in this book, right circu- 
lar cylinders are meant 



AttTs. 197, 108.] 



CTLIKDERS. 



199 



19& The- total Buriaee of a cylinder consists of two 
surfaces (circles) 
- curved surface 
he Lateral Sur- 



Diece of paper be 
a cylinder so as 
all its lateral sur- 
then unrolled, It 
I rectangle wbose 
the circumference 
'Under and whose 
B the height of the 



Hence, lateral surface = C x height ; 
which (by Art. 193) =Dx 3.1416 x H; 
whence H= lateral surface ■*• (D x 3.1416), 

and ■ 7> = lateral surface + (3.1416 x-ff). 

Ex. 1. Find the total surface of a cylinder 8 in. high and (A< 
radiw of whose base is 2 in. 

Total surface = 2 bases + lateral surface 

= 2 B2 X 3.1410 + Dx 3.U16 x H 
= 2E x3.1418(ii + a) 
= 4 X 3.1416 X 10 
= 125.864 aq. in. 
Note. fl'=heiglit; D = diameter ; C= circumference. 

Ex. 2. The lateral turface of a cylinder is 188.4S6i^ ; find the 
height when D = &. 

H= 138.496 -!- (U X 3.1416) 
= 188.496 + 16.6496 
= 10"^. 



200 



AREAS — VOLUMES. 



[Chap. VIII. 



199. If a cylinder is 10 in. high, it is evident that it 
will contain 10 times as many cubic inches as if it were 1 

in. high; since the number of cubic 
inches in a cylinder 1 in. high is the 
same as the number of square inches in 
the base, the 

Volame of a cylinder = base x H, 

or (Art. 193), = R« x 3.1416 x H, 

Volume 



:s^==: 



and 



and 



and 



H= 



IP = 



IP X 3.1416' 
V 



R 



3.1416 X H 
-4: 



3.1416 X H 



Ex. 1. Find the volume of a cylinder whose height Is 10 in. and 
the radius of whose bass is 6in» 

F= ^x 3.1416 X JET 
= 36 X 3.1416 X 10 
= 1130.976 cu. in. 

Ex. 2. Find the radius of the base of a cylinder whose volume 
is 126.664 «<^" and whose height is 1". 






3.1416 X H 

126.664~ 
3.1416 X 10 
= 2*». 



BXAMPLBS LXXX. 



Written Exercises. 



Find, in a cylinder, the 

1. Lateral surface when i? = 3*" and JJ= 14*". 

3. Lateral surface when 12 = 1 in. and ^= 5 in. 



Aht8. 199, 200.] SPECIFIC GRAVITY. 201 

3. Total surface when D = 10" and JB'= 8". 

4. H when lateral surface = 1413.72^^ and D = IS**"*. 

5. Fwhen22 = 3*" and 5'= 14*". 

6. F when 22 = 1 in. and H= 5 in. 

7. F when D = 10" and JT= 8". 

8. ^when F= 125.664 cu. ft. and R = 2K 

9. B when F= 1570.8^ and H= 20*". 

10. Measure in centimeters the height and diameter of 
some cylinder and calculate how many cubic centimeters 
of liquid it would hold if hollow. How many grams of 
water would it hold ? 

Specific Gravity. 

200. Weigh accurately a stone. Then place it in a jar 
brimful of water and weigh the water which runs over. 
Now divide the weight of the stone by the weight of the 
water which ran over, and you will know how many times 
the weight of the stone is greater than the weight of 
the same volume of water. 

The number of times that the weight of a substance is 
greater than the weight of the same volume of water is 
called the Specific Gravity (S.G.) of the substance. 

A body floating in water displaces a weight of water 
equal to its own weight. 

EXAMPLBS liXXXI. 
Written Exerolses. 

1. The S.G. of iron is 7.8 ; how much does a cu. ft. of 
iron weigh ? A cu. in. ? A ccm ? 

2. What is the weight of a cdm of silver, its S.G. being 
10.6? 



202 AREAS — VOLUMES. [Chap. VIH. 

3. A rectangular iron tank weighs 25 kilos, and it 
floats on water; what is the weight of the water dis- 
placed ? What is the volume of wat^r displaced ? What 
is the volume of iron in the tank ? 

4. A cubical liter measure weighs 150 grams ; if put 
in water, what pressure must be added to its own weight 
to make it sink ? 

6. The S.G. of gold is 19.5; if a person can lift 125 
lb., how many cu. in. of gold can he lift at one time ? 

6. What is the weight of a cdm of gold in pounds 
Avoir. ? In pounds Troy ? What is its value at $1 per 
pwt. ? 

If the stone mentioned in Art. 200 be weighed in air 
and then in water, the loss of weight will be found equal 
to the weight of the water which ran over. Therefore 
if we divide the weight of a substance by its loss of weight 
in water, we shall obtain its S.G. 

7. A substance weighs 2501b. in air and 1251b. in 
water ; what is its S.G. ? How much water would run over 
if the substance were put into a jar brimful of water? 
What is the volume of the substance ? 

8. A piece of wood, S.G. .25, floats on water and dis- 
places 40 ccm of water ; what is the volume of the wood ? 
How much iron must be attached to the wood to make it 
float under water ? 

9. How much weight will a ccm of iron lose when 
weighed in air and then in water ? 

Note. S.G. = weight in air -j- loss in water. 

10. A person weighing 146^ lb. has a S.G. of 1.0417; 
how much does he weigh in water ? 



Art. 200.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 203 

EXAMPLES LXXXII. 
Miscellaneoas f^xamples, Chapter Till. 

1. Find the cost of graveling a carriage drive 69 ft. 
9 in. long and 16 ft. wide, at 30 ct. per sq. yd. 

2. The outer and inner boundaries of a gravel path 
are squares, and the path is 4 ft. wide. The side of the 
square enclosed by the path is 50 yd. How much would 
it cost to gravel the path at 37^ ct. a superficial yd. ? 

3. Find the cost of turfing a lawn tennis court which 
is 78 ft. long and 39 ft. wide, making a margin of grass 
12 ft. wide at each end and 6 ft. wide at each side ; the 
turf costing 4d, a sq. yd. 

4. Find the prime numbers from 100 to 125 by using 
the sieve. [Art. 78.] 

5. What will be the lowest cost of carpeting a room 
33 ft. long and 24 ft. wide with carpet 27 in. wide and 
costing 85 ct. a yd., a border one yd. wide being left 
uncovered ? How broad a strip must be cut off, or turned 
under ? 

6. Multiply 688.4 by 99; 460.01237 by 11. 

7. Find the number of cu. ft. in a school-room by using 
its length, breadth, and height ; find also the area of its 
six surfaces, including windows, etc. 



8. Find the cost of covering the floor of a hall 39 ft. 
4^ in. long by 20 ft. llf in. wide with tiles each 5\ in. 
by 4|in., and costing (including the labor of laying 
them) $4.95 a hundred. 

9. What is the weight of an iron girder 20 ft. long, 
and having 54sq. in. sectional area, the weight of iron 
being 480 lbs. per cu. ft. ? 



204 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chap. Vm. 

10. A hall is 103.23 ft. long and 83.25 ft. broad, and 
it is to be paved with equal square tiles ; what is the size 
of the largest tile which will exactly fit, and how many 
of them will be required ? 

11 . A room 22 ft. 3 in. long, 17 ft. 9 in. wide, and 12 ft. 
6 in. high has two windows each 5 ft. 3 in. by 3 ft. 4 in., 
a door 7 ft. by 3 ft. 9 in., and a fireplace 5 ft. 3 in. by 
4 ft. 4 in. How many pieces (each 12 yd. long) of 
paper 21 in. wide would have to be bought to paper the 
room? 

12. How many sq. ft. of boards are required for the 
floor of a circujar hall 100 ft. in diameter ? 

13. What would be the weight of a beam of oak 5**^ 
square and 7" long, on the supposition that the S.G. of 
oak is .896 ? 

14. Divide 8921046 by 386 by the method of Art. 69. 



15. Supposing a postage stamp to be 1 in. long and 
^ of an in. broad, how many stamps would be required 
to cover a wall which is 16 ft. 6 in. long and 10 ft. 8 in. 
high? 

16. What is the cost of paper for the hall of Ex. 12, 
the hall being 25 ft. high, at $.67 a roll, allowing 600 
sq. ft. for windows, etc. ? 

17. A cubical cistern, open at the top, costs £16. 13a. 4d. 
to line with lead at 2d, per qdm; how many cum of 
water will it hold ? 

18. I have a rectangular box cover ^ of a meter long 
and ^ of a meter broad to be painted in squares ; what 
is the largest square I can use ? 

19. Find ^^Q — to three decimal places. 



Abt. 200.] MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. 205 

20. Find the number of board feet in a stick of timber 
8^ in. square at one end, 8^ in. by 5f in. at the other, 
and 21 ft. long. 

21. Mnd, by dividing by factors, 40579 -^ 72. 

22. How many cdm of water are required to fill a 
cylindrical tank whose radius is lO**" and whose height 
is2»? 

23. A cylindrical tank holds 1884.96^, and its height 
is 16f **™; what is its radius? 

24. How many cu. in. of wood are there in a wooden 
box whose external dimensions are 4 ft. 4 in. by 3 ft. 

10 in. by 3 ft. 6 in., the wood being everywhere 1 in. 
thick? 

25. An iron safe is everywhere l^in. thick, and its 
external dimensions are 6 ft. by 4 ft. 6 in. by 3 ft. 6 in. 
How much does the iron weigh? [The S.G. of iron has 
been given several times.] 

26. It cost 81.75/. to gravel a rectangular court-yard 
8.25"" X 4.8" with gravel costing 7.5/. per st. What was 
the thickness of the layer of gravel ? 

27. An importer received 427 T of goods at 125/ per 
T; he paid the custom house $1602.92; his expenses 
of cartage, etc., were $212 ; for how much must he sell 
the goods per cwt. in order to make a profit of $2000 ? 

28. The velocity of flow of water through a pipe 6**°* in 
diameter is 7.6*^ per sec. ; how many 1 flow through 
in 11 sec. ? 

29. A room is 18ft. 1 in. long, lift. Sin. wide, and 

11 ft. 3 in. high ; how many rolls of paper would be used 
in papering the walls, supposing that windows, etc., make 
up \ of the whole surface of the walls ? 



206 MISCELLANEOUS EXAMPLES. [Chap. VHI. 

30. How much would it cost to carpet the room of Ex. 
29, the carpet being 1 yd. wide, at $1.66f per yd. ? 

31. The S.G. of a piece of wood is .6 ; the wood being 
8" X 8^ X 8*°, how many kilos would be required to sink 
the wood if placed on water ? 

32. Find J\2 |600 - (4 150 - 25.5 - 16) + 3| 

- (4.1 12^^) _ /'^ X 90 + 50^1. 

.33. The S.G. of gold is 19.5 ; find the weight of V^ 
and the volume of 1 kilo. 

34. A pile of wood is 8 ft. long, 4 ft. high, and 4 ft. 
broad; what is its volume in cu. ft. ? 

35. How many such volumes (Ex. 34) in a pile 49.6 
ft. long, 8 ft. high, and 4 ft. thick ? 

36. A quadrangle 120 ft. x 100 ft. has, in the center, a 
grass-plot 80 ft. x 60 ft. ; find the cost of graveling the 
rest of it to a depth of 6 in. at 54 ct. a cu. yd. 

37. At a certain place the annual rainfall was 24.15 
in- ; find the number of gal. which fell on each sq. mi. 

38. A slate cistern open at the top is everywhere 1 
in. thick, and the external dimensions are length 6 ft. 
4 in., breadth 3 ft. 2 in., and height 4 ft. 8 in. Eind the 
weight of the slate employed, assuming that 1 cu. ft. of 
slate weighs 2880 oz. 

39. Find the number of gal. the cistern in the previous 
question will hold. 

40. What is the height of a cylindrical liter measure 

if the radius of its base is 5°'" ? 
Answer to the nearest tenth of a mm. 



Art. 200.] MISCELLANEOtTS EXAMPLES. 207 

41. State the squares of 23, 34, 38, 47, 78, and 96, 
using the method indicated in Arts. 54 and 86. 

42. Find by factors the H.C.F. and L.C.M. of 168, 
2772, 4368, and 12474. 

43. Find the weight of 12™ of alcohol, its S.G. being 
.81. 

44. A room is 24 ft. 2 in. x 18 ft. 11 in. ; which way 
would it be the cheaper to run the carpet strips, each 
strip being 27 in. wide ? 

45. Find the dividend when the divisor is ^ and the 
quotient is J^. 



208 BATIO — PBOFOBTION. [Chap. IX. 



CHAPTER IX. 

BATIO — PROPOBTION. 

201. The quotient of one number divided by another 
of the same kind may be called the Ratio of the first to 
the second. 

Thus, the ratio of 6 ft. to 2 ft. is 8, and the ratio of 62 cwt. to 
16 cwt. is f ij, or 3}. 

A ratio is expressed by the sign : placed between the 
two quantities; this sign means the same as the sign +. 

Thus, 63™ : 26™ means 62™ -4- 26™. 

The first is read * the ratio of 62™ to 26i" ^ ; the second is read 
*the quotient obtained by dividing 62™ by 26™.' The answer is 

the same in both cases. A ratio may be also expressed in the form 

62™ 
of a fraction ; as, 

26™ 

202. The two quantities compared in a ratio are called 
the terms of the ratio. 

The old names, antecedent and consequent, for the first and 
second terms respectively of a ratio, are still sometimes used. 

The terms of a ratio must be of the same kind of 
magnitude; for we cannot compare, for example, tons 
with weeks, or acres with gallons. 

When a ratio and one of its terms are given, the other 
term can at once be found. 



Ex. 1. A ratio it 3L amd itfjini t^rm u 6 c Had its secomd term. 



Here a drndend C and a quotient S aie giTen ; hence, the diiiaar 
6 -£- 3 = 2 = the second tenn of the imtio. 

Ex. 2. ^ ratio is 4^ and tis jetoiid f«^ is 10; Jfrni Os JlrsC 



Here a qootient 4.5 and a diTisor 10 are given ; hence, the 
dividend = 4.5 x 10 = 45 = the first tenn of the ratio. 

Ex.3. Whatsumofmufme9hasto$30thf ratioofbzS? 

Here the ratio is f , and its second term is $30 ; hence, $30 x | 
=$18.75 = the first term. 



EXAMPI^BS T.YinrTTT 
Oral Exercises. 

Find the indicated ratios, and in lowest terms : 

1. 9:3; 16:4; 50:5; 20:9; 12:16. 

2. 18:30; 75:100; 90:30; .5:5; 5 : .5. 

3. 121b.:51b.; 20gr.:33; 35 : 355 ; 3.50 : $5.60. 

4. 24«:36«; 50«":20~"". 

6. A square 2 ft long : a square 1 ft. long. 

6. A cube 2 in. long : a cube 1 in. long. 

7. A circle 6" in diameter : a circle 2"* in diameter. 

8. What is the ratio of a square to another square 
half as long? Twice as long? One-third as long? 
Three times as long? 

9. What is the ratio of a cube to another cube half 
as long ? Twice as long ? 

10. What is the ratio of a circle to another circle 
having twice the diameter ? Three times the diameter ? 
Five times ? 



210 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Ckaip. IX. 

Writteii Ezereiies* 

Find, in lowest terms, the indicated ratios : 

11. *5 : $7.50 ; $3.25 : $12.50 ; $5.44 : $39.10. 

12. 3t.5 cwt. :lt. 15ewt.; 3ewt. 641b. : 4cwt. 761b. 

13. 7 mi. 208 rd. : 4 mi. 277 rd. ; 2 oz. 11 pwt. 18 gr. : 
51 32 31 gr.l. 

14. Find what has to $1.20 the ratio of 2 : 3. 

15. Find what has to 1 da. 4 hr. 20 min. the ratio of 
3:4. 

16. Find what has to 11 cwt. 55 lb. the ratio of 7 : 11. 

17. Find what has to £ 11. 14^. 9d, the ratio of 2. 

18. Find the second term, the first term being 4 cd. 
24 cu. ft., and the ratio being |, or 8 : 9. 

Proportion. 

203. When four quantities are such that the ratio of 
the first to the second is equal to the ratio of the third 
to the fourth, the four quantities are said to be Propor- 
tionals. 

For example, the ratio ^5 : ^15 = the ratio 3t. ; 9t. Hence, 
the four quantities, $5, ^15, 3t., and 9t., are proportionals. 
The notation is as follows : 

$6:915 = 3t. :9t. ; 
or, ^5 : 916 : : 3 1. : 1. 

This is read, *$5 is to ^15 as 3t. is to 9t.* ; meaning that the 
ratio between ^5 and $15 is the same as that between 3t. and 9t. 

A proportion may be expressed in the form 

<lpO O L. 

$i5~9t' 



Arts. 203-205.] PROPORTION. 211 

It follows that, when two fractions are equal, the terms 
of the fractions, taken in the order in which they are 
written, are proportionals. 

Since the two terms of any ratio must be of the same 
kind of magnitude, the first and second terms of a propor- 
tion must be of the same kind, and the third and fourth 
terms must be of the same kind. 

204.* The first and fourth, of four quantities in pro- 
portion, are called the Extremes, and the second and 
third are called the Means. 

In the above case, the ratios are ^^ and f respectively; and 
since ^^ = |, it follows that 5 x 9 = 16 x 3. 

Thus, in this, and similarly in other cases, the product of the 
extremes is equal to the product of the means. 

205. When any three terms of a proportion are known, 
the remaining term can be found. 

Ex. 1. What quantity : 18 lb. : : $4 : $12 ? 
For convenience, let x stand for the quantity to be found ; then, 

X lb. : 18 lb. : : P : $12, 
whence [Art. 204] 12 x x = 18 x 4. 

. •. once x = 18 X T^ = 6 lb. 

This is equivalent to saying that ^^ is a ratio, and 18 lb. is its 
second term ; the first term (or dividend) must be 18 x y^. 
[Art. 68 ; also 202, Ex. 2.] 

Ex. 2. 27 oz. : 15 oz. : : what quantity : 25 in. ? 

27 oz. : 15 oz : : a; in. : 25 in. 
15 X a; = 27 X 26 ; 
once x = H X 25 

= 45 in. = Ans. 

* It will be noticed that, in any proportion, when the first term 
is larger than the second, the third is larger than the fourth ; that, 
when the first is smaller than the second, the third is smaller than 
the fourth. 



212 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

We observe from the above that 

either extreme = proa«ctofm^ . 

the other extreme 

Likewise, either mean = pro^PCt of extremes , 

the other mean 

206. When the second term equals the third term, we 

have ))ut three different quantities in the proportion ; the 

second is then called a Mean Proportional between the first 

and third, and the third is called a Third Proportional 

to the first and second. 

Tfaas, in 4 : 6 : : 6 : 9, 6 is a mean proportional between 4 and 9, 
and 9 is a third proportional to 4 and 6. 

Here 9 = ^"^"^ ^^ ^^^ ^^^^"^ and 6 = Vproduct of the extremes. 

the first 



BXAMPLBS LXXXIV. 

1. Find the fourth proportional to 4, 7, and 12. 

2. Find the fourth proportional to 9, 8, and 3. 

3. Find the fourth proportional to ^, ^, and |^. 

4. Find the mean proportional between 4 and 9. 

5. Find the mean proportional between 8 and 18. 

6. Find the mean proportional between } and f. 

7. What quantity has to f 1.32 the same ratio that 
4 ft. 3 in. has to 2 ft. 9 in. ? 

8. To what sum has Is, 9d, the same ratio as 6 days 
10 hr. has to 7 days 8 hr. ? 

9. Fill up the blank in the proportion 

£ 1. 12«. 6d : £ 2. 2a. 6d : : 1 cwt. 18 lb. : . 

Questions in which a missing term of a proportion has to 
be found, and other questions of a similar nature, are best 
treated by a method which we now proceed to consider. 



Arts. 206, 207.] THE UNITARY METHOD. 213 



The Unitary Method. 

207. The method will be seen from the following 
examples : 

Ex. 1. If h lbs. of tea cost $2.76, how much vnll 8 lbs. cost at the 
same rate f 

Since cost of 6 lbs. = |2.76, 

'* " 1 lb. = e2.76 -f- 6. 
.-. ** ** 8 lbs. = 62.76 -5-5x8 = $4.40. 

Ex. 2. Tjf 1 cuot, 24 lb. of sugar cost $8.06, how much will 2 cwt, 
46 lb. cost at the same ratef 

Since cost of 1 cwt. 24 lb. (124 lb.) = $8.06, 
the " ** lib. =$8.06-5-124 

= $.065, 
and " " 2 cwt. 46 lb. (246 lb.) = $.065 x 246 

= $16.99. 

Ex. 3. How long would 24 horses take to consume the same 
quantity of food that 45 horses eat in 16 days f 

Since 45 horses eat the food in 16 days, 

45 X 16 horses woald eat the food in 1 day ; 
.-. 45 X 16 -*- 24 ** ** *' ** 24 days. 

Thus, the number of days required = 45 x 16 4- 24 = 30. 



EXAMPLES LXXXV. 
OraJ Exercises. 

1. If 5t. cost $35, what will 20 1. cost at the same 
rate? 

2. A man walked 12 mi. in 3 hr. ; how far would he 
walk in 1\ hr. ? 

3. A certain quantity of food would be consumed by 
18 persons in 15 da. ; how long would it last 90 persons ? 



214 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

4. If 18 yd. are bought for $3.60, how much will 45 
yd. cost ? 

5. How far should 15 1. be carried for the money 
charged for carrying 12 1. 5 mi. ? 

Written Exercises. 

6. If 27 men can mow a field in 8hr., how long 
will 36 men take to mow the same field ? 

7. If 18 yd. are bought for $16.50, find the price 
of 111 yd. 

8. How far should 100 1. be carried for the money 
charged for carrying 75 1. a distance of 120 mi. ? 

9. If 19 men do a certain piece of work in 117 da., 
how long will it take 13 men to do the same work ? 

10. If 19 horses can be bought for $475, how many 
can be bought for $700 at the same rate ? 

11. If 25 cows cost $1387.50, how much will 6 cost at 
the same rate ? 

12. If a train runs 704 yd. in 12 sec, how long will 
it take to go half a mi. ? 

13. How many men would do in 20 da. the same 
amount of work as 15 men can do in 16 da. ? 

14. How long would 75 horses take to consume the 
same quantity of food that 40 horses eat in 15 da. ? 

15. If I lend a man $100 for 14 weeks, how long ought 
he to lend me $175 in return ? 

16. If 7cwt. 41b. of steel cost $133.76, what will 
3 cwt. 4 lb. cost at the same rate ? 

17. If Icwt. 191b. of coffee cost $41.65, how much 
will 5 cwt. cost at the same rate ? 



Akt. 208.] EXAMPLES. 216 

18. If 123 yd. of silk cost $165.05, how much can 
be bought for $58.05 at the same rate ? 

19. A man walks 9 mi. in 2 hr. ; how long will he take 
to walk 12 mi. at the same rate ? 

20. If I lend a man $350 for 34 weeks, how long ought 
he to lend me $170 in return ? 

21. If gold is worth $18.60 per oz., what is the 
value of a cup weighing 7 oz. 5 dwt. 12 gr. ? 

22. Find the value of 12 things any 7 of which are 
worth $26.46. 

23. If 3^ lb. can be bought for $5.46, how much can 
be bought for $26.52 ? 

24. If a t. of sugar cost $110, how much will 8 cwt. 
26 lb. cost at the same rate ? 

208. Each of the examples in the last exercise may be 
solved by the method of Art. 205. 

For instance, in 7, the price of 18yd. holds the same ratio to the 
price of 111 yd. that 18 holds to 111 ; hence, 

18 : 111 : : $16.60 : x ; 
X = .1^16.60 X ^ 
= $101.76. 

Here ^^ is the ratio and $16.60 is the first term ; therefore, we 
must divide $16.50 by ^j to find the second term. 

Again, in 6, the time required for 36 men is || (ratio) of the 
time required for 27 men ; therefore, 

27 : 36 : : X : 8 ; 

« = H X 8 
= 6 hours. 

EXAMPLES liXXXVI. 
Written Exercises. 

Perform examples 8-15 in the last exercise, using the 
method of Art. 208. 



216 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

Similar Figures — Similar Solids. 

209. Figures or Solids which have the same shape are 
called Similar Figures or Similar Solids. 

In the cases of rectangular figures, and rectangular 
solids, and cylinders [note, Art. 197], sameness in shape 
is determined by the ratios which exist between lines 
having the game relative positions. If these ratios are 
equal, the figures or solids have the same shape. 

For instance, two rectangles, 12 ft. and 8 ft. in length, and 3 ft. 
and 2 ft. in height, are similar, because 12 ft. : 8 ft. : : 3 ft. : 2 ft. 

Likewise, two cylinders, 15^" and 9<*" in height, and 10 «" and 
6"" in diameter, are similar, because 15<*" : 9<*™ : : 10"» ; 6™. 

From preceding examples we have learned that heights 
of squares are proportional to tJieir lengths; that circumr 
ferences of circles are proportional to their diameters; that 
surfaces of sqtmres or circles are proportional to tlie squares 
of lengths or diameters; and that volumes of cubes are pro- 
portional to cubes of lengths or heights or breadtJis. 

What is true of squares, circles, and cubes, is true of 
all similar figures ; viz., 

(1) Lines are proportional to lines (height to length, etc.) ; 

(2) Surfaces are proportional to squares of corresponding 
lines ; 

(3) Volumes are proportional to cubes of corresponding 
lines. 

EXAMPLES LXXXVII. 
Written Bxerdses. 

1. The circumference of a circle is 12 in. ; what is the 
circumference of a circle whose diameter is 3 times as 
great? 



Abts. 209, 210.] PROPORTIONAL PARTS. 217 

2. A rectangle 16" x lO" is similar to another rec- 
tangle whose length is 4"; what is the height of the 
second rectangle ? 

3. What is the area of a rectangle 5 in. long when a 
similar rectangle 9 in. long has an area of 32.4 sq. in. ? 

4. What are the comparative areas of two similar 
figures whose lengths are 8*~ and 17*"? 

6. Two cubes are 13" and 1" long; how large is the 
first in terms of the second ? 

6. Two similar cylinders have diameters of 5*" and 3*" 
respectively : compare their lateral surfaces ; their bases ; 
their volumes. 

7. A cylindrical bin will hold 300 bu. of wheat; a 
similar one 3 times as high will hold how many b\i.? 

8. A cylinder 2" high and 9*" in diameter will hold 
how many kilos of water ? What will be the diameter 
of a similar cylinder which will hold 10178784 » ? 

Pbopobtional Parts. 

210. Partnership. 

When the ratio between the parts of a given quantity 
are known, the parts themselves can be at once found, 

Ex. 1. Divide $100 between A and B so that A may have $3 
for every $2 that B has. 

For every $3 that A receives, B will receive $2, and the two 
together wUl receive f3 + 62 = $5. 

Hence, A receives $3 out of every $5 of the whole ; 
.-. A *' I of the whole = { of $100 = ^. 
Also, B '• f of the whole = i of $100 = $40. 

Ex. 2. The profits of a business are to be divided between the 
partners A, B, and C, so that A may have 4 parts, B 3 parts, and 
C 2 parts. How much does each get out of a profit of $4500 ? 



21 8 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

If A has 4 parts to B's 3 parts and C's 2 parts, A toill have 4 
parts Ota of (4 + 3 + 2) parts divided between them all. 

4 
Hence A will have of the whole ; 

4 + 3 + 2 

.-. A will have | of ^4600 = $2000. 

B '' '' (of ^4500 = $1600, 

and C '' '' } of $4600 = 61000. 

Ex. 3. Divide $23.50 between Aj JS, and C, so that A^s share 
may be to B^s share a« 4 : 6, and B^s share to Cs share a« 3 : 4. 

Here A's share = | of B*s share, and B*s share = } of C's share ; 
.-. A*s *» = I of I of C*8 share = | of C*s share. 

Hence A, B, and C have together (| + } + 1) of C*s share ; 
U., ♦23.60 = ^'^ + ^ + =^ " " " 

C'S shara = }f of $23.60 ^ $10 ; A*8 = f of $10 ; B*s = } of 
$10. 

Or thus : 

A*s share : B*s =4:5, 

B's : C's = 3:4. 

Now multiply the terms of the two ratios by such numbers that 
the numbers corresponding to B^s share may be the same in both. 

In the present case, multiply by 3 and 6 respectively. Then 

A's share : B's : C's = 12 : 15 : 20. 
Thus, A gets 12 parts out of (12 + 15 + 20) parts altogether, etc. 

Ex. 4. Divide £ 11. 12«. between 12 men, 8 women, and 20 chil- 
dren, giving to each man twice as mw^ as to each woman, and 
to each woman three times as much as to each child. 

A man's share = a woman's share x 2 = a child's share x 6. 
Hence 12 men, 8 women, and 20 children will have 

(12 X 6 + 8 X 3 + 20) shares of a child. 
Hence a child's share x (72 + 24 + 20) = £ 11. 12«. = 232«. ; 

. *. a child's share = f f |«. = 2s. 
Whence it follows that each man has 12<., and each woman 6$. 



Abt. 210.] EXAMPLES. 219 

Ex. 6. Divide 632 into three parts proportional to |, |, and |. 

Since }, }, and | are respectively J§, JJ, and |§, we have merely 
to divide into parts proportional to 40, 46, and 48. 

40 
Hence, as in Ex. 3, the parts are : of the whole, etc. 

40 + 46-1-48 

EXAMPLES LXXXVIII. 
Written Bxeroises. 

1. Divide $245 into parts in the ratio 3 : 4. 

2. Divide f 165 into parts in the ratio 2^ : 3. 

3. Divide $33.15 into parts in the ratio f : f . 

4. Divide $54 into three parts proportional to the 
numbers, 1, 2, and 3. 

5. Divide $90.19 into parts proportional to the num- 
bers, 7, 9, and 13. 

6. Divide £17. lis. into three parts proportional to 5, 
6^, and 7^. 

7. A sum is divided into parts proportional to the 
fractions, f, f, |^; what fractional part of the whole is the 
first part ? 

8. The profits of a business are to be divided between 
the three partners in proportion to the numbers, 5, 3, and 
2 ; how much does each receive out of a total profit of 
$6237 ? 

9. In a certain business A has 7 shares, B 5, C 3, and 
D 1 share. The profits are $2410. Find each partner's 
share. 

10. A provides $5000, B $3000, and C $1260 to 
carry on a business. How much should each get out of a 
profit of $555 ? 



220 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

11. A, B, and C are partners in a business and have 
shares in proportion to the numbers, 4, 3, and 2, respec- 
tively, after ^ per annum has been paid on the capital. 
The capital is $20000, of which sum A provided f 12000, 
and B the remainder. How much does each receive out 
of a total yearly profit of $3400 ? 

12. A, B, and C are partners in a business ; C as manar 
ger receives -^ of the net profits, the remainder being di- 
vided between A, B, and C in proportion to the numbers, 
5, 4, and 3, respectively. In a certain year A's share of 
the profits amounted to $1520 ; what were the shares of 
B and C ? 

13.* The shares of A, B, and G of the capital in a 
business are as 4 to 3 to 2. After 4 months A withdraws 
half his capital, and the profits at the end of the year are 
$1518. How should this be divided between A, B, 
andC? 

Hnrr. A hw | ^ ^^'^ ^ °'^^- \ = 32 for 1 mo. 

i 2 for 8 mos. f 

14. Divide $157.50 between A, B, C, and D, so that 
A may have as much as G and D together, B as much as 
A and G together, and D twice as much as G. 

15. Divide $80 among 22 men, 26 women, and 82 
boys, so that 2 men may have as much as 3 women, and 
1 woman as much as 2 boys. 

16. If 8 men can do as much as 14 women, and 5 
women as much as 9 boys, divide $270 among 4 men, 6 
women, and 9 boys in proportion to the work they do. 

* When partners put capital into a business for the same length 
of time, the case is one of Simple Partnership. 

When capital is put into a business for different lengths of time, 
the case is one of Compound Partnership. 



Arts. 211, 212.] MIXTURES. 221 

17. Divide $1519.10 among three persons, A, B, and 
C, so that A may get one-fourth as much as B receives, 
and C may get one-tenth as much as A and B together. 

18. Three partners. A, B, and C, had shares in a busi- 
ness proportional to the numbers, 4, 5, and 6, respectively. 
C retired and received as his share of the business $15000. 
How much of this money should be paid by A and B 
respectively in order that after C^s retirement their shares 
might be equal ? 

19. A and B, whose capitals were as 3 to 4, joined in 
business, and at the end of 4 months they withdrew ^ 
and f respectively of their capitals from the business. 
How should a gain of $624 be divided between them at 
the end of the year ? 

20. The volumes of three substances contained in a 
certain mixture are proportional to the numbers, 2, 1, and 
4, respectively ; also the weights of equal volumes of the 
substances are as the numbers, 1, 32, and 16, respectively. 
Find the weight of the first substance contained in 3 lb. 
1 oz. of the mixture. 

Mixtures. 

211. The cost of a mixture of given quantities of two 
different ingredients is at once found when the prices of 
the separate ingredients are known. 

Ex. 8 lb, of tea costing 30 ct. per pound is mixed with 3 lb. of 
tea costing 55 ct per pound; lohat is the cost of the mixture f 

The mixture cost 30 ct. x 8 -f 55 ct. x 3 = 405 ct. 

Hence, each pound of the mixture cost 405 ct. -f- 11 = 36^^ ct. 



The ratio in which two different ingredients must 
be taken in order to make a mixture whose cost is any 
given sum intermediate between the costs of tlie separate 
ingredients, will be seen from the following examples. 



222 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

Ex. 1. In tohat ratio must tea costing 30 ct. per lb, be mixed with 
tea costing 55 ct, per lb, that the mixture may cost 45 ct. per lb, f 

The loss on the better quality is 10 ct. per lb. 
The gain on the poorer quality is 15 ct. per lb. 
The ratio between the loss and gain being |, we equalize loss 
and gain by making 

the number of lb. of the better quality _ 3 
the number of lb. of the poorer quality ^ 2 

Ex. 2. In what way mitst 3 kinds of tea worth 30 ct., 35 ct., and 
50 ct. per lb, respectively, be mixed that the mixture may be worth 
38 ct. per lb. f 

When there are 3 (or more) kinds of commodity, and only the 
price of the mixture fixed, there is an indefinite number of ways 
of satisfying the condition. 

In the present case the gain on the lower two grades of tea, 
namely, 11 ct. on 2 lb. (1 lb. of each grade) must just balance 
the loss on the best grade, namely, 12 ct. per lb. The ratio be- 
tween gain and loss = IJ. Hence, we must have 12 lb. of each of 
the lower grades and 11 lb. of the best grade. 

Or, we may say that the gain on 2 lb. of 30 ct. tea with the gain 
on 1 lb. of 35 ct. tea (19 ct. in all) must just balance the loss (24 ct.) 
on a certain number of 2 lb. packages of 50 ct. tea. Here the ratio 
of gain to loss is if. Hence, we must have twenty-four 31b. 
packages (each package consisting of 2 lb. of 30 ct. tea and 1 lb. of 
35 ct. tea) and nineteen 2 lb. packages of the 50 ct. tea. 

Ans. =48 lb., 241b., and 381b. 

Or, gainonP|^-f^^-*^= »^*-\ = 20ct.; 

' * 14 lb. 35 ct. tea = 12 ct. / 

loss on 4 lb. 50 ct. tea = 48 ct. ; 

.*. gain: loss: : 5: 12. 

Hence, we must have twelve 5 lb. packages (1 lb. of first kind 
with 4 lb. of second land) and five 4 lb. packages of third kind. 

Ans. = 121b., 481b., and 201b. 



Akt. 213.] WORK AND TIME. 



EXAMPLES LXXXIX. 
Written Bxercises. 

1. What would be the cost per lb. of a mixture of 
4 lb. of tea at 30 ct., and 6 lb. at 40 ct. ? , 

2. What will be the cost of a mixture of 3 gal. of spirit 
at $2.80 per gal. and 5 gal. at $3.50 a gal. ? 

3. If 180 lb. of sugar which cost 4 ct. per lb. be mixed 
with 120 lb. which cost 5\ ct. per lb., at what price must 
the mixture be sold so as to gain ^ ct. per lb. 

4. A milkman buys milk at 20 ct. per gal. He adds 
^ as much water as he buys milk, and sells the mixture 
at 28 ct. per gal. What is his gain per gal. ? 

5. In what ratio must two kinds of tea, which cost 
respectively Is. 3d, and Is. 9d. per pound, be mixed in 
order that the mixture may cost Is. 5d. per poimd ? 

6. In what ratio must biscuits worth respectively 
11 ct. per lb. and 15 ct. per lb. be mixed that the mixture 
may be worth 12 ct. per lb. ? 

7. How much sugar worth 7^ct. per lb. must be 
mixed with 1121b. of sugar worth 4^ct. per lb. in 
order that the mixture may be worth 7 ct. per lb. ? 

8. Tea at 66 ct. a lb. is mixed with tea at 78 ct. a 
lb. In what proportion must they be mixed, so that 
by selling the mixture at 77 ct. a lb. a profit of ^j^ of 
the cost may be made ? 

Work and Time. 

213. We now consider problems with reference to work 
done in various times. These can all be solved by con- 
sidering the fractional parts of the whole work which are 
done in a definite time. 



224 RATIO— PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

Ex. 1. One man can mow a field in SOhr,, and another man 
can movj the field in 60 hr, ; Aoto long would it take them working 
together to do it f 

The first man mows ^^ of the whole in 1 hr., 

the second man mows ^ of the whole in 1 hr. ; 

therefore, two together mow ^^^ + ^ of the whole in 1 hr. 

And, as the two together would mow (3^ + ^) = A ^^ ^^^ 
whole in 1 hr., they would mow the whole in 20 hr. 

Ex. 2. A cistern could be filled in 20 min. by its supply pipe 
and emptied in 35 min. by its waste pipe. If the cistern be empty 
and both pipes be opened, how long would it take to fill it f 

The supply pipe fills 2^^ of the cistern in 1 min., 
the waste pipe empties -^ of the cistern in 1 min. ; 
hence, together they fill (^ ~ 3^) = liv ^^ ^^ cistern in 1 min. 

And, as y}ir of the whole is filled in 1 min., the whole will be 
filled in 1 min. -f- y}^ = 46} min. 

EXAMPLES XC. 
Written Exercises. 

1. A can mow a field in 3 da., and B can mow the 
same field in 6 da. ; in how many da. will they do it 
working together ? 

2. A bath could be filled by its cold water pipe in 16 
min. and by its hot water pipe in 30 min. ; in what time 
will it be filled when both are opened ? 

3. A can do a piece of work in 12 da., and B can do 
the same in 20 da. A works at it for 3 da. How long 
would it take B to finish it ? 

4. A can mow a field in 15 hr., and B can mow the 
same field in 25 hr. They work together for 1\ hr., 
when A goes away. How long will it take B to finish 
the work ? 



Abt. 213.] WORK AND TIME. 225 

5. Two men together can do in 20 days a piece of 
work which one of them alone could do in 30 days ; how 
long would it take the other man to do the work alone ? 

6. When the hot and cold water pipes are both 
opened a bath is filled in 6 minutes ; and when only the 
cold water is turned on, the bath is filled in 10 minutes. 
In how long would the bath be filled if the hot water 
pipe only were opened ? 

7. A and B could together finish a piece of work in 25 
days. They work together for 15 days, and then A 
finished it by himself in 20 days. How long would it 
take them to do the whole, working separately ? 

8. A and B could together do a piece in 22^ days. 
A worked at it alone for 10 days, and then B finished it 
alone in 60 days. How long would it take them sepa- 
rately to do the whole work ? 

9. A can do a piece of work in 2^ days, B can do it 
in 3 days, and C can do it in 3| days ; how long would it 
take them to do it, all working together ? 

10. A cistern is filled by one pipe in 48 minutes, by 
another in an hour, and by a third in half an hour ; in 
what time would it be filled if all three pipes were open 
together ? 

11. A cistern can be filled by one pipe in 3 hours, by 
another in 3 hr. and 40 min., and it can be emptied by a 
third pipe in 2 hr. 20 min. ; if it be empty, and they are 
all opened together, in what time will the cistern be 
filled? 

12. C does half as much in a day as A and B can do 
together, and B does half as much again as A; if all 
three working together can mow 20 acres of barley in 16 
days, how long woiQd each, working by himself, take to 
mow 5 acres ? 



r 



226 RATIO— PROPORTION. [Chap. t^. 

13. A can do a piece of work in 6 days, B in 8 days, 
and C in 12 days. B and C work together for 2 days, and 
then C is replaced by A. Find when the work will be 
finished. 

14. A and B together can perform a piece of work in 
24 hr., A and C in 30 hr., and B and C in 40 hr.; in 
what time would each be able to perform it when work- 
ing separately? 

Races and Games. 

214. The following are examples of questions of this 
nature. 

Ex. 1. In a 100 yards race A can give B 5 yards start and just 
mn ; also^ B can give C 5 yards start ; how much could A give C f 

A runs 100 yards while B runs 95, and B runs 100 yards while 
C runs 95. 

Hence, C's distance in any time = ^^ of B's = ^ x ^ of A^s. 

Hence, while A runs 100 yards, C will run i^ x ^ of 100 = 90^ 
yards. 

Thus, A can give 9} yards to C. 

Ex. 2. In a certain game A can give B 1 point in 5, B can give 
C 1 point in 5, and C can give D 1 point in 8 ; how many points 
in 100 can A give D f 

A:B =5:4 =25:20 

B:C = 5:4 = 20: 16 
C : D = 8:7= 16 : 14. 

Hence, as in Ex. 3, Art. 210, 

A:B:C:D:: 25:20:16:14 
: : 100 : 80 ; 64 : 56. 

Thus, A can give (100 — 56 =) 44 points in 100 to D ; i.e., A can 
make 100 points while D makes 56 points. 



Art. 214.] EXAMPLES. 227 

EXAMPLES XCI. 
'Written Exercises. 

1. A can give B 10 yards start in a race of 100 yards, 
and B can give C 10 yards start over the same distance. 
How many yards start can A give C ? 

2. A can give B 20 yards and C 51 yards start in a 
quarter of a mile race. How many yards could B give 
in a quarter of a mile ? 

3. A can beat B by 5 yards in a 100 yards race, and 
B can beat C by 10 yards in a 200 yards race ; by how 
much could A beat C in a 400 yards race, supposing that 
they always run at the same pace ? 

4. A wins a race of 100 yards, beating B by 19 yards 
and C by 10 yards ; how many yards start ought C to 
give B in 200 yards that they may run a dead heat ? 

6. In a certain game A can give B 1 point in 10, B 
can give C 1 point in 6 ; how many can A give C in 100 ? 

6. At a certain game A scores 100 points while B 
scores 85, and B scores 100 while C scores 80; how 
many will C score in the time that it takes A to score 500 ? 

7. A can make 9 articles while B makes 14, and B 
can make 7 while C makes 6 ; how many can C make in 
the time that A makes 30 ? 

8. In a certain game A can give B 1 point in 10, B 
can give C 1 point in 12, and C can give D 1 point in 15 ; 
how many can A give D in 1000 ? 

9. A can give B 20 yards and can give C 41 yards 
start in a race of a quarter of a mile, and B can give C a 
start of 3 seconds over the same distance; how long 
does each take to run a quarter of a mile ? 



228 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chap. IX. 

10. In a certain game A can give B 1 point in 5, B can 
give C 1 point in 8, and C can give D 3 points in 10 ; 
how many can A give D in 100 ? 

215. The following examples are worth notice. 

Ex. 1. A starts at 10 o^ clock to loalk along a road at the rate of 

4 miles an hour; B starts on a tricycle at 45 minutes past 10 and 
rides after A at the rate of 9 miles an hour. When will B over- 
take A f 

When B starts, A has already traveled |{ of 4 miles ; that is, 3 
miles. 

B gains on A at the rate of (9 — 4 = ) 5 miles an hour. 

B will overtake A when he has gained 3 miles, which he will do 
in (3 -i- 5) hours = 36 minutes. 

Ex. 2. At what time between 4 and 6 o'clock will the hands of the 
clock he together f 

At 4 o^clock the minute-hand is 20 minute-spaces behind the 
hour-hand. In one hour the minute-hand passes over 60 minute- 
spaces, and the hour-hand passes over 6 minute-spaces. 

Thus, the minute-hand gains 56 minute-spaces in an hour. 

Now, when the two hands are together, the minute-hand must 
have gained on the hour-hand 20 minute-spaces, and the time 
required for this = Jf of an hour = 21^^ minutes. 

Thus, the time required is 21^^ minutes past 4. 

Ex. 3. A train traveling at the rate of 45 miles an hour is 
observed to completely pass a certain telegraph post in 5 seconds ; 
it also completely passed in 4 seconds a second train which was 
traveling along a parallel line of rails in the opposite direction at 
the rate of 30 miles an hour. How long were the trains f 

The time the first train takes to completely pass a post is the 
time it takes to travel a distance equal to the length of the train ; 
and, since the train goes at the rate of 46 miles an hour, it goes in 

5 seconds a distance = -^^j^-q of 45 miles = 110 yards. Thus, the 
first train is 110 yards long. 

Again, in the time the trains take to completely pass one another 
the distance traveled by the two trains together must be the sum 



(( (I 

tt it 



216.] EXAMPLES. 229 

of the lengths of the trams; and in 4 seconds the trains will 
together travel y^ of 45 miles + j^ of 30 miles = 146 yd. 2 ft. 

Hence the length of the second train 

= 146 yd. 2 ft. - 110yd. = 36 yd. 2 ft. 

Ex. 4. Seven finds are worth 6 ducks, 7 ducks are worth 2 geese^ 
10 geese are tcorth 7 turkeys^ and a turkey is worth 17s. 6d. ; how 
much is a fowl worth f 

One fowl is worth f of the worth of a duck, 

f of f of the worth of a goose, 
^ of f of f of the worth of a turkey, 
tV of f of f of 17«. 6d. 
= T^xfx^x¥ shillings = Zs. 



EXAMPLES XCn. 
'Written Exercises. 

1. One boy runs at the rate of 100 yards in 15 sec- 
onds, and has a start of 40 yards in front of another boy 
who runs at the rate of 100 yards in 12 seconds ; when 
will the first boy be overtaken ? 

2. One cyclist rides at the rate of 15 miles an hour 
and starts half-an-hour after another who rides along the 
same road at the rate of 12 miles an hour; when will 
the first rider be overtaken ? 

3. At what time between 5 and 6 o'clock will the 
hands of a clock be together ? 

4. At what time between 2 and 3 o'clock will the 
hands of a clock be at right angles ? 

6. A train traveling at the rate of 45 miles an hour 
is observed to completely pass a certain point in 9 seconds ; 
find the length ef the train. 



230 RATIO — PROPORTION. [Chaps. IX., X. 

6. A man on the platform of a station observed that 
a train passed him in 10 seconds, and passed completely 
through the station, which is 308 yards long, in 24 seconds ; 
how long was the train, and how fast was it going ? 

7. A passenger train, moving at the rate of 45 miles 
an honr, overtook a mineral train twice as long as itself 
and which was going along a parallel line of rails in the 
same direction at the rate of 23 miles an hour ; and the 
passenger train completely passed the mineral train in 
22^ seconds. How long was each train ? 

8. A person lights two- candles, 12 and 10 inches long 
respectively, at 6 p.m. The former diminishes 5 inches 
in length in 4 hours, and the latter 1 inch in 2 hours. 
If kept alight, at what time will the former be two inches 
shorter than the latter ? 

9. If 3 peai's are worth as much as 4 apples, 5 apples 
as much as 3 plums, 8 plums as much as 3 peaches, and 
if pears cost 36 ct. a dozen, what is the price of a peach ? 

10. Twelve fowls are worth as much as 11 ducks, 5 
ducks are worth as much as 4 pheasants, 10 pheasants as 
much as 3 turkeys, and 7 turkeys as much as 10 geese ; 
also a fowl and a pheasant are together worth 6s. 6d, 
Find the cost of a goose and a turkey together. 



Arts. 216,217.] PERCENTAGE A RATIO. 231 



CHAPTER X. 

PERCENTAGES. 
Percentage a Ratio. 

216. In many cases the ratio of one number to another, 
or of one quantity to another of the same kind, is ex- 
pressed by the number of hundrecUJis the first is of the 
second, and this is called the per cent the first is of the 
second. 

For example, 2 apples = ^^ of 8 apples, or 25 per cent of 8 
apples. 

This means that the ratio of 2 apples : 8 apples is .25. The first 
term is sometimes called the percentage^ the second is called the 
base, and the quotient is, as formerly, the ratio. 

Per cent is expressed by the sign %, or by writing the numerator 
as a decimal ; thus, -j^^ = 25%, or .25 ; and we write * 5 is 25% of 
20,'or »5is.25of 20.' 

217. The following examples will show how to ex- 
press any given quantity as a per cent of any other given 
quantity of the same kind. 

Ex. 1. Five dollars is what % o/$40 ? 

$5 = ^s of $40 = J of $40 = iM of $40 =125 % of -$40. 

100 

Ex. 2. In a town whose population was 243200 there were 15504 
children born in a year. Find the per cent the number of births was 
of the population. 

The ratio of births to population is 15504 : 243200 ; 
15504 4- 243200 = .06f ; .-. Ans. = 61%. 



282 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X. 

218L The following examples will show how to find a 
given per cent of a given quantity. 

Ex. 1. Find 121% 0/ $18. 

12p/o of $18 = .12^ of $18 = $2.25. 

Ex. 2. In a town whose population was 243200 the birth rate in a 

year was 6| % of the population j how many children were horn in 

the year. 

6)% of 243200 = M\ times 243200 = 15504. 

Ex.3. Ofwhalis^ct,22\%'f 

100 

Since ct. is 22^%, 100%, or the whole, must be ^ of Oct. 
= Y of Oct. =40ct. 



22i 



219. Frequently in finding percentage it is best to 
multiply by the common fraction which is equivalent to 
the per cent expressed decimally ; thus, 

6J% of 96 = tV of 00 ; 12^% of 432 = J of 432 ; 
16}% of $36.85 = \ of $36.85 = $6.14^. [Art. 134.] 

BXAMPLB8 XCni. 
Oral JExercisefl. 

What fractions are denoted by the following per cents ? 

1. 50. 4. 10. 7. 12f 10. 3^. 

2. 26. 6. 5- 8. 16f. 11. 6 J. 

3. 20. 6. 2f 9. 33J. 12. 5f 

What per cents are equivalent to the following fractions? 

13. f 16. \. 19. ;^. 22. ^^. 

14. f. 17. tV. 20. if 23. ■^. 
16. \, 18. ^, 21. ^. 24. 1^. 

'Written Exeroises. 

Find the per cent the first is of the second in 
26. $10, ^25 \ 45 ct., f2.70; fl.l2|, $3. 
26. 7s. 6d, £2. 27. 71b., 1 cwt. 



Arts. 218, 219.] 



EXAMPLES. 



233 



28. 1 hr. 12 min., 1 da. 

29. 3oz. 15dwt., lib. lOdwt. 

30. 3216^«, 1.608^8. 

Find 

31. 5% of £7. 10s. 

32. 10% of $85.63. 

33. 12|% of $492.64. 

34. The population of a certaiii town increased 50 % 
in the 10 years from 1881 to 1891, and the population 
in 1891 was 34617 ; what was the population in 1881 ? 

35. Find the % of error in the statement that 1 oz. 
Troy is equal to 1.1 oz. Avoir. 

36. Fill the blanks in the following table by giving 
the per cents of the 1889 amounts to the nearest tenth. 



Receipts from — 


1890. 


18S9. 


Increase. 


Amount. 


Per 

Cent. 


Ordinary passengers . . 
Season-ticket holders . . 
Excess baggage, mails, etc. 

Total 


26983000 
2316000 
5029000 


25678000 
2196000 
4757000 


1305000 
120000 
272000 




34328000 


32631000 


1697000 



37. Fill the blanks in the following table by giving 
the per cents of the 1889 amounts to the nearest tenth. 



Receipts from — 


1S90. 


1889. 


Increase. 


Amount. 


Per 
Cent. 


Mineral traffic 

General mdse traffic . . 
Live stock 

Total 


17643000 

23300000 

1377000 


17052000 

22694000 

1340000 


• 

491000 

606000 
37000 




42220000 


41086000 


1134000 



234 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X 



Profit and Loss. 

220. When anything is sold for more than it cost, it is 
said to be sold at a profit, and when it is sold for less 
than it cost, it is said to be sold at a loss. Profit or loss 
is often expressed as a percentage, and this percentage is 
always to be reckoned on the cost price. 

Thus, if goods which cost $50 are sold for $60, the percentage 
gain, or profit, is $10, and the per cent gain is 10 : 50 = 20% on 
the original outlay. 



The following examples will show how to treat 
questions involving profit or loss. 

Ex. 1. A house was bought for $400 and sold for $480 ; what 
was ths profit per cent f 

The total profit = $480 - $400 = $80. 
And the ratio of $80 : $400 = 20%. 

Ex. 2. An article cost $10.40 and was sold at a loss of 15% ; for 
what was it sold f 

Selling price = cost — 15% of cost ; 
. • . * » " = 86 % of cost = .85 of $10.40 = $8.84. 

Ex. 3. WhaJt was the cost of goods which were sold for $66, at a 
gain of 12%? 

Selling price = cost + 12% of cost = 112% of cost ; 
.*. cost = ff { of selling price = $50. 

Ex. 4. By selling tea at 50 ct. a pound a grocer would gain 6% 
more than by selling it at 48 ct. a pound; what was the cost of the 
tea? 

50 ct. — 48 ct. is 5% of the cost ; hence 2 ct. is 5% of the cost ; 
.*. 40 ct. = the cost 



Arts. 220, 221.] PROFIT AND LOSS. 286 

Ex. 6. A manufacturer sells at a profit of 20% to a wholesale 
dealer J who sells at a profit of 16% to a retail dealer, and the retail 
dealer sells for $2.76 and makes a profit of 25%. Find the cost 
of manufacture. 

It cost the retail dealer {^^ of $2.76 ; 

*« " wholesale dealer |f^ of |Jf of $2.76 ; 
*' " manufacturer |§g of }f J of |JJ of $2.76 ; 
Thus requhred cost = JM x If* x tU of $2.76 = $1.60. 

EXAMPLES XCIV. 
'Written Bzercises. 

What was tlie gain or loss % in the following cases ? 

1. Cost price $20, selling price f 24. 

2. Cost price $2.00, selling price $2.28. 

3. Cost price 40 ct., selling price 44 ct. 

4. Cost price $3, selling price $3.60. 

5. Cost price $140, selling price $130. 

6. Cost price $1.20, selling price $1.62. 

7. Cost price 84 ct., selling price 98 ct. 

8. Cost price $7.80, selling price $8.97. 

9. Cost price $74, selling price $70.30. 

10. Cost price $15.20, selling price $20.52. 

11. Cost price $12.40, selling price $10.23. 

12. Cost price $147, selling price $122.01. 

13. If an article be bought for $4.20 and sold for 
$6.60, what is the gain % ? 

14. What was the cost price of tea which is sold for 
80 ct. a pound and at a gain of 25% ? 

15. If a grocer buys 60 lb. of tea for $21.00, at what 
price per lb. must he sell it so as to make 20% profit? 



286 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X. 

16. An article was sold for 56 ct., at a gain of 12% ; 
what did it cost ? 

17. Tlie profit on an article if sold for f 3.00 is 26% ; 
what would be the profit if it were sold for $2.88 ? 

18. By selling a house for f 759 a builder gained 10% ; 
what would he have lost % if he had sold for $621 ? 

19. If a profit of 22^% is made by selling an article 
for $2.94, what would be the selling price if the profit 
were only 5% ? 

20. A person bought a carriage and sold it for $37.80 
more than he gave for it, thereby clearing 7% ; what 
did he give for it ? 

21. A house is sold for $4000, and 25% profit is made ; 
how much % profit would be made by selling for $3360 ? 

22. A tradesman by selling an article for $1.62 gains 
35% ; what would he have gained % if he had sold it 
for $1.98 ? 

23. A man bought apples at the rate of 6 for 2 ct., 
and an equal number at the rate of 10 for 2 ct. ; and he 
sold the whole at the rate of 5 for 2 ct. What profit % 
did he make ? 

24. If 5% more be gained by selling an article for 24 
ct. than by selling it for 23 ct., what was the original 
price ? 

25. If 3% more be gained by selling a horse for 
$399.60 than by selling for $388.80, what must have 
been the original cost ? 

26. If a woman gains 12% by selling 5 herrings for 
14 ct., what % would she gain by selling them at 6 for 
18 ct. ? 

27. If a woman buys eggs at 20 ct. a dozen, how many 
ought she to sell for 18 ct. in order to gain 8% ? 



Art. 222.] TRADE DISCOUNT. 287 

28. A man who had been paying $25.20 for 4t. of 
coal changed his coal merchant and then got 5 1. for 
f 20.16 ; how much did he save % ? 

29. A draper bought 240 yd. of silk. He sold ^ at a 
gain of 25%, J at a gain of 20%, and the remainder at 
a loss of 15%, and received $800 in all. What was the 
cost price per yd. ? 

30. A draper bought a piece of silk 35 yd. long; and, 
after cutting off 2 yd. which were damaged, hie sold the 
remainder so as to clear 10% on his outlay. How much 
% was the selling price of a yd. higher than the cost 
price ? 

31. A manufacturer sold at a profit of 25% to a 
wholesale dealer, who sold at a profit of 12% to a retail 
dealer, and the retail dealer sold for $3.22 and made a 
profit of 15% ; what was the cost of manufacture ? 

32. A quantity of wheat was sold in succession by 
three dealers, each of whom made a profit of 5%. The 
last of the three sold for $3087 ; how much did it cost 
the first ? 

33. A house was sold by the builder at a profit of 30%, 
and the purchaser sold it again at an advance of $117 in 
the price, and gained 20% on his outlay; how much 
did the house cost the builder ? 

Teadb Discount. 

222. Merchants often sell goods at a certain price with 
a certain % discount ; thus, 

Macmillan & Co. may sell books at $1.60 per copy less 
15% ; this means that they sell for $1.60 - 15% of $1.60, 
or for $1.60 - $.24 = $1.36. 



238 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X. 



I. Sometimes after a given % discount is allowed, a 
second allowance of another % is made, and even a third 
allowance is made. 

Ex. 1. Goods sold for ^2500 with a discount of 20%, 5%, and 
1 i % bring what price f 

$2500 - 20 % of $2500 = $2000 ; 
$2000- 5% of $2000 = $1900; 
$1900 - \\% of $1900 = $1871.60 = Ans. 

Ex. 2. Which is cheaper^ to buy goods at a discount of 30% and 
6%orwith3Si%offP 

The marked price less 30% = 70% of marked price ; 70% -5% 
of 70 % = 66^%. It is cheaper to buy at a discount of 30% and 5 % 
than at a discount of 33} %. 

BXAMPLBS XCV. 
Oral JEzercUes. 

What is paid for goods marked 

1. $50 with a discount of 10% ? 

2. $50 with a discount of 10% and 10% ? 

3. f 50 with a discount of 20% and 5% ? 

4. $600 with a discount of 33J% ? 

5. $900 with a discount of 16f % ? 

6. f 1000 with a discount of 27% and 10% ? 

7. $1000 with a discount of 20%, 10%, and 1% ? 

What is the marked price of goods sold for 

8. $90 after a discount of 25<fo ? 

9. $63 after a discount of 30% and 10% ? 

10. $49 after a discount of 12^% and 12^% ? 

11. $45 after a discount of 16f % and 10% ? 



Arts. 223, 224.] COMMISSION— BROKE RAGK. 239 

'Written £zercifl6fl. 

12. Find what was received for goods marked $1200 
if a discount of ^ and 15% is allowed. 

13. For what % of the marking price are goods sold 
if an allowance of ^, 10%, and 6J% is made? 

14. Goods are marked $170 and sold for $144.50; 
what % discount was allowed ? 

15. Goods marked $16 were sold at 6\% discount and 
5% off for cash ; what was the selling price ? 

16. Goods cost a merchant $1600; he wishes to make 
a profit of 25% after making a discount of 20% and 16§% ; 
what was the marked price ? 

17. At what % above the cost must goods be listed 
that a merchant may allow a discount of 20% and realize 
a profit of 12% ? 

18. A merchant allows on $2000 worth of goods (list 
price) a discount of 15%, 9%, and 5% for cash, then J% 
to clinch the bargain ; how much cash did he receive and 
what profit did he make, his % of profit being 8 ? 

Commission and Brokerage. 

224. An agent employed to buy, or sell, goods, or to 
collect rents, is usually paid a percentage on the price of 
the goods, or on the amount of rent. This percentage is 
called Commission. 

To insure against loss of life, or damage by tire, some 
persons pay money to an Insurance Company. In return 
for this money, the Company undertake to compensate 
the person insured for any loss caused by tire, or to pay 
a specified sum to relatives of the deceased. The money 



240 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X. 

paid to the Company is a percentage on the value of the 
property inauredy or on the specified sum, and is called a 
Premium. 

Kz. 1. The total rental of an estate is ^8474. 40, and the agent 
18 paid a commission of 6% ; how much is the commission/ 

98474.40 X .06 = $423.72. 

Ex. 2. What is the annual premium for insurance on a building 
worth $7600 at the rate of 24 ct. for $250 ? 

^ X $7600 = $7.20. 
260 

EXAMPLES XCVI. 
'Written JEzercises. 

1. After paying 5% to his agent, a man received 
If 1430.40; what was the agent*s commission? 

2. AVhat is the amount of annual premium for the in- 
surance of a building for $8520 at fV%^ 

3. A landlord allowed his tenants 20% reduction from 
their rents; what was the nominal rent of a tenant whose 
reduced rent was $1800 ? 

4. A commission merchant sells goods for $2864 and 
sends to his principal $2824.62 after deducting com- 
mission ; what was the % commission ? 

5. A commission merchant is asked to purchase $6800 
worth of goods at 2|% commission; how much money 
was paid by his principal ? 

6. A commission merchant received $6953 with which 
to purchase goods after deducting 2J% commission; what 
was paid for the goods ? 

7. An agent sold goods for $5672; his bill for ex- 
penses was $56.72, and his commission was 1^% ; what 
fo of the selling price did the pi'incipal receive ? 



Akt. 225.] TAXES AND DUTIES. 241 

8. A. man insured his life for $5000 at an annual 
premium of 2J-% ; how much had he paid at the end of 
13 years ? 

9. A cargo is insured for $254500, its full value, at 
2% ; the ship is insured for $120000 at 2|% ; the owner 
of the cargo pays all insurance and sells his goods at the 
end of the voyage at an advance of 9% over total cost, 
allowing $2000 for freight ; what was the selling price ? 

10. The premium for insuring a building at 2^% is 
$1136.25; find the insurance. 

11. A company insured a building and the goods it 
contained for $117944, the goods being worth 15% of the 
value of the building. The merchant paid 2% premium 
on the building and 1^% premium on the goods; what 
was the total premium ? 

12. A man sold through an agent some merchandise, 
paying the agent 5% commission. The agent invested 
the proceeds in two parts after taking out commissions 
of $325 at 5%, and $260 at 4%, respectively; what was 
the value of the merchandise ? 

13. A man had two houses, each costing $5000; he 
insured one for $4000 at 1^%, and the other for $6000 
at 1 i % ; find the difference between the loss on one and 
the gain on the other, both houses having been burned 
on the day after insurance. 

Taxes and Duties. 

225. Persons owning property or importing goods, pay 
to the government (for its support) a certain per cent of 
their property or of the foreign value of the goods im- 
ported. 

The percentages paid on property are called Taxes. 



242 PERCENTAGES. [Chap. X. 

The percentages paid on imported goods are called 
Duties. 

Duties levied on articles regardless of their value are 
called Specific Duties. 

Duties levied at a certain per cent on the foreign values 
of goods are called Ad Valorem Duties. 

In some States voters pay annually a small fixed sum 
of money ($1.50 or $2) before they can vote. Such 
money is called a Poll Tax 

BXAMPLBS XOVn. 
Written Exercises. 

1. The expenses of a certain town are $39512.32 
annually ; the tax is 16 mills on the dollar ; what is the 
value of the town as fixed by the assessors ? (The asses- 
sors' valuation is much smaller than the real valuation.) 

2. The valuation of a certain town is $6495860, while 
the assessed valuation is 26 % of that ; the polls number 
1112, and the taxes are $16.25 on each thousand of as- 
sessed valuation ; what are the expenses of the town ? 

3. The expenses of a city are $339000, and the assessed 
valuation is $16950000 ; what is the tax rate expressed 
as per cent ? Expressed as dollars on a thousand ? 

4. What is the duty on 5000 bbl. of hydraulic cement 
at 8 ct. per bbl. ? 

5. What is the duty on 125 plates of polished un- 
silvered glass 24 x 30 in., at 8 ct. per sq. ft. ? 

6. What is the duty on 100 doz. penknives valued at 
30 ct. per doz., at 25 % ad valorem ? 

7. What is the duty on 3t. of No. 23 steel wire at 
2ct. per lb.? 



Art. 226.] EXAMPLES. 248 

8. A merchant imported 1550 yd. of tapestry carpet 
valued at 80 ct. a yd. ; what was the duty at 42^ % ad 
valorem ? 

9. An invoice of 150 doz. linen collars valued at $ 1.30 
per doz., calls for how much duty at 30 ct. and 30 % ? 

10. What does the government receive on an impor- 
tation of 1000 gross of steel pens at 8 ct. per gross ? 



244 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



CHAPTER XL 



INTEREST. 

Promissory Notes. 

When one person borrows money from another 
person, he gives to the lender a written promise to repay 
the money and to pay also a percentage on the money at 
a given rate % per year. This percentage is called 
Simple Interest, or Interest. 

The form of note given in the following pages is the form in use 
by the best business men in the United States. Students are 
strongly advised to adhere closely to the form while practising the 
making of notes. 



The written promise is called a Promissory Note, 
example : 



For 



% 




Skvitu doAf^ oAteA^ cCaZ& of promise to pay to 
the order of^ fa/vyve^ ^Z^^^fi^,^.v,w.,^.^,^./v,^,v^ 

^^..r.,.^<S^<yuA^ hu/yvcU^&dy QAocXA^Q.^A^-eAi/.rs^..,^^DoVlars 

ValTJue Heceived, wiXA Cnt&v&oZ. 

ia/yyu/Q/ lAh^uJL, 

Jfo. 82. Thjue fa/yv. 3//fS^€^. 3, 'f^. 



Abts. 226-229.] PROMISSORY NOTES. 



245 




€i^ cC&yyva/yicL <J promise to pay to 

the order of /ifcyuM^ B&Uk&v.....................^ 

. ^liMy A/u/yicCv&cC ^c^Cy a/yud ^Dollars 

cub tA& (S^ka/fiA/yL o^atA/yyvout SoL/nk/^ ^ 

Vdiiue received, wWv vyite/L&ot at 6%. 

JSTo. 763. Thjue. f. €, /ifa^vu>nd. 



227. In the case of a promissory note, it is to be noticed 
that the heading indicates the names of the Town and 
State in which the note is written, also the month, day, and 
year. At the left is written in figures the sum of money 
for which the note is given. 



L* The face of the note indicates the names of the 
parties (TAaker and Payee) to the note, the words ^ value 
received/ the sum of money for which the note is given 
(written in full), and the tim^ for which the note is to 
run. If the note is interest-bearing, it mMst have the 
words ^with interest^ written in the face- 



Notes written as above may be transferred (sold) 
by the Holder to another person (who in turn becomes the 
holder), and are therefore called Negotiable notes. When 
the note contains the words ' or order/ the holder must 
Endorse his name on the back of the note (thus becoming 



♦ The Maker of a note is the person who signs the note. The 
Payee is the person to whom the note is made payable. The Holder 
of a note is the person who owns the note (the payee or some 
person to whom the payee has sold the note). 



246 INTEREST. [Chap. XI. 

responsible for its payment) when he sells the note. 
When the note contains the words * or hearer , no endorse- 
ment is legally necessary. If the note does not contain 
the words ' or order ^^ or * or hearer, it is not negotiable. 

230. A note is payable at the husineas office of the 
Maker unless otherwise specified in the note. Nearly all 
notes specify the place of payment. 



When the rate of interest is not written in the 
note, as in the first of the above notes, the law of the 
State in whidi the note is to he paid fixes the rate. If the 
parties interested wish a rate different from the rate in 
the State in which the note is to be paid, such rate must 
be specified in the body of the note, as in the second of 
the above notes, hut may not he more than tlie maoiimum 
allowed hy such State. 



When the words ^with interest^ are omitted from 
a note, no interest is payable on that note except for the 
time it may over-rim. [Art. 239.] 



The first of the above notes is called a Time note ; 
the second, a Demand note. 

A time note is nominally due at the date indicated in 
the note, but Matures (becomes legally due) three days 
later. The three days are called Days of Grace. In some 
States no days of grace are allowed. 



When a note . matures on a Sunday or on a legal 
holiday y it is payable in some States on the business day 
next preceding, and in other States on the business day 
next succeeding, such Sunday or legal holiday. 



The dates on which a note is nominally and 
legally due are indicated thus : Feb. 8/11, 1880. 



Arts. 230-238.] TABLE OF RATES. 247 

If the time of payment is indicated in * days after datej 
those days, together with three days of grace (if such be 
allowed by the State), are counted forward from (not 
including) the date of the note in finding the date of 
maturity; thus, the first of the above notes matures 
•^*^- « VFeb. 8, 1894. 



If the time of payment is indicated in ^months 
after datey calendar months, together with three days of 
grace, are counted forward from the date of the note in 
finding the date of maturity ; thus, the maturity of a note 
for 2 months, dated Jan. 31, 1892, was Mar. 8i/^p^ g^ 1392 ; 
for 3 months, it was ^P^-^/Mays, 1892; for one month, it 

was Feb. 29/j^^j^ 3^ 1892. 

237. If payment of a note is not made on the day of 
maturity, the holder must engage a Notary Public to send 
to the endorser (or endorsers) a written notice of such fact. 
This notice is called a Protest. The protest must be sent 
on the day of maturity, otherwise the endorser cannot be 
held to the payment of the note. 

Table of Bates of Interest. 

23& The following table gives, for each of the States 
and Territories, the Legal Rate when no rate is mentioned 
in a note, the Maximum Rate allowed, the Time of pay- 
ment when the day of maturity falls on a holiday (the 
day before by B, and the day after by A), and indicates 
by the letter G those States in which days of grace are 
legal. 

Notes made on or after Jan. 1, '96, and payable in New 
York, bear no grace. 

Notes made after July 4, '96, and payable in New Jer- 
sey, bear no grace. 



248 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



Bute. 



AUbftmA . 
Aiizon* 
Arkansas . 
CalifornU . 
Colorado . 
Connecticut 
Delaware . 
Dl8t. of Colombia 
Florida . 
Georgia 
Idaho . 
Illinois . 
Indiana , . . 
Indian Territory 
Iowa 
Kansas. 
Kentucky 
Louisiana 
Maine . 
Maryland 
Massachusetts 
Michigan . 
Minnesota 
Mississippi 
Missouri . 









• 




9 


• 


i 


8 


8 


P 


o 
o. 


A. 


T 


Any. 


A. 


0. 


6 


10 


B. 


o. 


7 


Any. 


A. 




8 


Any. 


B. 


o. 


6 


6 


B. 


G. 


6 


6 


B. 


G. 


6 


10 


A. 


G. 


8 


10 


B. 


G. 


T 


8 


A. 


G. 


10 


18 


A. 




6 


7 


B. 


G. 


6 


8 


B. 


G. 


6 


10 


B. 


G. 


6 


8 


B. 


G. 


6 


10 


B. 


G. 


6 


6 


B. 


G. 


6 


8 


A. 


G. 


6 


Any. 


B.orA. 


G. 


6 


6 


B. 


G. 


6 


Any. 


A. 


G. 


6 


8 


A. 


G. 


7 


10 


A. 


G. 


6 


10 


B. 


G. 


6 


8 


A. 


0. 



Bute. 




1 

10 


• 

M 

<• 


• 


• 




1^ 

Any. 


& 


O 
G. 


MonUna . . . 


B. 


Nebraska . . . 


7 


10 


A. 


G. 


Nevada . . . 


7 


Any. 


B. 


G. 


New Hampshire 


6 


6 


B. 


G. 


New Jersey . . 


6 


6 


A. 




New Mexico 


6 


12 


A. 


G. 


New York . . 


6 


6 


A. 




No. Carolina 


6 


8 


B. 


G. 


No. DakoU . . 


7 


12 


A. 


G. 


Ohio . . . . 


6 


8 


B. 


G. 


Oklahoma . . 


7 


12 


B. 


G. 


Oregon . . . 


8 


10 


A. 




Pennsylvania . 


6 


6 


A. 


G. 


Rhode Island . 


6 


Any. 


A. 


G. 


So. Carolina . . 


7 


8 


A. 


G. 


Bo. Dakota. . 




7 


12 


A. 


G. 


Tennessee . 




6 


6 


B. 


G. 


Texas . . . 




6 


10 


B. 


G. 


UUh . . . 




8 


Any. 


B.orA. 




Vermont . . 




6 


6 


A. 




Virginia . . 




6 


6 


B. 


G. 


Washington 


• • 


8 


Any. 


B. 


G. 


W.Virginia. 




6 


6 


B. 


G. 


Wisconsin . 




6 


10 


A. 




Wyoming . 




12 


Any. 


A. 


G. 



BXAMPLBS XCVIII. 

1. Write a time note for $ 250.67 with interest at 16 %. 

2. Write a time note for $ 76 with interest at 20 %. 

3. Write a time note for $468.92 for 20 da. without 
interest. 

4. Write a time note for $ 20 for 4 mo. with interest 
at 13 %. 

5. Write a time note for $560, headed Cincinnati, 
Ohio, Jan. 13th, 1892, to mature in 63 da., with interest. 

6. Write a demand note for $ 528 with interest. 

7. Write a demand note for $460 with the maximum 
interest allowed by the State in which you live. 



Aets. 239, 240.] SIMFLE INTEBEST. 



249 



Find the date of maturity of each of the following 
indicated notes : 




Date. 




WuEBB Payable. 


Tdce. 


8. 


Dec. 


18, 


1895 


New York 


30 days 


9. 


Jan. 


18, 


1895 


New York 


60 days 


10. 


Jan. 


27, 


1896 


New York 


45 days 


11. 


July- 


31, 


1896 


New Jersey 


60 days 


12. 


June 


6, 


1896 


New York 


3 months 


13. 


Jan. 


30, 


1895 


New York 


1 month 


14. 


Jan. 


30, 


1896 


New York 


1 month 


15. 


Mar. 


31, 


1896 


New York 


3 months 


16. 


Mar. 


31, 


1895 


Conn. 


1 month 


17. 


Mar. 


30, 


1896 


Mass. 


1 month 


18. 


Sept. 


3, 


1890 


Nebra»ska 


60 days 


19. 


Ja,n. 


29, 


1896 


Cal. 


30 days 


20. 


Jan. 


29, 


1896 


Cal. 


1 month 



Simple Interest. 

L Interest on the Principal (money borrowed) . is 
called Simple Interest^ and is computed at the given rate 
per cent (per year understood) for the time elapsing 
between the date and maturity of the note. 

If a note is not interest-bearing and is not paid at maturity, 
interest is payable after maturity and until the note is paid. 
[Art. 232.] 

240. The majority of notes are given for short periods 
of time — say 30, 60, or 90 days, or 1, 2, or 3 months. 
Now it is customary in interest computations, to regard 
one year as 360 days. Therefore, by a short operation, 
we may find the interest on any principal for any time 
and at any rate per cent. 



260 



INTEBEST. 



[Chap. XL 



Ex. 1. 



S), 



€i(fkt&e/yv cia^if^ ait&v daZ& ^promise to pay to 
the order of fa&t <?utna/»v 

at tk& ^civ^ Bank, 



^Dollars 



VaZue received, iv-iXJv vytZ&v&ot. 

Jfo. 68, Due S^&L 3. d, ^. S'&yyijde 



9360 

M 

360 ) $21.00 

.051 
18 

$1.06 



In this note, the rate is 6% and the time is 18 
da. ; the interest for 1 yr. will be .06 of the princi- 
pal, — $21 ; the interest for one day is found by 
dividing $21 by 360, and the interest for 18 days 
is found by multiplying the quotient thus found 
by 18. Hence, .06 and 18 are multipliers, while 
360 is a divisor. 



This may be expressed as follows : 



360 X 6 X 18 
100 X 360 



, which becomes 



.360 X 18 
6 



by cancellation. 



We observe that interest for any number of days may be found 
by dividing the principal by 1000, multiplying by the number of 
days, and dividing by 6. 

The following is a better form for practical work : 

OCA 

18 3 Here, cancelling 6 from the dividend and divisor, 

^. QRQ we have .360 to be multiplied by 3. 



Akt. 241.] 



SIMPLE INTEREST. 



251 



Ex. 1. In the above note let the principal he 9867.91, the rate 
6%, and the time 21 da. ; find the interest. 



Mtn ,18396 + 
^X 7 



We must cancel the divisor complete- 
ly ; only 5 figures will be needed for 
the multiplicand ; keep the multiplier as 



$1.28765 

$1.29 = Ans, small as possible by cancellation. 

Ex.2. 




f660^. diAxyu^ta., ?71&., fa/yi. 7, 18 ^8. 

S^w^ yruyyitA^ o^^teA^ dat& of promise to pay to 

the order of /ife/yiA/u SutteA 

cub tk& S%a^yiit& cAatixyyvat Ba/yifo. 

Value received, waXA i/yiteAy&ot, 

J^o, /5S Due TnoA^ 7//0, '(J a. 



j^ Dollars 



Find the interest. 






326 
21 



326 
660 

6.826 

6.83 = interest. 



When the time is ^months after 
date,* calendar months are counted 
in obtaining the date of maturity 
[Art. 236], and the interest is com- 
puted for the stated number of 
months coun^in^ 30 da. as one month. 

This note payable in Maine has three days of grace ; therefore the 

interest is computed for 63 da. 

241. The value of a note at its date of maturity is 
called its Maturity Value, and consists of the sum for 
which the note is given plus the interest (if any). In 
finding maturity value, observe whether or not the note 
bears int. and ' days of graced 



262 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



BXAMPLBS XCIX. 



Written Ezamplcs. 



What interest is due at maturity on each of the follow- 
ing indicated notes ? 



Date. 

1. Arkansas, 

2. New Jersey, 

3. Ohio, 

4. Texas, 

6. New York, 

6. New York, 

7. California, 

8. Kentucky, 

9. Connecticut, 

10. New Hampshire, 

11. Illinois, 

12. Utah, 



Pkhvoipal. 

$763 

«1467 

$1626.75 

96000 

$5267.50 

$2675 

$376 

$498 

$75000 

$704.25 

$84.75 

$846 



Rate. 

6% 



6i 

i( 
u 

« 

(( 

6C 
(( 
U 



Tune. 

12 da. 

15 da. 

18 da. 

21 da. 

27 da. 

27 da. 

2 mo. 

Imo. 

108 da. 

201 da. 

361 da. 

51 da. 



242. For rates other than 6%, find the interest at 6% 
and take such a part of that interest as the given rate is 
of 6%. 

Ex. 1. P = 1 4673, i? = 5 % , time = 33 da. ; find interest. 



?tfOT. 2,3366 
^ r 33 11 
6)26.7016 
4.2836 



$21.42 =Ans. 



Here the interest at 6% is $26.7016, 
and I of this is $21.42. We obtain this 
result rapidly by subtracting the interest 
at 1 % from the interest at 6 %. 



Abt. 242.] 



SIMPLE INTEREST. 



258 



Ex. 2. P = $ 26.48, B = 7i %, time = 90 da. ; find int. 

026.48 
^0 16 



Here the interest at 7 J % = f of the interest at 

4) .39720 6%. The answer is obtained by adding to the 

•QQQ3 interest at 6 % one-fourth of the interest at 6 %.♦ 
.50 



In the final work do not waste time writing anything but the 
answer. 

EXAMPLES C. 




j^ Dollars 



f/00^. RateAxfk, cA. &., ducf, Sf, 18 (J 6. 

3^kv&& "vruyyitA^ alt&v dat& <J promise to pay to 
the order of.,..y^^..,^..y..y^3^k(yY>uM^ Svesn&. 
d&v-e/yi kund/it-cL. 

Value received, wZtA iAiteA^&oZ at 7 %. 
Jfo. /6 Due Mv-. dO/Jb&e^ 3, /8^6. 



1. Find the interest on the above note. 

2. Find what would be the amount of the above note 
if the time were 90 da. 

3. Find interest on a New York note for % 2670, dated 
Dec. 31, 1895, payable 47 da. after date, with interest. 



* For interest at 8 %add ^ of interest at 6 % to itself. 




' 7i% " i 




i( t( (( 




7 % " i 




(( ii i( 




5i%subt.TJi 




** from " 




6 % " i 




(( (( ti 




' 4i% " i 




t( It ii 




4 % " i 




(( (C (i 


The ' 


' 8 % = \ 







254 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XI. 



What interest is due at maturity on each of the fol- 
lowing indicated notes ? 



4. 


DATS. 

Saratoga, N.Y., 


Pbuvcipal. 

$2670 


Batb. 

Maximum 


TlMB AJn 

Datb. 

.47 da. 


6. 


Springfield, Mass., 


$4893 


5% 


60 da. 


6. 


Washington, D.C., 


$ 289.20 


6% 


90 da. 


7. 


Buffalo, N.Y., 


$ 48.93 


H% 


3 mo. 


8. 


Utica, N.Y., 


$ 48.93 


4% 


3 mo. 


9. 


Baltimore, Md., 


$765 


Maximum. 


6 mo. 


10. 


Hartford, Conn., 


$4893 


6< 


90 da. 


11. 


Denver, Col., 


$8695 


12% 


24 da. 


12. 


St. Louis, Mo., 


$ 463.50 


9% 


60 da. 


13. 


Chicago, 111., 


$873 


6i% 


30 da. 


14. 


St. Paul, Minn., 


$ 487.20 


n% 


2 mo. 


16. 


NewYork,N.Y., 


$ 286.37 


4f% 


3 mo. 


16. 


Boston, Mass., 


$ 499.99 


4% 


60 da. 


17. 


Find the amount 


in each 


of the last thre 


examples. 









The above method for computing interest is in general 
use when the time is less than one year ; but if the time 
is in yr., mo., and da., the 6% method is the more 
frequently used. 

Six Per Cent Method. 

243. A demand note for $ 268.50, dated Nov. 26, '87, 
was paid 4 yr. 7 mo. 18 da. after date ; what was the 
interest at 6% ? 



Arts. 243, 244.] SIX % METHOD. 255 

At 6% 

the interest on $1 = $.06 (six cents) for 1 yr., 

$1 = $.005 (5 mills) for 1 mo., 
$1 = $.000J- (^ of a mUl) for 1 da. ; 



(( a (( 

(( u (( 



hence 

(( (( i( 



$1 = $.24 for 4 yr., 
« « « $1 = $.035 for 7 mo., 
« « « $1 = $.003 for 18 da.. 



a u (( 



$1 = $.278 for 4 yr. 7 mo. 18 da. 



$ 268.50 Having found the interest on $ 1 for the given rate 
.278 and time, we multiply this interest by the principal. 
I 74.64 [Art. 47, Theorem I.] 

Note. It is evident that the interest for 2 mo. at 6 % may be 
computed by moving the decimal point 2 places to the left. Thus, 
the interest on $784.70 for 2 mo. is $7.85. Similarly, the interest 
for 6 da. is $.78. Also the interest for 12 da. is $1.57. The 6% 
method is sometimes used when the times are less than 1 yr. 

244. There is great diversity in the methods of finding 
the time in a case like this. Some prominent banks and 
business houses in the United States use the method of 
counting the time in years and days, instead of the method 
just described. 

Thus, the above note was paid July 14, '92 ; the 4 yr. were 
counted forward from Nov. 26, '87, the 7 mo. were counted for- 
ward as calendar months from Nov. 26, '91, and the 18 da. were 
counted forward from June 26, '92. (This is not compound 
addition.) 

In obtaining the int. the years were reckoned as wholes, but the 
months and days were reckoned in the exact number of days 
found in that 7 mo. and 18 da. which began with Nov. 26, '91. Thus, 
the time was 4 yr. 231 da. — 4 in Nov., 31 in Dec, 31 in Jan., 29 in 
Feb., 31 in Mar., 30 in Apr., 31 in May, 30 in June, 14 in July. 

The int. on $1 = $.24 for 4 yr., 
" " $1 = $.0386 for 231 da., 
*' " $1 = $.2785 for 4 yr. 231 da. 

$268.60 X .2786 = $74.77 = Am, 



Principal. 


Batb. 




Tims. 


37680.95 


6% 


3yr. 


6 mo. 12 da. 


1^83.42 




4yr. 


7 mo. 


|;1492.88 




4yr. 


11 mo. 18 da. 


$2689.42 




2yr. 


10 mo. 18 da. 


$487.60 




lyr. 


7 mo. 13 da. 


$2000 




8yr. 


6 mo. 



266 INTEREST. [Chap. XI. 

EXAMPLES CI. 
Written Exercloei. 

What was the amount at mcUurity of each of the 
following indicated notes? 

Obtain answers by each method [Arts. 243, 244]. 

Datk. 

1. Philadelphia, July 31, '84 

8. Richmond, Aug. 6, '87 

8. Boston, Jan. 9, '88 

4. Cleveland, Oct. 1, '90 

6. Jersey City, Aug. 1, '96 

6. Providence, Aug. 8, '79 

24S* For rates other than 6%, proceed as in Art. 242. 

EXAMPLES CII. 

A few demand notes are here indicated; find the 
interest on each of the first four, and the amount on each 
of the others. 

Obtain answers by each method. 

Paid after Date. 
5yr. 9 mo. 18 da. 
3 yr. 6 mo. 27 da. 
3yr. 11 mo. 6 da. 
lyr. 3 mo. 3 da. 
Syr. 2 mo. 7 da. 
4yr. 11 mo. 29 da. 
9yr. 6 mo. 15 da. 

Annual Interest. 

246. Somer States allow interest to be collected on each 
annual instalment of interest, if such instalment is not 
paid when due. 





Date. 


Principal. 


Bate. 


1. 


June 8, '81 


$468.93 


4i% 


2. 


Aug. 2, '87 


$1680.60 


4 »* 


3. 


Feb. 29, '88 


$2600 


51" 


4. 


Mch. 9, '91 


$166 


3i" 


5. 


May 13, 89 


$450.60 


6i'* 


6. 


Oct. 23, '86 


$896.88 


4JU 


7. 


Sept. 15, '82 


$15875 


2i" 



Aet. 246, 246.] ANNUAL INTEREST. 257 

Ex. 



$673^. Biookl^yv, of. If., aj^A^xl 6, 18 (f6. 

dn de/Ynx^nci J^,^^^^.^.....s..^.^^^^promise to pay to 

the order of /'femAAf ofrruXA ^ 

^^loc k^oncU^&cL Q^&v^/yit/u-tA'L&e^^^-y^^^Dollars 

Value received, lAz-iXA i/nt&i&QZ a/nmiattu aZ 6 %, 
J^o, //, Due Be/yi/(cuyyUAV icyuia/^. 



If this note be paid in 3 yr. 6 mo. after date, and no interest has 
been paid meanwhile, there will be paid the principal, the simple 
interest on the principal, and simple interest on each annual instal- 
ment of interest from the time it is due until the note is paid. 

$673. 
.21 



6)141.33 
23.666 

$117,776 = interest for 3 yr. 6 mo. 
7.671 = interest on interest. 
673. = principal. 



;.36 = amount to be paid. 

The 1st instalment bears interest for 2 yr. 6 mo. 

The 2d instalment bears interest for 1 yr. 6 mo. 

The 3d instalment bears Interest for 6 mo. 
Interest on annual Instalment 

is computed for 4 yr. 6 mo. 

$33.66 = annual instalment at ^ %. 
^ 

6)0.0866 
1.6142 

$7,671 = interest on interest for 4 yr. 6 mo. 

s 



258 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



BIXAMPIiBS Om. 



Written Ezeroltet. 



1. 



f/863^. c/l'&w- Ifcyih, Jt.y., foAV /a, 18 ^S 



€.71 di&yyia/yicL <X. 



:proTni8e to pay to 



(Sufkt&e/yv kuncbbtd QA/xZif-thi&& and ^^ Dollars 
Value received, mhZ^ vyiZt^^e^Z a/yiwu/oltu aZ^^o. 
JSTo. ^/7. Diue. /if&nvif 



If this note be paid 5 yr. 8 mo. and 20 da. after date, 
no interest being paid meanwhile, how much will the 
holder receive ? 

2. Cast the interest on a note similar to the above, 
when P= $897.75, i2 = 5^%, and ^=471. 9 mo. and 
15 da., no interest being paid meanwhile. 

3. How much does a man owe at the maturity of a 
note similar to the above, when P=f 437.25, 22 = 4%, 
and T=7 jT, 27 da., no interest having been paid ? 



Commercial Discount. 

247. We have been considering, in the last few pages, 
cases in which money is borrowed from persons ; we have 
learned that the interest is payable at the maturity of the 
note. 



Aets. 247-249.] COMMERCIAL DISCOUNT. 



259 



When money is borrowed from a bank, the interest 
(simple) is paid on the day on which the money is borrowed. 

The simple interest which a bank takes in advance is 
called Commercial Discount, or Bank Discount. 

The borrower does not receive the principal (as when 
borrowing from a person), but receives the principal minus 
the simple interest on the principal; this remainder is 
called the Proceeds of the note. 

The following example will show the methods of calcu- 
lation of discounts and proceeds. 



Ex. 1. 









/£(^r^ . 



Bo^tcyyu; TftcLo^,, cAov-, f6, 18 ^f . 



SlkuXAf dayo, a^t&v cLat& J promise to pay to 

the order of yyLm^eJtt 

..^.^..y.^^S'w^ ivuAuiAy&ci aA/?cXAf-Q^eA)'&rv>^^^^^ ^ Dollars 
at tA& S%a>at cAatu>naZ Banfo. 



Value received. 



9aAfv&Q/ &xyyvki\/yL. 



JVb. /^. Due ^e^. /6//^, ^^f . 



248. When a person borrows money from a bank, he makes his 
note payable to himself, and at the bank which makes the loan. 
The note must be endorsed. 

249. The discount is computed on the maturity value 
of the note ; in the above note it is computed on $267, 
since the note is not interest-bearing. So, also, when a 
person sells a note to a bank (Ex. 2, following), the bank 
discounts its maturity value. 

Find the discount and proceeds of the note in Art. 247. 



260 INTEREST. [Chap. XL 

^^H. . 1336 It will be observed that in case money 

^^ ^^ is borrowed from a person the borrower 



;2 



$1.4086 lias the use of a larger sum of money 

i207 00 ^^^'^ when he borrows from a bank, yet 

1^47 = discount. h® P^ys ^^ same interest. The bank 



$265.53 = proceeds. ^^^ ^^^ ^^^^ ^^ ^^^ discount whUe the 

borrower has the use of the proceeds. 

At the maturity of a note given to a person the borrower pays 

principal and interest ; at the maturity of a note given to a bank 

the borrower pays the principal only, having already paid the 

interest. 

Ex. 2. 






Hyie^ ^yyuyyitA a^ten, data J promise to pay to 
the order of-^^^^.^.,.^ — — ia/nv&o^ ^AioJiiAta-^^^^^^^-^s.^^-ys^-^ 

at t/v& (S^ijtA ClAM&nAt& Bcunk, o^&w- iMyJo, o^.ll. 

Value received, witK OnteA^&oZ at ^i%. 

JVb. £/, Due S^eA. 28/^5. /"ftyiAAf ^vU&, 



Discounted Feb. 5, at 6%. 

In this case the holder took a promissory note to some bank, 
and the bank discounted the note ; i.e., the teller gave the holder 
the proceeds of the note calculated on its maturity value. The 
time for which a hank computes discount is the exact number of 
days from the day of discount to the day of maturity, although 
the time of the note may he written in months. The holder must 
endorse the note. [Art. 229.] 



700. 



m.fl^ .1171 
23 23 



4)3,50 $2.69 = discount. 

.876 

$2.63 = interest at 4^%. ^2 69 

$702.63 = maturity value. ^^^ ^ proceeds. 



Art. 240.] 



COMMERCIAL DISCOUNT. 



261 



The note matures without grace, because payable in N.Y. The 
term of discount is the number of days from Feb. 5 to Feb. 28. 



Ex. 3. 



c%ue yn/yyith^ a^t&v dat& I promise to pay to 
the order of <S%&cl&vlek^ /ifo^AyueAy. 

Value received, w-iZk Cnt&v&ot. 

J^o,/7. Due TMoa^ / ^ ; '^6. /ife/mif S'hcyyyua^. 



m Dollars 



Discounted Dec. 31, '94, at 5%. 



978.25 

;^0 25 



1^002.71 
71 



,16712 
71 



6)11.86652 
1.97758 



$24,456 
$978.25 

$1002. 71 = maturity value. $9.89 = discount. 

$1002.71 - $9.89 = $992.82 = proceeds. 

Ex. 4. A merchant wishes $750 for immediate use for 60 days. 
What must be the principal of his note given to a New York hank f 

Here we have the proceeds and rate given, to find the principal. 
Find the proceeds of $ 1 for 60 days ; this will be $ .99. Then, 

proceeds of $1 : given proceeds : : $1 : principal. 

. •. Required principal = ffl^^n proceeds 

proceeds of $1 

= |^ = $757.58. 
$.99 



262 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



BXAMPLB8 OIV. 



1. 




■ $8700 



m 



&fu^kv-itt&, S^eAvyv., Jbe^. S7, 18 ^^. 




CM) 



c^ineXAf doAM/ a^t&v cLat& c/ promise to pay to 

the order of ^itif^^el^ 

€icfkt tAcm^QAxncC Q^&v^Au hundA/ecC,.^s^.y.^s^^ Dollars 

at tA& BoA^fo oj^ ^xyvn/yyuAM^ 

Valuue received, ^hhXA iAttcAye/oZ. 

J^o, f27* Due /ifcAiAAf ^Ovyvo,, 



Find maturity, discount, and proceeds. 

The State in which a note is to be paid determines the 
question of ' Days of Grace.' 



2. 



C 





Yx fSOOO^. Jbem.v-eA., @^., foAv. 6, 18 ^£. 

cfvxXAf cCoAM, olteAy cLat& o/ promise to pay to 

the order of yyiyo^C^. 

3^k^&& tA(yiiQyaAui m Dollars 

at ^..JJi& cAovtA Jbenv-eAj BoAifo 

Value received. 

Jfo, 70. Due /i^&vnuiAv ^hi/fijs^eA^. 



00 



Find maturity, discount, and proceeds. 



Art. 249.] 



EXAMPLES. 



268 



3. 



Vf 




Skie^ yn/yyttA^ o^teA, ciaZ& J promise to pay to 

the order t?/L,^,^,^/^,^^^^^^^.^,^,,,x/^'m/yfl/^'^/ 

S^cyuA. tkcyvooyOAtci j^tv-e kii/ytcOu&cC tAOitu ^Dollars 

cub t/i& <S\/iat cAatixyyvat BartJc/^.y^,^^^^,^,,^,^^^.,,^ 

Value received, 

J{o, 86. Due (Zyyio^ S^i^eAeAy. 



Find maturity, discount, and proceeds. 

In all notes Date of Maturity and Rate are the first 
things to consider. 



4. 




f^60^. mo'viUtxyiAyyi, Jt. f. , dvuf, f2, 18 ^6. 

S^w-a "yyvantAo^ o/^^v cCat& cf promise to pay to 
the order o/-v,..>...v.v...v,.,..v.....^m/wfl^// 

Value received, 

J^o, /q. Due T4hn^, fC, RoUyl/yi^. 



^^ Dollars 



Find maturity, discount, and proceeds. 



264 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XI. 



6. 



e^ 



f686^. ioAAf- S^OAAf-, TnU/u, duf, 3/, 18 f ^. 

S^vO'&vXAf doAf^ aiteA/ cLat& <J promise to pay to 

the order of^ 'YMfo^t^ 

.o/l^ hiincU&cL £-t^/i^-^l^.....^.s.>^^ Dollars 

Value received. 



^o, //, Due 



c5\ c5^ ^oaJc/q^, 



Find maturity, discount, and proceeds. 



6. 




'k 



^fe 




i 





/ ^t. aUoAto., vt., jtuVif 3/, 18 ar. 

deA>-eAv yyuyyitk^ olteAy cCat& cf promise to pay to 

the order (?/l^.^,^.^,^.^ yyiAf^d^ v^ 

.Y^Dollars 

at tA& lO&lcCeAv o4'aZioncot Bcm^ 



Value received. 
JSTo. i2. Due... 



L&<yn(VuL ieA/yvyi^, 



Discounted 2it 6%. 

Proceeds = $6269.25 ; find maturity and discount. 



Art. 249.] 



EXAMPLES. 



265 



7. 



/ al&w- TMnk; cA'.y,, fa<yi, /, 18 ^6, 

^w^ 'Muyyitko, a/^t&v cCat& of promise to pay to 

the order o/U^wwv,>/n 'nvyo.&C^ 

__ ^^Dollars 

Yalue Received, 

J^o, / . Due &k<Mu. €. Buyi^TV* 



Discounted at 4%. 

Proceeds = $248600 ; find maturity and discount. 

8. What would have been the discount in 7, if the 

note had been discounted by a bank in Ohio at the same 

rate % ? 

9. 




S^vlt&e/yt daya^ aiCed^ dat& of promise to pay to 

the order of 'mAfQ.e^ 

^Dollars 

Value received, 

*N'o. /8. Due jCe<yyicivcC ??tcind&L 



Discounted at 4^ %. 

Proceeds = $100000 ; find maturity and principal. 



266 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XL 



10. 




f3660^. xAe/w- y<yvh, xA.y., ^e^. /9, 18 9^. 

SiAy& yfionXA^ ct^teA^ date^ o/ promise to pay to 

the order of S^ved&tlek, <?ti/ne& 

S'Kite, tAcyuA^nd fi^v& A/icncCtecC a^uxty ^ Dollars 

at t/ie ^&vti/tat o^atuyytal Bcuyvh 

Value received, waXA iAtteA^&ot^ 

J^o. 66. Dae (L. f, (Zt^cyuC. 



Discounted Dec, 31, at 4^ %. 
Find maturity and discount. 

11. A note dated N.Y., July 7, 1891, payable in Ohio 
in 3 yr. after date, was discounted Jan. 16, 1892, at 4J % ; 
the principal was I|p5000. Proceeds =? 

12. 




f780'^. RUhvyumd, Vcu., fwyi& 7, 18 ^^. 

^(yiZif dai^ o/fteA/ daZ& of promise to pay to 
the order of^.^,^.^^...^^,^s^/l^(yiatu> ^ateo^. 



at. 



XA& StcL^teAA/ cAaXAAyyiat Bank, 



r^Dollars 



Value received, witfi OyiteA^aot. 



Jfo. 27. Dae 



fa/yyu^ /"fa/mA/X/yyi, 



Discounted June 13, at 4^%. 
Find maturity and proceeds. 



Art. 249.] 



EXAMPLES. 
13. 



267 



f67/^. cA&w- y<yuh, Jt. If., fa/yv. £0, 18 ^5. 

cAvyieZnfcLaAfQ^ cu^teA^ cLat& w-& promise to pay to 

the order of^ ^ccyyuic&t ^vcuv-e^ 

,cfi/?o A/u/yvd^&cL Q^&u&ntAf-cyyi&^.^^.^^LDollars 



100 



at tA& S^xaaZ cAattona.t Ba/yih, o^, Civxfu^XA/yi&, Stcu. 
Value received, with iAiteA^&oZ. 

JW?. /£. Due.,... /-fiAA^k V ^. 



Discounted Feb. 28, at 6 %. 
Find maturity and proceeds. 



14. 




/ o^'cmAzccu, cA./f., Jbe^. 3/, 18 ^^. 

3^iH>- yyicyyitk^ oAt&v date/ w-& promise to pay to 

the order of Be/yi^'a/yyvi/yv Svoa^&q^^ 

'm Dollars 

at.^,^.^.,.^.^.^.^.^^,^^JtA& ^&e/uAyttif ch/uot ^ 

Value received, n^iX/i Vyit&v&^. 

^a/yyuu&t john^cyyi. 



Jfo. /02. Due 



^CAAHydi W^<uZ&. 



Discounted Feb. 3, at 5 %. 

Find maturity, maturity value, and principal, when the 
proceeds = I|p790. 



268 INTEREST. [Chap. XI. 

16. 



ScyuA^ yiuyyttko/ o/^t&v cCat& of promise to pay to 

the order C>/U,wws,W^^/W. cP. -6i^/^^....,^.^.^.^.^.s/v^ 

_ ^^Dollars 

Value received, wiXA vnteA&ot. 

J^To, //S. Due /"fouM^ V)4ilt&. 



Discounted July 1, '93, at 5^%. 
Proceeds = $8000 ; principal = ? 

Am \ ^'^^20.84 = face. 
^' \ $8110.28 = maturity value. 

Exact Interest. 

250. Thus far interest has been computed on the basis 
of a year of 360 da. Such interest is evidently ^| of the 
interest computed on the basis of a year of 365 days. 

The interest computed on the basis of a year of 365 da. 
is called Exact Interest, and is computed for only fractions 
of a year. 

Exact interest is computed in interest transactions with 
General Governments and in many interest transactions 
of ordinary business. 

Ex. 1. Find exact interest at 4}% on a note for $892, dated Feb. 
16, '93, and maturing Apr, 2/6, *93. 
892. 

-^ — Here we find the interest at 4J% for the exact 



1 784 "^™^®^ ^^ ^^y^ ^°^ ^^ ^^® ^^ ^^ys basis, and sub- 

78 '>5"62 *^^^ ^^°^ ^^^ interest 7^ of itself to obtain the 

'073 answer on the 365 days basis. 

^.28 



Arts. 250, 251.] PARTIAL PAYMENTS. 



269 



Ex. 2. Find the exact interest at 4 % on a note for $781.20, dated 
June 6, *89, and maturing Oct, 4/7, '92. 



$781.20 
.12 



Here simple interest is com- 
puted for 3 yr., and the exact 



$ 93.74 Interest for 3 yr. . , . . ^ox ^ ,i 

9.00 Exact interest for 124 da. ^^^terest for 124 da. (leap yr.) is 

$102.74 = Ans. ^^®^- 



EXAMPLES OV. 



Written Exercises. 



What is the amount at maturity of each of the following 
indicated notes, exact interest ? 



Datk. Face. 

1. Texas, Jan. 4, '93, $890 

2. K Y., Jan. 8, '96, $400 

3. Mass., June 11, '91, $250 

4. Oregon, Apr. 19, '93, $1250 
6. Iowa, Aug. 6, '94, $46849 
6. Vt, Feb. 4, '95, $2685 



Bate. 


Matukitt. 


H% 


Apr. 4/7, '93. 


4% 


Apr. 7, '96. 


6% 


Mch. 10/13, '92 


Legal 


July 18/21, '93 


Legal 


Nov. 4/7, '94. 


6% 


May 5, '95. 



Partial Payments. 

It often occurs that part of a note is paid at one 
time, another part at another time, and so on, until all 
the note is paid. Such payments are called Partial 
Payments. 

In case of interest-bearing notes, it becomes necessary 
to compute simple interest on the different principals which 
appear during the life of the note. 

The sums of money paid and the times of payment are 
Endorsed on the back of the note. 



Art. 251.] 



PARTIAL PAYMENTS. 



271 



Dates found on Times between 
the note. successive dates. 

Jan. 16, '94. , 

Mch. 8, '94. I ^; 

May 13, '94. ^, 

July 9, '94. ^, 

July 21, '94. ,, 

Sept. 19, '94. 



When a note is wholly within 
a year, the exact number of days 
between dates is found, and the 
days' method is used in compu- 
tation. 



4.59 



$544.59 



75. 



$469.59 
5.17 

$474.76 
80. 

$394.76 
3.76 

$398.51 
100. 

$298.51 
.60 

$299.11 
150. 

$149.11 
1.49 



1st prin. 

int. for 51 da. 

am't of 1st prin. 
1st payment. 

2d prin. 

int. for 66 da. 

am't of 2d prin. 
2d payment. 

3d prin. 

int for 67 da. 

am't of 3d prin. 
3d payment. 

4th prin. 
int. for 12 da. 

am't of 4th prin. 
4th payment. 

5th prin. 

int. for 60 da. 



It will be observed that the 
amount of the principal is found 
for the time elapsing between the 
date of the note and the date of the 
first payment. The 'first payment 
is subtracted, and the remainder is 
used as a new principal. And so 
on to the end. 



$161.60 dm't paid Sept. 19. 



272 



INTEREST. 



[Chap. XI. 



Ex. 2. 





f6000^. (ZnnajLotU, Tyid., fwne. /<f, 1888. 

€n d&yyux/yici J promise to pay to 

the order of /i-em/iyu ^o-hyi^^ru. 

^.y.^.^^d'ifV-& tAo^oQ^yuL 

cut tJv& <Su^w&i^^ c4'aCuyyuU' Ba/nk/ 

Value received, w-iXA imteA^e^ at ^%. 

^am/t Bcu{^{y\Zt. 



^Dollars 



This note carried the following endorsements : 



Dec. 1, '88, $160 
Apr. 7, '80, $260 
Oct. 26, '90, $276 



Mch. 1, '92, $1000; 
Mch. 1, '93, $2000. 



Find the balance which was paid on Sept. 19, '94. 



Here we find the times in years, months, and days. 



Dates found on 
the note. 



'88 6 19 

'88 12 1 4 

'89 4 7 1 

'90 10 26 1 4 

'92 3 .1 1 

'»3 3 i;;;;;;;;;;i « i8 

'94 9 19 



Times between 

successive dates. 

yr. mo. da. 

.. 6 12.. 

6... 

6 18... 

6... 



Interest on $1 at 
for the times. 



$.027 
$.021 
$.093 
$.081 
$.06 
.093 



}=». 



174 



Akt. 252.] U. S. RULE. 273 

$5000 1st principal. 

90 int. for 5 mo. 12 d., at 4%. 

$5000 am't of 1st prin. 
150 1st payment. 

$4940. 2d prin. 

69.16 int. for 4 mo. 6d., at 4%. 

$5009.16 am't of 2d prin. 
250. 2d payment. 

$4759.16 3d prin. 
552.06 int. for 2yr. 10 mo. 24 d., at 4%. 

$6311.22 am't of 3d prin. 
1275. 3d and 4th payments. 

$4036.22 4th prin. 

161.45 int. for 1 yr., at 4%. 

$4197.67 am't of 4th prin. 
2000. 6th payment. 

$2197.67 5th prin. 

136.26 int. for 1 yr. 6 mo. 18 da., at 4%. 

$2333.93 am't paid Sept. 19, '94. 

In case any payment is less than the interest due at the time of 
such payment (as in the 3d payment of this note) a portion of 
the interest would become a part of the new principal and would 
draw interest, if we should proceed as with the 1st and 2d pay- 
ments. Here compound interest is forbidden by law, and we must 
find the interest on the same principal until the time when the sum 
of the payments equals or exceeds the interest. 

The United States Rule.* 

252. Compute the amount of the principal to the time 
when a payment, or the sum of two or more payments, 
equals or exceeds the interest due. 

Subtract from this amount the payment, or the sum of 
the payments, and proceed with the remainder as a new 
principal. And so on to the time of settlement 

* Vermont, New Hampshire, and Connecticut have methods of 
their own for computation in partial payments, but it is not advis- 
able to consider those methods in our present study. 



274 INTEREST. [Chaps. XL, XIL 

EXAMPLES OVI. 

1. A Kentucky note for $3500, with interest, dated 
Mch. 1, '90, had the following endorsements : 

Apr. 6, '90, $500. May 15, '90, $800. 

" 30, '90, $300. July 11, '90, $600. 

What was paid in settlement on Aug. 22, '90 ? 

2. An Arizona note for $8600, with interest, dated 
July 1, '87, had the following endorsements : 

Oct. 2, '87, $150. Feb. 21, '88, $4000. 

Nov. 7, '87, $1500. 

What was due May 4, 1888 ? 

3. A Louisiana note for $876, with interest, dated 
Feb. 6, '86, was endorsed as follows : 

Apr. 11, '86, $50. June 2, '87, $300. 

Dec. 1, '86, $160. July 5, '87, $76. 

What was paid in settlement on Jan. 1, '88 ? 

4. A Massachusetts note for $3000, with interest at 
4J%, dated Jan. 1, '91, was endorsed as follows: 

Mch. 7, '91, $175. Sept. 20, '93, $800. 

May 9, '91, $300. Nov. 30, '94, $80. 

Aug. 17, '93, $400. 

What was paid, in settlement on Dec. 6, '94 ? 

5. An Indiana note for $2500, dated Jan. 6, '94, was 
endorsed as follows : 

Feb. 7, '94, $250. Oct. 6, '94, $500. 

Apr. 20, '94, $180. Feb. 7, '95, $350. 

July 7, '94, $75. 

What was paid in settlement on Feb. 20, '95 ? 

Arts. $1145. 



AsT. 233.] 



2:5 



CHAPTER Xn. 



EXCHANGE. 



I^RAFTS. 

Suppose that Wilson & Ca of Baltimore buy of 
Morton & Co. of St. Paul $2o00 worth of goods on 00 
da. credit When the bill is due, Morton & Ca mav 
make a formal request for its payment. Such a req\iest 
is called a Draft; Morton & Co. are said to dnvc oh 
Wilson S: Co. For example : 



Gts' ^ Clt a^ifAt^^^^-^^Paj/ to the 





Order 0/^.v.^^^^^,v>,^.^^^.^^^,^.v^ 



t^j. 



.V>.-%>.N • 



.^^DolJars 



WITH EXCHANO& 



Value received and charge the same to 

a/^count of 

To W-iZo/yyiV^ ^ , 1 -,, / c^ -^ 

\ fUoxton V € i*. 



The draft is sent to Wilson & Co. through a St. Paul 
bank which transmits it to a Baltimore bank. Tlie latter 
presents the draft to Wilson & Co. for payment, and the 
cash is sent to Morton & Co. through the St. Paul bank. 

The banks charge a small fee for their services, and tlie words 
* with exchange ♦ in the draft signify that the debtor must pay 
the fee. 



276 



EXCHANGE. 



[Chap. XII. 



The above draft is called a Sight Draft 

A sight draft is payable on presentation (most States 
not allowing grace on sight drafts), and, from its nature, 
is not subject to discount. 



Instead of waiting for the expiration of the 60 
da. and then drawing 'at sight,' Morton & Co. might 
make a Time Draft, payable after date. For example : 




S^o^itAf-iiAye/ ciaif^ cip^v daZ&y.^,^.^,^JPay to the 
Order of. 






.(^ Dollars 



Value receimA Cf>iyi charge the same to 



To 



^ account of 



J^o. ^f6. JSattvnuyue, Tnd. j ^e.^. Sjff, '^^. 



} 



If Wilson & Co. accede to the request, they make a 
formal acceptance of the draft by writing across its face 
the word * accepted,' together with their signature. Their 
acceptance is equivalent to their making d^ promissory note, 
and the draft is regarded as such by all concerned. After 
acceptance, the draft is returned (through the banks) to 
Morton & Co., who now have a written promise from 
Wilson & Co., whereas before they had only a verbal 
promise. Morton & Co. now have the draft discounted, 
exactly as if it were a promissory note, and thus obtain 
the cash needed. 



In case the time draft is made payable ' after sight^ 
instead of ' after date,^ Wilson & Co. affix to their accept- 
ance the date of acceptance so that maturity may be found. 



Arts. 264, 266.] 



DRAFTS. 



277 



The payee is the owner of the draft. [See also Art. 
228, Note.] For example : 




3^oiXAf-j^lA>-& cLan^ cij^teAy oXxfkt Poy to the 

Order of Cu^oyeLi^^..^^ . 

S'H^&npi^f^i^r^ef /un.^^^pBv&ci —Dollars 

Value receiT^ arta charge the same to 

account of 

To lOlUcyyv V ^., ) 7n(yvtx>n V ^. 



J^o, (Jf6. )Sci(lvy>u>-v&, Tnd. J ^e/fst. fOJ/S, '^^-. 



.} 



Ex. This draft was discounted at 6 % on July 2Qth ; find ma- 
turity and proceeds. 






.8333 
23 



$19.17 = discount. 
$2480.83 = proceeds. 



From day of discount to maturity 
was 46 da. 



Time drafts are rarely used, while sight drafts are very 
common. 

EXAMPLES evil. 

1. E. A. Winslow of Brattleboro, Vt., drew on F. B. 
Crane of St. Louis, Mo., for the payment of a $650 debt 
contracted Apr. 13, '92, and due in 90 da. The draft was 
dated May 13, '92, and made payable 'after date.' 

Write the draft, indicating acceptance, arid write its 
date of maturity in the lower right-hand corner. 

2 . Rewrite the draft, making it payable 'after sight' and 
find its maturity, it having been accepted on May 16, '92. 

3. Winslow had the first draft discounted May 20; 
find the proceeds. 



278 EXCHANGE. [Chap. XII. 

4. What would have been the proceeds of the second 
draft, had it been discounted May 18, '92 ? 

5. On Jan. 1, '92, S. B. Titus of Austin, Texas, drew 
on Ward & Co. of Macon, Ga., for the payment of a 
$1766 debt, contracted Dec. 7, '91, and due in 90 da. 

Write the draft, payable * after sight,' indicate accept- 
ance on Jan. 3, '92, and write its date of maturity. 

6. Draft in Ex. 5 was discounted Jan. 6, '92; pro- 
ceeds = ? 



It is evident that all the drafts thus far shown 
have been requests made by a creditor to his debtor. 
Now drafts may be used for paying debts as well as for 
collecting debts. In this case the debtor (through his 
bank) makes a draft on some bank in the city where his 
creditor lives and payable to such creditor. 

Domestic Exchange. 

257. The main object of drafts is the payment of 
debts without sending the actual money, thus avoiding 
expense, and risk of loss. 

The draft method of making payments between cities 
in the same coimtry is called Domestic Exchange. 

Foreign Exchange. 

258. The draft method of making payments between 
cities in different countries is called Foreign Exchange. 



Foreign drafts are made more extended in form 
than domestic drafts, and are called Bills of Exchange. 
A Bill ofEoschange consists of a set of two bills, both alike. 



Arm. 256-202.] FOREIGN EXCHANGE. 279 

except that tiiej are nxmibeTed. These two bills are sent 
by different steamers, and as soon a£ one of the bills has 
been paid the other becomes void. 

2G0. The drawing of Bills of Exchange is done by 
brokers, and no commission is chai'ged for transacting 
the business. 



The actual amount paid for Bills of Exchange, 
for example paid in 'Sew York for bills on London^ varies 
from time to time ; the current price paid for Bills, called 
the ^Rate of Exduagt/ cannot, however, ordinarily be 
much above or below par ; for if it would cost more to 
discharge a debt by means of a bill than by the actual 
transmission of bullion^ the latter method would naturally 
be adopted. 

It should be noticed that even if all countries had 
exactly the same coinage, there would still be fluctuations 
in the rate of exchange between two countries, as the 
balance of indebtedness between those two countries 
varied. 



The following table gives the value of some 
foreign coins in terms of U. 8. Money as proclaimed by 
the Secretary of the Treasury on Jan- 1, '96 : 

Austria ^ 1 Crown = | .20, 8 

Belgium 1 Franc = .19, 8 

BrazU IMilreis = .54,6 

ChiU IPew = .91,2 

ryu' ST if Shanghai = .67, 3 

\ Haikwaa = .74, 9 

Cuba 1 Peso = .92, 6 

France 1 Franc = .19, 8 

Germany 1 Mark = .23,8 

Great Britain .... 1 Pound Sterling = 4.86, 6} 

Holland ...... 1 Guilder = .40, 2 

H«ly ILira = .19,3 



280 



EXCHANGE. 



Japan ....... 1 Yen (gold) 

Mezioo 1 Dollar (gold) 

Norway 1 Crown 

Russia 1 Rouble (gold) 

Spain 1 Peseta 

Sweden 1 Crown 

Switzerland 1 Franc 

These values are subject to change. 



[Chap. XII. 


.99, 


7 


.98, 


3 


.26, 


8 


.77, 


2 


.19, 


3 


.26, 


8 


.19, 


8 



Exchange on Great Britain is quotQd at the vcUue 
of one pound sterling (£ 1) in dollars; exchange on France 
is quoted at the number of francs to the dollar; exchange 
on Germany is quoted at the value of four reichsmarks. 
The following is copied from a daily journal : 

The foreign exchange market was steady, but veiy quiet in 
tone. Posted rates were unchanged at f4.88} for sixty-day bills 
and 1^4.90 for demand. Actual sales were t4.87f @ $4.88 for 
sixty-day bills, $4.89^ for demand, $4.89^ for cables, and $4.87 @ 
$4.87^ for commercial. 

In Continental, francs 6. 17^ for long and 6.16^ for short ; reichs- 
marks 95} and 96 1 ; guilders at 40} and 40{. 

The following example shows the form of a Bill of 
Exchange and how to find its cost. 





^fiOO"^ . c4e^ IfoJo, o/t;lf., €et. £9, 18 9^. 

0^ tA& Q^yn^ cCat& a/noC te/yuyu, vA^/fa/uxi 

Order of ^cuyyuioet jCMCe/foA/n 

S^x^^-etv-e^ hiAA^dbi&ci js/cyiuncL^ oteAZiAUf, 

Value received and charge the same to 

To I ^. TncyiqaAv V @xy.,\ ^ 

JL/yndxyyi, ^ncfla/nci ) ' 



Akt. 263.] EXAMPLES. 281 

On Oct. 29th sight drafts on London were quoted at 9^.88}. 

£1200 



$6862.00 = cost of exchange. 

Ex. 2. How large a sight draft on London can he purchased 
for 1^3890, exchange at 4.86^ ? 

4.86^ )3890. 

£800. =Ans. 



BXAMPLBS CVIII. 

Find the cost in New York of a Bill of Exchange for 

1. £500 on London at 4.86^. 

2. £1750 on Glasgow at 4.85. 

8. 50000 francs on Paris at 5.18f. 

4. 1250 marks on Berlin at 96J. 

5. 2000 milreis on Rio Janeiro at 54.9 [cents per 
milreis]. 

6. 3000 crowns on Vienna at par. 

7. Calculate the cost at market { a. £650. 
prices (as found in some daily < b, 2400 francs, 
journal) of ( c. 2000 marks. 

8. What will be the face of a N. Y. draft on Bremen 
costing $297.96, exchange being at 95J ? (Omit decimals 
of the answer.) 

9. How large a draft on London can be purchased for 
$8554.14, exchange being quoted at 4.88J ? 

10. How large a draft on Paris can be purchased for 
$1920, exchange being quoted at 5.18|? 



282 STOCKS AND BONDS. [Chap. XIIL 



CHAPTER XIIL 

STOCKS AND BONDS. 

Stocks. 

There are many business undertakings, such as 
railways, banks, gas works, etc., which are on so large a 
scale that many persons must combine to provide the 
money necessary to carry on the business. This is gen- 
erally done by dividing up the whole sum required into 
* Shares ' of definite amount, say of $10, or $50, or $100 
each. 

The whole body of partners is called a Company, and 
the individual partners are called Stockholders. 

The total amount of money raised to carry on the busi- 
ness of the company is called its Capital. 

The affairs of a company are managed by a small 
number of elected stockholders called Directors. 

The profits made by the company are called Dividends, 
and are periodically divided among the stockholders ; the 
dividend is declared as a percentage on the capital. 



A stockholder in a company cannot demand the 
retui'u of the money he paid for his shares ; he can, how- 
ever, sell the shares. 

If the dividends of the company are high, and are 
likely to continue to be high, the shares will sell for 
more than they originally cost; if, however, the com- 



Ams. 264-268.] PREMIUM — DISCOUNT. 288 

pany is not prosperous, the shares woiild have to be sold 
for less than they originally cost. 

Thus, the stockholders in a company are continually 
changing, and different stockholders may have bought 
their shares at very different prices. 



The most important point to notice is that the 
amount of dividend paid to a stockholder does not depend 
on the price at which his shares were bought^ but simply on 
their nominal value. 

Thus, two men who had the same number of $100 shares in a 
company would be entitled to the same amount of dividend, 
although one may have bought, for example, 9100 shares for 9180 
and the other for $50 each. 

267. Shares are said to be above or below 'par' ac- 
cording as they are sold for more or for less than their 
nominal value. The nominal value is $100 per share, 
unless otherwise stated. 

Thus, if $100 shares sell for $110 each, since $110 is \^ of 
$100, the shares are 10 per cent above par. 

When the price of shares is more than their nominal 
value they are said to be 'at a premium/ and when the 
price is less than their nominal value the shares are < at 
a discount.' 



The following are examples of the different ques- 
tions which may have to be considered. 

Ex. 1. $100 shares in a gas company sell for $240 saeh ; how 
mttch will 70 shares cost f 

Each $100 share costs $240 cash ; 

. '. 70 shares cost $240 x 70 = $16800. 

Ex. 2. A man bought $100 shares in a gas company for $16800, 
giving $240 for each $100 share ; how many shares did he buy f 

Since each share cost $240, 

the number of fbares = $16800 -»- $240 g% 70. 



284 STOCKS AND BONDS. [Chap. Xni. 

Ex. 8. A gas company pays a dividend 0/8% per annum; how 
much does a man receive who holds 70 flOO shares f 

His share of the capital is $100 x 70 = $7000, and he receives 
8% on this, or #560. 

Ex. 4. A man invests money in the stock of a company, each 
4100 share costing $240 ; what % does he receive on his investment 
when the company pays an 8% dividend f 

He receiyes $8 on each share, and having paid $240 for a share, 
he receives $8 on each $240 invested ; 7}^ = 3}%. 



Sometimes a company does not need its full 
capital to carry on its business ; and in tliat case only a 
certain fraction of the nominal amount of the shares is 
* paid up ' ; the stockholders are, however, bound to pay 
the rest if it should become necessary. When a dividend 
is declared at so much per cent, this percentage is paid 
only on the amount paid up on the shares, and not on 
their full nominal value. 

Ex. What income will he obtained by investing £1008 in the 
purchase of £20 bank shares, on each of which £5 is paid up, at 
£24 each share, the bank paying a dividend of IS per cent ? 

Since £24 bays one share, £1008 will buy £1008 -^ £24 = 42 
shares. These 42 shares, on each of which £6 is paid, make up a 
capital of £6 x 42 = £210. On this capital of £210 a dividend of 
18% is paid ; hence, income required = £210 x ^{^ = £37. 16«. 

BXAMPLBS CIX. 
Written Exercises. 

1. If $10 shares sell for $3.50, how many shares can 
be bought for $9271.50 ? What is the nominal value of 
shares purchased ? 

2. Mining shares of $10 each are sold at $2.50 dis- 
count; what is the price of 80 shares ? 



Art. 269.] EXAMPLES. 286 

3. The shares of a certain company are sold at 10% 
above par ; how much must be paid for 1060 $50 shares ? 

4. A company pays a dividend of 8%; how much 
does A receive if he holds 50 $60 shares ? 

5. A man holds 350 shares of $50 each, and the 
company pays 7% dividend; how much does he receive? 

6. A man sells 63 $100 shares for $180 each, and 
buys with the proceeds $50 shares at $35 each; how 
many shares does he buy ? 

7. What is the difference between a $100 stock and 
$100 worth of stock ? 

8. A man sold 75 $50 shares for $65 each, and in- 
vested the money in $100 shares at $125 each; how 
many shares did he buy ? 

9. What income would be pbtained by investing 
$3850 in the purchase of $100 shares in a company at 
$175 each, the company paying a dividend of 6% per 
annum? 

10. $100 shares in a certain bank sell at $350, and 
the bank pays a semi-annual dividend of 7% ; what 
annual income would be obtained by investing $9450 ? 

11. A company pays a dividend of 4^%, and its $100 
shares sell for 50% above par; what per cent does an 
investor receive ? 

12. A man buys $50 shares at $62.50, and the 
company pays a 5% dividend; what percentage does he 
receive, and what % on his investment ? 

13. A man sells fifty shares of $100 gas stock, paying 
8% dividend, at $180; he invests the proceeds in $50 
railway stock at $35 ; find the change in his income, the 
railway company paying a dividend of 3^%. 



286 STOCKS AND BONDS. [Chap. XIH. 

14. A man buys $100 stock in a company which pays 
an 8% dividend, and he buys at such a price as to receive 
3% on his investment; what does he pay per share? 

15. A bank pays a 9% dividend, and its $600 shares, 
of which $200 is paid up, sell for $750 ; what % does 
an investor receive on his money ? 

The price of Stock is given at so much per cent; thus, 
stock is said to be at 115, when $100 stock costs $115, 
and so in proportion for other amounts. 

16. How much will $500 stock at 75 sell for? 
How much will $150 stock at 120 sell for ? 
How much will $60 stock at 128 sell for ? 
How much will $1200 stock at 97 sell for ? 

17. What income will be obtained from $500 stock 
when the dividend is 4% ? 

18. What income will be obtained by investing 
$110175 in a stock which pays 3^%, and can be bought 
at 113? 

19. What income will be obtained by investing $70380 
in a 3^% stock at 97|? 

20. What % will a man get on his money if he invests 
in a 4% stock at 125? 

21. A man receives $660 a year by investing $21450 
in 4% railway stock; what was the nominal value of the 
stock ? 

22. An income of $506.25 per year is derived by 
investing $15300 in a 4^% stock ; what was the price of 
the stock per share ? 

23. Stock was purchased at 97^ and sold at 103 J, and 
the profit was $661.25 ; how much stock was purchased 
and what was the total cost? 



Arts. 270-272.] BOiiTDS. 287 

24. In which will a man receive the greater % on his 
investment; in a 3% stock at 95 or in a, 4% at 127? 

25. What will be the difference in income between a 
4% stock at 129 and a 4^% at 145 ? 

« 

Bonds. 

270. Governments borrow money to meet exceptional 
expenditure, and undertake to pay a fixed rate of interest. 

The promissory notes given in return for this money 
are called Bonds. The bonds differ, however, from the 
ordinary promissory notes in being more formal, and in 
having small certificates attached to enable the holder of 
the bond to easily collect his interest. These certificates 
are called Coupons. There is a coupon for each 3 mo. 
of interest. Therefore a twenty-year bond has eighty 
coupons attached. 

Railway and other companies generally issue bonds of 
a nature similar to that of government bonds. 

271. A person investing money in bonds is sure of 
a specified income, while a person investing in stocks 
receives only his share of the profits after all expenses, 
including the interest on bonds, have been paid. 

272. The public debt of the United States Apr. 1, '95. 

Amount of Bonds. Rate. When Redeemable. 

$25,364,600 2%. Option of U.S. 

569,624,860 4 " July 1, 1907. 

54,710 4 « 

100,000,000 5" Feb. 1, 1904. 

28,807,900 4 " Feb. 1, 1925. 

$713,851,960.00 Total int.-bearing debt. 
381,025,096.92 Non mt.-bearing debt (U.S. Notes, Nat. Bank 

Notes, Fractional Currency). 
1,770,260.26 Debt which has matured. 



$1,096,647,307.18 Total debt, exclusive of bonds issued to Pacific 

railroads. 



288 STOCKS AND BONDS. [Chap. XIII. 

273. Stocks and bonds, except those of small com- 
paniesy are bought and sold at a special market, called a 
Stock Exchange. The agent who is employed to buy and 
sell for the public is called a Stock Broker, and the person 
who deals in stocks and bonds is called a Stock Jobber. 

Stock Brokers charge for their services a commission 
called Brokerage; in calculating the cost of stocks and 
bonds this brokerage must be added to their market 
prices; the proceeds of a sale of stocks and bonds are 
the market prices minus the brokerage. In previous 
examples, brokerage has been allowed for in the prices. 

274. Brokerage is generally | of 1%, reckoned on the 
par value of the stock ; it is therefore \ oi $1 on every 
4(100 share bought or sold, no matter what the market 
price. 

(In the following examples each share is to be considered as 
$100 par value, and ^% is to be allowed for brokerage.) 

Ex. A man sold out $5000 stock of a company which paid 3^% 
annual dividends at 94}, and invested the proceeds in a stock which 
paid 4% at 108^ ; what was his change in income f 

$5000 X .Od| = $175 = original income. 

91} — } = $01} = proceeds from one share. 

$91} X 50 = $4556.25 = proceeds from 50 shares. 

^^^i + i = $101} = cost of each new share. 

$4556.25 -T- 101.25 = 45 = number of new shares. 

$4500 X .04 = $180 = income from new shares. 

. *. he had an increase of $5 in his income. 

EXAMPLES OX. 

1. What is the difference between a dollar of stock 
and a dollar's worth of stock ? 

2. What is the difference in the interests on a hun- 
dred-dollar stock and a hundred-dollar bond ? 



Arts. 273, 274.] EXAMPLES. 289 

3; What amount of bonds at 97f can be bought for 
$3900? 

4. What amount of bonds at 96^ can be bought for 
$6335? 

6. What number of bonds at 97^ can be bought for 
$7154? 

6. What number of bonds at 97^ can be bought for 
$584.25 ? 

How much would l)e realized by selling 

7. $1000 bonds at 96? 

8. $500 bonds at 98i ? 

9. $100 bonds at 118| ? 

10. Bonds bought at 124J pay 5% on the investment; 
what rate do they bear ? 

11. Bonds bought at 92 J pay 4J-|% on the investment ; 
what rate do they bear ? 

12. What is the price of U.S. 5 per cents when the 
investment produces 4^% ? 

13. I have $10000 to invest in U.S. 4's at 118 J; what 
is my income, and how much money is not invested ? 

14. I have $7000 to invest in U.S.2's at 107f ; what 
is my income, and how much money remains uninvested ? 

15. U.S. 2's are bought at 114^; what rate do they 
bear? 

16. The trustees of a school invested, as a teachers' 
fund, $40512.50 in U.S. 5's at 115|; the salary of the 
principal was $1000 ; how much was left for his assistant ? 

17. A speculator invested in a company and received 
a dividend of 6%, which was 8J% on the investment; at 
what price did he purchase ? 

u 



$90 STOCKS AND BONDS. [Chaps. Xllt., XtV. 

18. A young man receiving a legacy of $48000 invested 
one half in 5% railway bonds at 95 J, and the other half 
in 6% stock at 119f ; what income did he secure ? 

19. A owns a farm which rents for $320.40 per yr. 
If he should sell the farm for $8010 and invest the pro- 
ceeds in U.S. 4's at 111|, will his yearly income be 
increased or diminished, and how much ? 

20. A capitalist drew the quarterly interest on his 
U.S. 4's, amounting to $540, and afterwards sold the 
bonds at $124| ; what were the proceeds of the sale ? 

21. A lady invested $20948.75 as follows: $6160 in 
Maryland 6's at 96 1^, $8225 in manufacturing stock at 
87f paying 8% annual dividends, and the remainder in 
steamboat stock at 73f paying 10% annual dividends; 
what was her total income ? 

English government bonds are called Consols. 

22. A man had £2400 in the 2|% consols; he sold 
out at 99 1- and invested the proceeds in 4% railway bonds, 
thereby increasing his income by £6 a yr ; at what price 
did he buy the bonds ? 

23. A man having an income of £352 a yr. in the 
2f % consols, sells out at 97 and invests the proceeds in 
4% railway bonds, thereby increasing his income £48 a 
yr ; at what price were the bonds purchased ? 



Aets. 275-277.] ARITHMETICAL PROGRESSION. 291 



CHAPTER XIV. 

PROGRESSIONS. 

275. A series of numbers which increases or decreases 
regularly is called a Progression. 

For instance, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, or 23, 20, 17, 14, 11, 8, 

or 3, 6, 12, 24, or 81, 27, 9, 3, 1, i, J, 
are progressions. 

It will be noticed that in the first two progressions the series are 
made by successive additions or subtractions, while in the last two 
the series are made by successive multiplications or divisions. 

The first are called Arithmetical Progressions (increasing 
or decreasing). 

The second are called Geometrical Progressions (increas- 
ing or decreasing). 

Arithmetical Proobessions. 

276. There are five things to be considered : 

the first term, denoted by a, 

the last term, " " l, 

the number of terms, " " n, 

the common difference, " " d, 

and the sum of the terms, ** " s. 

277. Any three of these five being given, the other two 
may be found. 



292 PROGRESSIONS. [Chaf. XIV. 

In the arithmetical progression, 

7, 10, 13, 16, 19, 22, 26, 

it is evident that the last term is a plus six <l, or that the first term 

is I minus six d. 

.-. Z =:a+ (n-l)d, 

and a = l — (n — 1) <l. 

It is also evident that if a and I be added and the sum -f- 2, the 
result will be the middle term ; and that if each term be changed 
so as to contain as many units as the middle term the sum of the 
new seizes will be the same as the sum of the original series. 

.'. 8 = =-^ X n. 
2 

By these formulas all examples in arithmetical progression may 
be solved. 

Ex. 1. a = 3, d = 5, n = 12 ; find I and s. 

Now Z = a+(n — l)d a-\-l 

= 3 + 11 X 6 2 

= 68. ^ 3 + 68 ^ j2 

= 30.6 X 12 
= 366. 

Ex. 2. a = 6, { = 17, n = 7 ; find d. 

Now ? = a + (»-l)(i; 

.-. 17 = 6 + 6d; 

whence 6 d = 12, 
and d= 2. 

Ex. 3. Find n when a = 2, 2 = 30, and (2 = 7. 

Now 2 = a -f (w — 1) (2 ; 

.-. 30 = 2 + (n-l)7; 
whence 7 (n - 1) = 28, 

and w — 1 = 4 ; 

t'.e., n = 6. 



Art. 278.] GEOMETRICAL PROGRESSION. 293 

BXAMPLES OXI. 
Written ExeroUei. 

Answer the indicated questions. 





1. 


2. 


3. 


4. 


5. 


6. 


a = 


12. 


5. 


1. 


9 

• 


9 

• 


.24. 


I = 


• 


41. 


4.5. 


35*. 


18. 


9 

• 


d = 


5. 


4. 


9 

• 


H- 


3. 


1.2. 


71 = 


8. 


9 

• 


8. 


6. 


6. 


7. 


8 = 




9 

• 


9 
•• 


• 




9 

• 



7. Insert 3 means between 2 and 12. 

8. Find the series of 8 terms when the 3d term is 14 
and the 7th term is 26. 

9. Find the series of 9 terms when a = 10.8 and the 
6th term = 4.8. 

10. Find 2 + 6 + 8 + 11 + ... to 37 terms. 

11. Find 8 + 7.75 + 7.5 + ••• to 11 terms. 

Geometrical Pboobessions. 

278l There are five things to be considered ; 

the first term, denoted by a, 

the last term, " " /, 

the number of terms, " " n, 
the ratio, " " r, 

the sum of the terms, " " a. 

(The ratio is the relation existing between any two successive 
terms. It is the constant multiplier by which any term is found 
from the preceding term.) 

Any three of these five being given, the other two may 
be found. 



294 PROGRESSIONa [Chap. XIV. 

In the geometrical progressioD, 

2, 6, 18, 54, 162, 

it is evident that the last term is a times the product of r by itself 
four times, i.e., a x r*. 

and a = / + f*-*. j-*^^*—»*»« *. 
It is also evident that 

« = 2 + 6 + 18 + 64 + 162 ; (1) 

multiplying the equation by the ratio, 

3» = 6 + 18 + 64 + 162 + 486 ; (2) 

subtracting (1) from (2), we have 

3«-« =486-2, 
or »(3-l)=486-2; 

whence 486-2 



3-1 

Now 486 = rZ, 2 = a, and 3 = r ; 

/. 8= • formula 2. 

r— 1 

By means of these two formulas all examples in geometrical 
progression may be solved. 

Ex. 1. a = 3, r = 2, n = 6 ; find I and 8. 

Now l = ar^-^ __ rl — a 

= 3x2* *"73T 

= 48. 2 X 48 - 3 



2-1 
= 93. 



Ex. 2. a = 3, i = 81, » = 4 ; flnd d. 

Now I = ar^-^ ; 

whence 81 = 3 x r* : 

whence r* = 27 ; 

whence r = 3. 



Art. 279.] INFINITE SERIES. 295 

Ex. 3. Find n wJien a = 3, ^ = 375, and r = 5. 

Now l = a7^-^; 

whence 376 = 3 x 6»»-i ; 

whence 125 = 5*» - ^ ; 

whence n — 1 = 3 ; 

whence » = 4. 

Formula 2 becomes 8 = - — ^ if (2) is subtracted from (1). 

1 — T 

This should be used in case of a decreasing geometrical progression. 



EXAMPLES CXn. 
Written Exercises* 

Answer the indicated questions. 



1. 


2. 


3. 


4. 


6. 


6. 


a= 2. 


11. 


i- 


? 


9 


1.3. 


I = ? 


352. 


625 
TTZ* 


¥l^. 


608. 


9 

• 


r= 5. 


2. 


• 


f 


2. 


1.2. 


n= 5. 


? 

• 


6. 


4. 


6. 


4. 


8 = 


• 


9 

• 


9 

• 




9 

• 



7. Insert 3 geometrical means between 4 and 2500. 

8. Find the series of 8 terms when the 3d term is 10.8 
and the 7th is 874.8. 

9. Find the series of 6 terms when a = f^ and the 
fourth term is ^^^^. 

10. Find 2^ + 6| + 19| H to 10 terms. 

11. Find the series of 5 terms when a = 36.015 and 
the 3d term is .735. 

12. Find 28.8 + 14.4 4-7.2 4--- to 7 terms. 

279. When a decreasing geometrical series is extended 
to a large number of terms, the last term will be so small 
that it will have no appreciable value. 



296 PROGRESSIONS. [Chaps. XIV., XV. 

Thua, If we conUnue f , A, yf,, ^f,, ^/„, „f ,3, indefinitely, the 

last term will be almost zero : .-. In the formula g = ^'~ ^ their 

1 — r 

of the numerator may be omitted, and the formula will become 



$ = , by which we may find the sum of the terms of a decreas- 
1 — r 



ing infinite series. 

Ex. 1. Find i + i + i'} + I'f + ••• to infinUy. 



'"i-r-i-i-r*' 

Ex. 2. Find the value of .46. 

Now .46 = .4 + .06 + .006 + .0006, etc. 

.*. the yalue must equal .4 + the geometrical progression, .06, 

.006, .0006, etc. 

._ a__.06_ , 

/. .46 = .4 + A = H + A= A- 



BXAMPLBS OXin. 
Written Exerciaes. 

1. Fmd^-f^+.'« to infinity. 

2. Findf + ^H to infinity. 

8. Find the value of 1.416. 

4. Find the value of 1.531. 
6. Find the value of 3.3360. 



Abts. 280,281.] CUBE ROOT. 297 



CHAPTER XV. 

CUBE ROOT. 

280. The cubes of the first 10 whole numbers should 
be known : they are 

1, 8, 27, 64, 125, 216, 343, 512, 729, 1000. 

An integer (or a fraction) which is the cube of another 
integer (or fraction) is called a Perfect Cube. 

Thus, 64 and ^|f are perfect cubes ; namely, the cubes of 4 and 
f respectively. 



In simple cases the cube root of a number can 
be found by separating it into factors, as in Art. 80. 

For example, to find -^261. 

9261 = 9 X 1029 = 27 X 343 = 38 x 78 = (3 x 7)» ; 
hence, ^261 = ^(3 x 7)8 = 3 x 7 = 21. 

BXAMPLBS OXIV. 

Find the cube root of each of the following numbers : 

1. 10648. 3. 35937. 6. 19683. 

2. 3375. 4. 13824. 6. 42875. 

Find the least number by which each of the following 
numbers must be multiplied in order that the result may 
be a perfect cube. 

7. 108. 9. 336. ' 11. 4032. 

8. 392. 10. 441 12. 7056. 



298 CUBE ROOT. [Chap. XV. 

282. Since, 

10» = 1000, 100» = 1000000, 1000» = 1000000000, 

and so on, it follows that 

if a number has 1 digit, its cube has either 1, 2, or 3 digits 



(( 


« 


2 digits, " 


u 


4, 5, or 6 


(( 


(( 


a 


3 " « 


(( 


7, 8, or 9 


« 



Hence, if we mark off the digits of a given number, be- 
ginning at the units' digit, in periods of three, the last of 
the periods containing one, two, or three digits ; then tJie 
number of these periods will be equal to the number of digits 
in the cube root of the given number. 

For example, by pointing off the numbers, 2744, 32.768, 3511808, 
as follows, namely, 2'744, 32'.768, and 3'611'808, we see that the 
cube roots of these numbers contain, respectively, 2, 2, and 3 figures. 

Ffaid (60 + 3)8. 

By Art. 86, (60 + 3)2 = 60«+ 2(60 x 8) + 33 

Multiplying by 60 +3 

608+2(602x3)+ 60x82 

602x3 +2(60 x3«) + y 
and (60 + 3)8 = 608+ 3(602 x 3) + 3(60 x 32) + 38. 

The cube of the sum of any two other numbers can be 
expressed in a similar form. 

Hence, the cube of the sum of any two numbers is equal 
to the cube of the first plus three times the square of the first 
multiplied by the second plus three times the first multiplied 
by the square of the second plus the cube of the second. 

The above Theorem will enable us to find the Cube 
Root of any number. 

283. To find the Cube Root of any number. The method 
will be seen from the following examples : 



' -" 



Abts. 282, 283.] CUBE BOOT. 299 

Ex. 1. To find the cube root of 157464. 

By pointing off the figures into periods of three [Art. 282], we 
see that there are two figures in the required root. 

The first figure of the root is 5, since 157000 is between 50^ and 
608. Subtract 50* from the given number, and the remainder will 
be 32464. 

Now this remainder must consist of 3 x 50^ x units' digit + 3 
X 50 X sq. of units' digit + cube of units' digit, and the first of 
these three terms is the largest ; therefore if we use 3 x 50^ as a 
trial divisor, we obtain a quotient, namely 4, which is equal to, or 
greater than, the unknown (units') digit. If now we add to the 



508 = 


157^464(50 + 4 
126 000 


3 X 502 = 7500 

3 X 50 X 4 = 600 

42= 16 


32 464 


3 X 502 + 3 X 50 X 4 + 42 


32 464 



trial divisor the last two of the above three terms (omitting the 
units' digit once as a factor), we shall have as a true divisor 
3 X 502 + 3 X 50 X 4 + 42 = 8110. Multiplying this by the units' 
digit and subtracting the product from 32464, we have no 
remainder. 

Ex. 2. Find the cube root of 13312053. 

13'312'053(200 + 80 + 7 
200»= 8000000 



3 X 2002 = 120000 

3 X 200 X 30 = 18000 

302 ^ 900 


5 312 053 


138900 


4167 000 


3 X 2302 = 158700 

3 X 230 X 7 = 4830 

72= 49 


1 145 053 


168579 


1 145 053 



Here there are three periods, and therefore three figures in the root; 
and, since 13000000 lies between 200« and 300^, the first figure of 
the root is 2. Subtract 200*, and the remainder is 5312053. Now 
take 3 x 2002, that is 120000, as a 'trial divisor' ; and 5312053 + 



800 



CUBE ROOT. 



[Chap. XV. 



120000 will give 40 for quotient. It will, howeyer, be found on 
trial that 40 is too great, for 

(8x2002-f8x200x40 + 402)x40 

is greater than the remainder 6812063 ; we therefore tty 80. Take 

8x2002 + 8x200x80 + 802, 

and multiply this sum by 80 and subtract the product from 6812053 ; 
we shall then have subtracted altogether (200 + 80)> from the 
given number, and the remainder will be found to be 1145058. 

To find the last figure of the root use 8 x 2302, that is 158700, as 
a * trial divisor/ and 1145058 -t- 158700 gives 7 for quotient. Take 
8 X 2302 + 3 X 280 X 7 + 72, and multiply this sum by 7, and sub- 
tract the product from 1146058. There is now no remainder ; and, 
from Art. 210, we have now subtracted altogether (230 + 7)2 ; 
hence the given number = 237*, so that 237 is the required cube 
root. 

Ex. 8. Find the cube root of 252.486968. 

The pointing must be began from the units' figure, and carried 
forwards for the integral part and backwards for the decimal part. 

262'.485'068'(6 + .8 + .02 
6» = 216. 



3 X 62 = 108 
3 X 6 X .3 = 5.4 
(.3)2 = .09 


36.485968 


118.49 


34.047 


8 X (6.3)2 - 119.07 

3 X a.3 X .(fe = .378 
(.02)2 s= .0004 


2.388968 


119.4484 


2.388968 



The process can be somewhat shortened, as in Square 
Root ; it is, however, very rarely necessary to find a cube 
root, and it is therefore undesirable to attempt to shorten 
the above process. 



Aet. 283.] EXAMPLES. 801 

EXAMPLES OXV. 

Find the cube root of each of the following numbers : 

1. 1331. 7. 79507000. 13. 2.197. 

2. 3375. 8. 148877000. 14. .004913. 

3. 4913. 9. 8869743. 16. .238328. 

4. 12167. 10. 733870808. 16. 125525.735343. 
6. 29791. 11. 2352637. 17. 2^. 

6. 68921. 12. 16974593. 18. 39^. 
19. 12568^. 20. 240|^Ji|. 

Find to three significant figures : 

21. ^10. 22. ^J.5. 23. ^3.75. 24. ^.0675. 

26. Find the side of a cube which has the same vol- 
ume as a beam 40 ft. 6 in. long, 1 ft. 4 in. wide, and | in. 
thick. 

26. Find the length of one edge of a cube whose vol- 
ume is 2 cu. yd. 14 cu. ft. 145 cu. in. 

27. Find the area of each face of a cube whose volume 
is 5 ciL yd. 2 cu. ft. 1592 cu. in. 

28. Find approximately the length of one edge of a 
cubical vessel which contains a gallon. 

29. Find approximately the side of a cube of iron 
which weighs a t., assuming that a cu. ft. of iron weighs 
486 lb. 

30. Find, to the nearest mm, the length of a cube of 
gold which weighs as much as a cu m of water, the S.G. 
of gold being 19.5. 



802 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

MISOBLLANEOnS EXAMPLES FOB QENEEIAL BEVIBW. 

1. Express in words 5006017, and in figures thirteen 
million twenty-five thousand eleven. 

2. Find the least multiple of 3157 which is greater 
than a million. 

3. How many articles each worth $14.45 should be 
given in exchange for 60 articles each worth $49.13 ? 

4. Reduce 5 1. 7 cwt. 30 lb. 11 oz. to oz. 

6. Find the G.C.M. also the L.C.M. of 3432 and 3575. 

6. Find the sum of |, f , |, -J^, and ^f . 

7. Divide 43;^ by 28^^, and express the result as a 
fraction of 12. 

8. Divide .221312 by 5.32. 

9. Add .375 of 13s. 4d. and .07 of £2. 10«., and sub- 
tract the result from £.45. 

10. Find the rent of 134 A. 145 sq. rd. at $19.50 per 
acre. 



11. Multiply 905741 by 518963, and express the result 
in words. 

12. A certain number was divided by 77 by short divis- 
ions ; the quotient was 137, the first remainder was 9 and 
the second remainder was 6 ; what was the dividend ? 

13. Reduce 15 m. 95 rd. 3 yd. to in. 

14. A grocer mixed 48 lb. of tea which cost him 64 ct. 
a lb. with a certain quantity which cost 60 ct. a lb. He 
then sold the whole for $76.92, and gained $7.20 by the 
transaction. How much tea did he sell ? 

16. Express 756, 1155, and 1176 as the products of 
prime factors. 



Akt. 288.] EXAMPLES. 803 

16. Simplify 4i + t~3i + 5 J- 6H. 

17. Simplify I of ^ of 4^^ -5- 1| of ^V 

18. Simplify 2.9015 x .01702 x .005803. 

19. Find ^ of £2. lis, lid. - .115625 of £1 + .75 d 

20. A farm of 500°* 91» is rented at $3.25 per Ha. ; 
what is the whole rent ? 



21. Find the difference between seventy-six million 
eight, and four hundred ninety-nine thousand four hun- 
dred forty ; and divide the result by ninety-nine. 

22. What is the greatest •number which will divide 
2000 with remainder 11, and will divide 2708 with re- 
mainder 17 ? 

23. Multiply 190 rd. 9 in. by 144. 

24. Taking the average length of a lunar month from 
full moon to full moon to be 29.5306 da. and the length 
of a yr. to be 365.2422 da., show that 4131 lunar months 
are very nearly equal to 334 yr. 

26. What is the least number of gr. which is an ex- 
act number both of lb. Troy and of lb. Avoir. ? If the 
number of lb. Troy in a certain weight exceed the number 
of lb. Avoir, by 496, what is that weight in gr.? 

26. Simplify ?i^^^Mzi3 ^ 8|f. 

27. Find the value of a property if the owner of f of 
it can sell ^ of his share for $492. 

28. Divide .00625 by 2500, and 6.25 by .0025. 

29. Express 201b. 8oz. 9dwt 6gr. as a decimal of 
2541b. 10 oz. 



804 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

80. Find the difference between the value of 13 cwt. 
74 lb. of sugar at $5 per cwt., and that of 52 lb. 12 oz. of 
tobacco at $120 per cwt. 



31. Write MDCCCXCIX in Arabic figures, and express 
1489 by means of Roman numerals. 

32. A man takes 100 steps a minute, and the average 
length of his step is 30in. ; how far will he walk in 
4 hr. ? 

33. How much coal is required to supply 12 fires for 
27 weeks, each fire consuming 1 cwt. 42 lb. of coal weekly ? 

34. Find the greatest number by which when 4344 and 
6943 are divided the remainders will be 31 and 41 respec-, 
tively. 

36. SimpUfy 267f of |f x (| - f - ^). 

«« a- i-r 4i-3i 4iof4| 

36. Simplify j^-^^^^^_^. 

37. If If of 1| of 29| of a certain sum is $1692.60, 
what is the sum ? 

• • • • • ■ 

38. Reduce .63, .48324, and .01654 to common fractions 
in their lowest terms. 

39. What decimal of $2.25 is $5 ? Find the value 
of .78125 of $4 - .0625 of $1.20 - 2.75 of f .04. 

40. What is the cost of a silver cup weighing 2 lb. 5 oz. 
17 dwt. 12 gr. at $1.85 per oz. ? 



41. $603.42 is to be divided equally among 226 people ; 
how much will each receive ? 

42. The heights of 5 boys are respectively 5 ft. 4| in., 
5 ft. 2 in., 5 ft. 1^ in., 4 ft. 10 in., and 4 ft. 8| in. ; what 
is the average height ? 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 805 

43. Reduce 726314 in. to mi., rd., etc. 

44. A circular running path is 902 yards round. Two 
men start back to back to run round, and one runs at the 
rate of 10 miles and the other at the rate of 10^ miles an 
hour. When and where will they meet for the first time ? 

45. Find the greatest length of which both 42 yd. 9 in. 
and 55 yd. 9 in. are multiples. 

46. Find the least fraction which added to the sum of 
\^, ^, and ^ will make the result an integer. 

47. What fraction of $27 is ^ of $1.21 ? 

48. Simplify ^ x '^^^', and divide .72 by .il7936, 

^ ^ .018 .64 ' J f 

expressing the result as a recurring decimal. 

49. Find the value of .05 of .lOi of £74. 18s. 6d, 

60. A person buys 5 cwt. 46 lb. of sugar at $3.87^ per 
cwt., and sells it at 4 ct. per lb; what is the gain ? 



61. Find the sum of all the numbers between 100 and 
200 which are divisible by 13. 

62. If a person's income be $1700 a year, find what 
he will save in 4 yr. after spending on an average $25.50 
a week, taking 52 weeks to a yr. 

63. Divide 69 mi. 319 rd. 2 yd. 1 ft. 10 in. by 136. 

64. The L.C.M. of two numbers is 11160, the G.C.M. 
is 15, and one of the numbers 465; what is the other 
number ? 

65. Simplify ^ of 1 J of 4J -*- ^ of 1^ of 3^. 

66. Express as a simple fraction. 

3+ ^ 

5-h-^ 

7 + i 



306 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

67. Subtract || of i of $21 from | of ^^ of *20; and 
express the difference as a fraction of an eagle. 

68. Divide .37592 by .0125, and 3759.2 by .000125. 

69. Express f of 2.624H» _ ^ of 1.376 » as Kl. Is the 
answer numerically the same as cubic meters ? 

60. Find the value of 7 A. 80 sq. rd. of land at $200 
per A. 

61. How many mi., etc., are there in a hundred 
million in. ? 

62. If butter be bought at $27 per cwt. and sold at 
33 ct. per lb., how much will be gained on every cwt. ? 

68. Find the G.C.M. of 1035, 391, and 598. 

64. Simplify 4^ of 3^ - 2^ -f- 6f + 6-^- -f- 3^. 

aK ^- vf. 2 ^ ,1551.65^ 21 
66 . Simplify — and — x 



o - 65.1 20.02 

66. A square cistern is 3™ long inside and when filled 
contains 47.25''^ of water; what is the depth of the 
cistern inside ? 

67. If a bankrupt pays $23 in a hundred, how much 
will a creditor, to whom he owes $7866, receive ? 

68. If 8 cwt. 20 lb. cost $20.50, what would a t. cost 
at the same rate ? 

69. The distance between two stations is 234 mi. 160 rd. 
38 yd. 2 ft. An engine wheel revolves 142878 times in 
traveling from one station to the other. How many 
in. does it travel in one revolution of the wheel ? 

70. What is the greatest weight of which both 2 t. 
4 cwt. 18 lb., and 5 1. 5 cwt. 94 lb. are multiples ? 



Art. 283.] :EXAMPLES. 307 

71. The sum of the ages of a father and of his son is 
now 88 yr., and 12 yr. ago the father was three times as 
old as the son ; how old are they ? 

72. A number is divided by 210 in three steps, the 
factors being 5, 6, 7 in order; and the remainders are 
2, 3, 4 in order ; what would have been the remainders 
if the number had been divided by 7, 6, 5 in order ? 

73. Reduce 216875 in. to mi., etc., also 57637 sq. yd. 
to A., sq. rd., and sq. yd. 

74. Find, to within a thousandth of the whole, the 
square roots of 15, ^, and .081. 

75 . Find two numbers, one of which is double the other, 
and whose product is 8192. 

76. Find the following : 

17 X 19, 18 X 14, 13 X 16, 19 x 15, 
75^ 952, 105^ 1151 

77. Find the least length which is a multiple of 1 ft. 
6 in., 4 ft. 6 in., 7 ft. 6 in., and 15 ft. 9 in. 

78. What is the acreage of a rectangular field whose 
sides are respectively 201 yd. 2 ft., and 60 yd. ? 

79. A rectangular field contains 2 A. 134 sq. rd., and 
its length is 6.25 ch. ; what is its breadth ? 

80. What is the least length of carpet 27 in. wide 
that would be required to cover the floor of a room 24 ft. 
long and 21 ft. wide ? 



81. Simplify 4^-H (3jV X T^ X 10^) and 4^ + 35^ X A 
xlO|. 

82. Simplify 7 X 16 - 1 of 4| -5- 1| X 17 - 1 4(18 - 6) 
+ (26-3)}~7. 



808 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

83. Find by factors Vl^36, V2601, VtIMt- 

84. How much will it cost to paint the ceiling of a 
room 15 ft. 6 in. long and 12 ft 6 in. wide at 16 ct. per 
square foot ? 

86. How many loads (cu. yd.) of gravel would be re- 
quired to cover to a depth of 2 in. a path 90 yd. long 
and 5ft. wide? 

86. One side of a square field of 22^ A. abuts on a 
road. This side is divided into building plots 100 ft. 
deep and having a frontage along the road of 30 ft. each. 
The building plots are let at £12 each, and the rest of 
the field at £5. 10^. an A. What is the total rental of 
the property ? 

87. A dealer purchased 40 tubs of butter, each contain- 
ing 35 lb., at 22 ct. per lb., and sold 35 tubs of the butter 
for as much as the whole cost; for how much per lb. 
must he sell the remainder in order to gain 16% and 
«3.22 ? 

88. What is the acreage of a rectangular field whose 
length is 117 rd. and whose breadth is 55 rd. ? 

89. The number of sheep on a farm increased for 4 yr. 
at the rate of 20% each year, and there were originally 
625 sheep ; how many were there at the end of the 4 yr. ? 

90. A man makes a profit of 20% by selling an article 
for 24 ct. ; how much % would he make by selling it for 
25 ct. ? 

91. From a vessel containing 32.3^ of kerosene 1722.5** 
were drawn ; how many dl remained ? 

92. Find the least number which when divided by 17 
leaves a remainder 12, and when divided by 29 leaves a 
remainder 24. 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 809 

98. Reduce to their simplest forms : 

(i) Aa+f+A-i)-Hof^ 

94. The age of a father is three times the sum of the 
ages of his three sons, and two years ago the father's age 
exceeded the sum of the ages of the three sons by 36 
years ; how old is the father ? 

95. A body weighs 60 « in air and 42* in water ; what 
is its S.G. ? 

96. Find the interest on a 30 da. Mass. note for 
$7895.56. 

97. A man bought 13|bu. of corn for $7.77, and 
sold the same at 20% profit; what was the selling price 
per bu. ? 

98. A man paid $45.10, including a duty of 10%, for 
a watch ; how much was the duty ? 

99. The distance between two places on a map is 
166™"; what is the distance in Km if the scale of the 
map is 1 to 80000 ? 

100. Find the number of Km in one mi. 



101. Find the prime factors of the L.C.M. of 391 
and 493. 

102. If 15% be lost by selling an estate for $3400, for 
what must it be sold to gain 20% ? 

103. Find ^.6 to the nearest thousandth. 



810 REVIEW, [Chap. X\^. 

104. A. beam 36 ft. long, and whose section is a square, 
contains 182^ cu. ft. of timber; what is its width? 

105. Find the length of the side of a square field 
which contains 10 A. 

106. Divide 570326 by 63 by 'short' divisions, ex- 
plaining clearly the formation of the remainder. 

107. Keduce to its simplest form 

a-Hi)of(f-ht)+*of(i-hTV)+^-«-^ 

108. Multiply 36.2 by .067, and divide 5762.8 by 
.00376, and .0025 by 3.1. 

109. Find the value of a bar of gold weighing 5 lb. 
10 oz. 17 dwt. 22 gr. at $20 per oz. 

110. How many gallons will a cistern 6 ft. by 4 ft. by 
3ft. hold? 



111. The total number of votes given for two candi- 
dates at an election was 127346, and the successful 
candidate had a majority over the other of 17377 ; how 
many votes did each get ? 

112. Divide $876 between three persons so that the 
first may have $60 more than the second, and the second 
$76 less than the third. 

113. A certain number less than 1000, when divided 
by 56 or by 72 leaves 13 as remainder; what is the 
number ? 

114. A grocer mixes 9 lb. of coffee at 54 ct. a lb. with 
6 lb. of chicory at 16 ct. a lb ; at what price per lb. must 
he sell the mixture in order to get a profit of 25%? 



.' J 



r 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 3I1 

115. The breadth of a room is twice its height and the 
length is thrice its height ; and it cost $115.20 to paint 
the walls at $.08 per sq. ft. ; what is the height ? 

116. How many turfs each 3 ft. by 1 ft. would be re- 
quired to turf a lawn 96 ft. by 75 ft., and how much 
would they cost at f 1.75 a hundred ? 

117. Find the weight of a rectangular solid piece of 
iron 17 ''"^ by 5^=" by 3«", the S.G. of iron being 7.8. 
Answer in Kg. 

118. Find the interest on $672.87 for 2 yr. 7 mo. 
at 4%. 

119. In a room 22 ft. by 18 ft. there is. a Turkey 
carpet with a border 2 ft. wide all round it. The 
carpet cost 20 ^a. ; how much was that a.sq. yd. 

120. Find the length of a square field whose area is 
4 A. 89sq.rd. 

121. A wire .2346 yd. long is cut up into pieces each 
.007 yd. long ; how many pieces will there be, and what 
length will be left over ? 

122. A room is 21 ft. long, 17 ft. wide, and 12 ft. high ; 
how many pieces of paper 21 in. wide and 12 yd. long 
must be bought to paper the room supposing 150 sq. ft. 
of the walls are left uncovered ? 

123. A class contains 19 boys; and in an examination 
6 boys got 56% of the full marks each, one got 90%, and 
the rest got 39% each, except one boy who got no marks 
at all ; what was the average % got by the boys in the 
class ? 

124. A rectangular block of timber is 5 ft. long and 
contains 3 cu. ft. If its section be a square, find its 
thickness to the nearest tenth of an in. 



812 RE VIEW. [Chap. XV. 

125. A square field is bordered by a path one yd. 
wide, the field and path together occupying two and 
one half A. ; find the cost of covering the path with 
gravel at 36 ct. per sq. yd. 

126. A flask holding 26«»» of water, holds 20.25 « of 
alcohol ; find the S.G. of the alcohol. 

127. Some goods cost $25 ; how much is lost by selling 
them at 20% below cost ? 

128. One lb. Troy is what % of one lb. Avoir. ? 

129. What is the proceeds of a N. Y. note for $2040 
drawn Jan. 31, '95, at 3 mo. and discounted on Feb. 25th 
at5%? 

130. What sum is invested if the investment yields 
$585 per annum at 4|% ? 



131. Eeduce 563147 in. to mi., etc. 

132. Find the prime factors of 58212. What is the 
greatest square number of which 58212 is a multiple ? 

133. Simplify ^IH -H HI + f)- 8 (j + f) 

^ ^ ioff-|oft 

134. Find the acreage of a rectangular field whose 
length is 25 ch. 80 li. and whose breadth is 8 ch. 75 li. ; 
find also the rent at $12 an A. 

135. A certain piece of work can be done by 8 men or 
16 boys in 10 da. In how many da. can the work be 
done by 8 men and 16 boys ? 

136. An object weighs 10* in air and 4« in water ; find 
its S.G. 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 813 

137. A man, after deducting $4000 from his income, 
pays $170 income tax on the remainder. If the $4000 
had not been deducted, the tax would have been $250. 
Find the rate of taxation and the income. 

138. A demand note with interest was paid 4 yr. after 
date. The interest at 4^ % was $365.04 ; find the 
principal. 

139. A demand note bearing interest was paid 4 yr. 
after date. The amount at 5% was $2433.60; find the 
principal. 

140. A train 110 yd. long was observed to pass a 
certain point In 10 sec. ; how many mi. an hr. was it 
then going? 

141. Determine the number which when divided by 
231 by the method of ' short ' divisions, gives a quotient 
583, and 2, 6, and 10 as successive remainders. 

142. Find the G.C.M. of 464321 and 683111, and hence 
find all the common measures of those numbers. 

143. Find the weight in Kg of the air in a room 60 ft. 
long, 36 ft. wide, and 21 ft. high, assuming that one 
cu. yd. = .765^^™, and that air weighs 1.29 « per liter. 

144. The wages of A and B together for 46 da. 
amount to the same sum as the wages of A alone for 72 
da. ; for how many da. will this sum pay the wages of 
B alone ? 

145. A room is 20 ft. 7 in. long, 16 ft. 6 in. wide, and 

11 ft. high. Find the number of pieces of paper, each 

12 yd. long and 21 in. wide, which would have to be 
bought to paper the walls, supposing that windows, 
etc., which are not papered, make up one-sixth of the 
whole surface of the walls. 



^ 



814 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

146. Ten loads (cubic yards) of gravel are spread uni- 
formly over a path 180 ft. long and 4 ft. wide ; what is 
the depth of the gravel ? 

147. A merchant borrowed $2000 from a Philadelphia 
bank for 30 da. at 5% ; find the proceeds of the note. 

148. An Ohio farmer sold some sheep for $475, and took 
in payment a 3 mo. interest-bearing note dated Jan. 6, ^93, 
rate 5^ % . On Mch. Ist the farmer had the note discounted 
at 5% ; how much cash did he receive from the bank ? 

149. One pound of silver is weighed in water; how 
many pwt. does it lose, the S.G. being 10.5 ? 

IBO. Find the weight in dg of a cylindrical stick of 
silver 10*" long and I*'" in diameter, the S.G. being 10.5. 



IBl. Find the least length which is a multiple of 5 yd. 
1 ft. 3 in., and also of 7 yd. 2 ft. 9 in. 

152. Simplify (4i-2| of f + 2i) -^ | (4^-21) of f +2i|. 

153. Find V'^83 to the nearest tenth. 

154. (i) Multiply 17 + 19 -f 16 by 18. 
(ii) Find mentally (30 + 4)1 

(iii) Find mentally 85^. 

166. Find 

[352-*. 7« X 4« - {(150 X I -5- 25) + 1260 -f- 35f] 11. 

156. (i) A ratio is 47 ; find the second term when the 
first term is 235. 

(ii) A ratio is ^ ; find the first term when the second 
term is ^. 

(iii) Two similar rooms are respectively 8 yd. and 9 yd. 
long ; how much paper will be required to paper the first 
room, compared with that which will be required for the 
second room ? 



Art. 2830 EXAMPLES. 315 

157. Sound travels at the rate of 1090ft. a second; 
how far off is a thunder-cloud when the sound follows 
the flash after 6^ sec. ? Answer to the nearest hun- 
dredth of a mi. 

158. A father, who had three children, left his second 
son $500 more than he left the third son, and his eldest 
son twice as much as the third. They had $8500 between 
them; how much had each? 

159. In a certain examination every candidate took 
either Latin or Mathematics, also 79.4% of the candi- 
dates took Latin and 89.6% took Mathematics. If there 
were 1500 candidates altogether, how many took both 
Latin and Mathematics ? 

160. For what sum must goods worth $6370 be insured 
at 2% premium so that in case of loss the owner may 
recover the value both of the goods and the premium ? 



161 Simtjlifv 2foff-8iofTW 

161. Simplify 8iof(W-^)ofVW" 

162. A bill of $301.05 was paid with an equal number 
of eagles, dollar pieces, quarters, and five-cent pieces; 
how many coins of each kind were there ? 

163. A and B received respectively ^ and -j^ of a 
certain sum of money, and C received the remainder. 
A received $1173; how much did C receive? 

164. What is the cost of a plot of building-land 242 
ft. long and 21 ft. wide at $2000 an A. ? 

165. At the beginning of a year the population of a 
town was 16400. The deaths during the year were 3% 
of the population at the beginning of the year, and 80% 
of the births. What was the population at the end of 
the year, neglecting changes caused by traveling ? 



816 HEtlEW. ICkjlp. XV. 

166. A liter flask was half filled with sand, and the 
weight of the sand was 1375<; what was the S.G. of the 
sand? 

167. What is the cost of concreting the bottom of a 
circular pond 70 ft. in diameter, when concreting costs 
$1.87 per sq. yd. ? 

168. Find the exact interest on $700 for 30 da., at 6%. 

169. A merchant sold goods for $5650, with 20% and 
5% discount, and 10% off for cash. Cash was paid; how 
much did the merchant receive for his goods ? 

170. The buyer of the goods in Ex. 169 sold the goods 
for $5603.38 ; what was his % profit ? What was his 
percentage profit? 

171. Express 1887 by means of Boman numerals. 

172. Express in t. and fractions of a t. the weight of 
lead required to cover a flat roof, 147 sq. yd. in extent, 
with sheet lead one-eighth of an in. thick, supposing 
that a cu. ft. of lead weighs 820 lb. 

173. Simplify 

174. Find the value of a silver cup weighing 2 lb. 7 oz. 
7 dwt. 12 gr. at $1.20 an oz. 

175. Find the cost of painting the sides and bottom of 
a cistern 3 yd. long, 5 ft. wide, and 3^ ft. deep at 3^. 9d, 
per sq. yd. 

176. Two similar boxes hold 125 lb. of sand and 216 lb. 
of sand respectively ; the larger box is 36 in. long ; find 
the length of the smaller box. 

177. Find the bank discount on a note for $1460 
payable in San Francisco 30 da. after date. 



Akt. 283.] EXAMPLES. 817 

178. Find the trade discount on a bill of goods for 
$1460 with 15% and 7% off. 

179. The volume of a room is 2592 cu. ft. ; what is the 
length of the room when the height is 9 ft. and the 
breadth is 16 ft. ? 

180. For economy which way would carpet strips run 
in the room of Ex. 179 ? 



181. What number is the same multiple of 354 that 
86445 is of 765 ? 

182. Subtract f of f from 1^ of ^; and divide the 
result by (f - :f) x (f - f). 

183. A lidless cistern 10 ft. 6 in. long, 7 ft. 4 in. broad, 
and 5 ft. 4 in. high is to be painted outside ; find the 
cost at 4^ ct. per sq. ft. 

184. A promissory note, written for 30 da. and payable 
in Ohio at 4%, amounts to $1505.50 ; find the principal. 

185. A promissory note, written for 45 da. and payable 
in Ohio at 4%, amounts to $1960.40 ; what would have 
been the amount if the note had been payable in N.Y. ? 

186. When railroad 4's can be bought at 101^ (broker- 
age ^), how many such bonds can be bought for $7317 ? 

187. A man buys $5000 of Government 4's at 111|- 
(brokerage \) ; what % is he receiving on his investment ? 

188. A traveler purchases £500 at 4.88f (commission 
■^) ; how many dollars does he pay ? 

189. A train moves 6 in. the 1st sec, 1 ft. the 2d sec, 
and so on for 75 sec, and then moves 37^ ft. per sec. for 
1 h. ; how far does the train go in the 1 h. 1 min. and 15 
sec. ? (Ans. to the nearest thousandth of a mile.) The 
answer lacks how many in. of the exact result ? 



818 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

190. In a decreasing arithmetical progression a-= 12, 
d = ^, n = 50 ; find I and 8. 



191. The nearest of the fixed stars is roughly twenty 
trillion mi. distant. Show that it would take light 3^ 
yr. to traverse this distance at the rate of 190000 mi. 
a sec. 

192. Simplify 
17^x{6-3-h(i-M)}-17i^{6-3xa + i)}. 

193. Express 1 da. 4 hr. 31 min. 52^ sec. as a decimal 
of 3 da. 4 hr. 5 min. 

194. Find the value of 11 oz. 13 dwt. 8 gr. of gold at 
$1.02 per dwt. 

195. What will it cost to carpet a room 18 ft. long and 
15 ft. wide, the carpet being 27 in. wide and costing $1.05 
ayd. ? 

196. A ship is worth $45000. For what sum must it 
be insured at $5 per $100 in order that the owner in case 
of loss may receive the value of the ship and the amount 
of premium paid ? 

197. At what rate %, simple int., will $7600 amount 
to $7676 in 3 mo. ? (No grace.) 

198. What is the price of a 4% stock, if a man who 
invests $4301 gets an income of $136 a year on his in- 
vestment ? (Brokerage \.) 

199. A man bought $100 bonds at 89 and sold them at 
95 (brokerage ^ on each transaction) and made a profit of 
$86.25 ; how many bonds did he buy ? 

200. Find the mean proportional between 
(i) 4 and 36 ; 

(ii) .25 and 112; 
(iii) .64 and 1.44. 



Find a third proportional to 

(iv) 2.5 and 4.5; 
(v) .7 and 7; 
(yi) 15' and 6*. 



201. A train is traveling at the rate of 35 mi. an hr. ; 
how many ft. does it go iu a sec. ? 

202. Simplify 2.42 ^- .0025 x -02 - .056. 

. 203. Find the rent of 376.4875 A. at $12.80 an A. 
204. How many loads (cu m) of gravel will be required 
to cover a court-yard 20" by 15" to a depth of 5™, 
and how much will the gravel cost at 84 ct. a load ? 



/^ZS^. BoUo'n., 7nc^., jam.. 6. 18^5. 

Si^tee/n, do/ift- a^tsA, cCcute- o^ promise to pay to 

the order o/..„^„„^^^.,^^^^^,„TMyii-e/^ 

.^.^.^.^iSvwi' kiiMid/i&d, i,fA>-e/>ztu-ttv^.-^^^-^DolXars 

Value received. 

J^o.iOS. Ihie SitiiO' /Mo^jym^. 



When was this note due ? What were the proceeds ? 

206. How many gallons will fall on a sq. mi. in a 
rainfall of ^ of an in., and how many t. will the water 
weigh ? (1 gal. of water weighs 8.33 lb.) 




820 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

207. A man has an income of £525. 5^. from 2| per 
cent consols. He sells out at 96^, and buys 4 per cent 
Russian bonds of £100 at 95|. What will be the change 
in his income ? (The prices include brokerage.) 

208. Find the exact interest on 9750 for 36 da. at 

209. Two rooms of the same height are respectively 
15 ft. and 20 ft. square ; what is the ratio between the 
numbers of rolls of paper required for the walls of the 
rooms ? For the ceilings of the rooms ? 

210. The first of two similar rooms requires 94**" of 
plastering for its walls and ceiling, and is 6 "* long ; how 
many qm of plastering are required for the second room, 
which is 7" long? How many cum of mortar are re- 
quired for the first room if the thickness of the plastering 
bel""? 

211. Express 4 min. 12 sec. as a decimal of a week. 

212. A man sold 25 articles for the same price as he 
paid for 35 ; what was his profit ^o ? 

213. The niunber of oz. Avoir, in a certain weight 
exceeds the number of oz. Troy by 17 ; what is the weight 
Avoir. ? 

214. If a number when divided by 391 leaves a remain- 
der of 300, what will be the remainder when the number 
is divided by 17 ? 

215. A grocer bought tea at 32 ct. per lb. and sold so 
as to gain 25% ; the duty on tea was reduced, and he then 
bought and sold at 4ct. per lb. less than before; what 
was his gain %? 

216. A man invested $38400 in 2|% bonds at 95|; 
how much stock at 109 J could he have bought with his 
first semi-annual interest ? 



Art. 28^.] EXAMPLES. 821 

217. A man embarks his whole property in four suc- 
cessive ventures. In the first he gained 60%, and in 
each of the others he lost 20% ; what was his total 
loss % ? 

218. A man spent one-third of his income on lodgings, 
one-fourth the remainder on food, one-fifth what was left 
on clothes, one-sixth of the remainder on books, and then 
had $1200 left; what was his income ? 

219. If a railroad stock pays a 7% annual dividend, 
at what price must the stock be bought so as to yield 4% 
on the investment ? (Brokerage as usual.) 

220. A rectangular field, whose area is 1 A. 65 sq. rd., 
is 137 yd. 1 ft. 6 in. long ; what is its breadth ? 



221. A cistern 9 ft. long, 8 ft. broad, and 6 ft. deep is 
supplied with water by a pump which will send in 27 
gal. a min. ; how long will it take to fill the cistern ? 
(Answer to the nearest sec.) 

222. A cistern 3"* long, 2.5"* broad, and 2"* deep is 
supplied by a pipe through which run 150^ of water per 
minute ; how many minutes will be required to fill the 
cistern ? 

223. In the centre of a room 23 ft. square there is a 
carpet 18 ft. square and the rest of the floor is covered 
with oil-cloth which is extended 6 in. under the carpet. 
'The carpet cost $2.25 a yd. and the oil-cloth cost 90 ct. a 
sq. yd. ; what was the whole cost ? 

224. A man leaves by will $3600 to his wife, and the 
remainder of his property to be equally divided between 
his four children ; and it was found that the share of each 
child was one-seventh of the whole property ; how much 
did the man leave ? 



r 



S22 REVIEW. [Chap. XV^. 

226. Divide 168 A. 158sq.rd. ISsq.yd. by 51. 

226. A person who owned ^ of an estate sold -II of ^ 

of his share for $9600 ; what woidd be the value of ^ of 
^ of the whole estate at the same rate ? '^ 

227. A Vermont inter est-beaxing note for $3000 drawn 
on May 1 for 3 mo. was discounted at 4% on May 13 ; 
what was the discount ? 

228. A man bought 12 sheep for $150 and 10 oxen 
for $525. He sold the sheep at a gain of 10%, and the 
oxen at a gain of 8% ; what was his total profit ? 

229. If in 5 years at simple interest £6520 amount to 
£7824, in what time will £450 amount to £531 at the 
same rate % of simple interest ? 

230. A man sold $5500 of stock, part at 127^ and the 
rest at 129 (brokerage included in each price), and the 
total siun realized was $7035; how much stock was sold 
at 129 ? 



231. Simplify 

f-[i+}i-(i-i)n+ioft^+^. 

232. What is the greatest niunber which will divide 
9640 and 10250, and leave the remainders 4 and 30 
respectively ? 

233. Six chickens are worth $4.20, 3 ducks are worth' 
4 chickens, 2 geese are worth 7 ducks, and 5 turkeys are 
worth 9 geese ; find the value of a turkey. 

234. A can do a piece of work in 12 days, and B can do 
it in 15 days. They work together for 5 days, after which 
C joins them, and the work is finished by the three in one 
day more. How long will B and C take to do the whole ? 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 828 

235. A banker discounts on May 19, at 3%, a note 
drawn on Feb. 1, '94, for 6 mo., for $2750 ; what did he 
give for the note ? (The note was payable in Ohio.) 

236. A room is 20 ft. long, 17 ft. wide, and 12 ft. high, 
and there are in it two doors each 7 ft. by 4^ ft., two 
windows each 6 ft. by 4^ ft., a fireplace 6 ft. by 6 ft., 
and a baseboard 1 ft. high; how many rolls (each 12 
yd. long) of paper 21 in. wide must be bought to paper 
the room, supposing that one yd. out of every 14 is 
wasted ? 

237. A man invests $6900, partly in 3% bonds at 91| 
and partly in 6% railroad stock at. 160 1^; how much 
does he invest in each so that his income may be the 
same from one as from the other investment ? 

238. A person invests half his capital in 5's at 119^, 
and half in 7's at 174rJ. His total income from the two 
investments is $2058 ; find his capital. 

239. A traveler purchases in New York a bill of 
exchange on London for £788; how many dollars did he 
pay the banker, exchange being at 4.89:^ ? 

240. A man obtains an income of $48 from an invest- 
ment of $1560 in 4's ; what was the market price of the 
bonds? 

241. Find^l037. 

State a method for determining by inspection the cube 
root of any perfect cube less than a million. 

242. The product of two numbers is 183.63177, and 
their quotient is 3.857 ; what are the numbers ? 

243. An express train runs a distance of 96 J mi. in 2 
hr. ; part of the journey is run at the average speed of 
40 mi. per hr., and the remainder at the average speed of 
50 mi. an lu\ ; find the lengths of these two portions. 



r 



324 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

244. In the centre of a square court is a square of 
grass covering ^ of tlie whole area of the court, and the 
side of tlie square of grass is 60 feet; iind tlie cost of 
graveling the remainder of the com-t to a depth of 3 
in., the gravel and labor costing 9 1.08 a cu. yd. 

245. A man buys eggs at 30 ct. per dozen, and sells 
them at $2.80 per hundi'ed; what is his gain %? 

246. A gi-ocer pays 24 ct., 30 ct, and 40 ct. per lb. 
respectively for three different kinds of tea. If he mixes 
weights of these teas proportional to the numbers, 6, 4, 
and 3, respectively, and sells the mixture at 36 ct. per 
lb., what profit does he make %? 

247. A piece of work can be done in 48 da. by 15 
men, but after 9 da. two of the men go away ; in how 
many more da. will the men who remain finish the 
work ? 

248. By selling goods for $45.60 a man lost 5% ; 
what would he have gained if he had sold for $57 ? 

249. A dealer bought a certain number of articles at 
the rate of 40 in a lb., and twice the same number at 
the rate of 50 in a lb. He sold the whole at the rate of 
36 in a lb. ; how much % did he gain ? 

260. At $1.12| per sq. yd., it cost $506.25 to carpet a 
room whose length is double its breadth, and whose 
height is f its breadth ; how high is the room ? 



251. Simplify 

569 l\25^ 4.y ^^^\7^ - Sfj ^ ^"^^^ 

252. A clock is set right at noon, but when it strikes 
12 that night it is 80 sec. fast ; find how many minutes 
it will gain in a week. 



Art. 283.] EXAMPLES. 325 

253. In a race of 100 yards A can beat B by 5 yards, 
B can beat C by 5 yards, and C can beat D by 5 yards ; 
how should they be handicapped for a 100 yards' race, 
putting A at scratch and giving him the advantage of 
any odd fraction of a foot ? 

254. What is the least number which when divided by 
15 leaves a remainder 9, when divided by 35 leaves a 
remainder 29, and when divided by 42 leaves a remain- 
der 36 ? 

256. The commercial discount and interest on a cer- 
tain sum for the same time and rate are $254.10 and 
$252 respectively ; find the sum. 

256. A man invests $9875 partly in a 3% stock at 
104^ and pai-tly in a 5% stock at 152|-, and he obtained 
2^% on his outlay; how much did he invest in each 
stock ? 

257. Three persons. A, B, and C, working together com- 
plete a piece of work which it would have taken them 
respectively 9, 10, and 12 da. to complete if working 
separately. They receive in payment $25.44, which they 
are to divide in proportion to the quantity of work done 
by each ; find their shares. 

258. Which term of the series, 9, 12, 15, etc., is 636 ? 

259. Find (90 + 2y ; (60 -f 7)« ; (40 -f- 8)1 

260. A man had 4% Railroad Preferred Stock which 
brought him $664 a yr. He sold out at 119 1^, and invested 
in Common Stock at 145 J^. The Common Stock paid 6% 
dividends ; what was his gain in income per yr. ? 



261. A square field contains 22 A. SOsq. rd. ; how 
long will it take a boy to nm. round the boundary of the 
field at the rate of 12 mi. an hr. ? 



826 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

262. A man bought a certain number of eggs at the 
rate of one for a v,t, three times the number at the rate 
of three for two ct., six times tlie number at 11 ct. per 
dozen, and ten times the number at the rate of 16 ct. per 
score, and sells them at the rate of 90 ct. per hundred, 
gaining by the transaction $3.60 ; how many eggs did he 
purchase, and what did lie gain %? 

263. A grocer has two soi-ts of tea, which cost him 
64 ct. and 50 ct. per lb. respectively ; in what ratio must 
he mix them so that he may gain 25 fc by selling the 
mixture at 70 ct. per lb. ? 

264. A room three times as long as it is broad is 
carpeted at $1.08 per sq. yd., and the walls are colored at 
18 ct. per sq. yd., the respective costs being $39.69 and 
$20.16; find the dimensions of the room, making no 
allowance for doors, etc. 

265. A borrows from B $550 at 6% ; six da. after- 
wards B borrows from C a certain sum at 6% ; A pays his 
debt in 36 da. ; B pays his debt in 30 da. The interest 
being the same in each case, what was B's debt ? 

266. A man who held $24600 of 3|'s sold out at 93 
and piu'chased as many 4's as possible at 130 J. He sold 
the 4's at 139^ and re-invested in 3^'s at 94. What was 
the change in his aimual income, and how much money 
was not re-invested ? 

267. Find the sum of 51 consecutive odd numbers, the 
greatest of which is 117. 



Art. 283.] 



EXAMPLES. 



327 



268. 





^Av&& "yn/yntAo^ a^t&v dat& cf promise to pay to 

the order of ^Aa^, R. ^C&lcC 

S^cyuAy tAcncQyoncl- qa/x^ ku/ncOo&cC ^^eA^^riXAf ^ Dollars 

at tA& S\x^nkCOyt ^.(yiint^ Bcunk . 

Value received, i^iMA vnt&i.&at at ^^%' 

J\ro. /^£. Due favte^ 7^!aA.tun, 



Discounted at 5% on Jan. 12, '92. Proceeds = ? 



269. 





Sw^ntAf dcMfQy cv^v daC& J promise to pay to 

the order of ^iAfvot/iAf f<yyie^ 

^•piM)- tAaiiQAi^yicC ^iv^ kuncOb&cC a/yucL ^Dollars 

at^^,^.^^t/i& /aZ c/f'attonaC Ba/yJo, Bo^tan, T?la^^, 

Value received, 

Jfo. /^. Due /if&nvif ^yyuiXA, 



Discounted June 19 at 4J-%. Proceeds = ? 

270. Find the cost in New York of a Bill of Exchange 
on Paris for 4130/, when exchange is quoted at 6.16^. 



828 REVIEW. [Chap. XV. 

271. A person standing on a railway platform noticed 
that a train took 21 sec. to pass completely through the 
station, which was 88 yd. long, and that it was 9 sec. in 
passing him ; how long was the train, and at what rate 
per hr. was it traveling ? 

272. Two trains start at the same time from A and B 
and proceed towards each other at the rate of 35 and 45 
mi. per hr. respectively. When they meet, one train has 
gone 17^ mi. further than the other. What is the dis- 
tance from A to B ? 

273. A man bought a house and sold it so as to gain 
5 per cent. Had he given 10 per cent more for the house, 
and sold it for $129.60 more than he did sell it for, he 
would have lost 2^ per cent. Find what he gave for the 
house. 

274. An example in multiplication was worked cor- 
rectly, and then all the figures except those 4 — 
given were erased, and the lines show the posi- ^- 
tions of the missing figures; find the missing 36 — 
figures. 



— 3— . 

275. What is the side of a square field which contains 
3 A. 96sq.rd.? 

276. A thin rectangular lamina of metal, 3 ft. 2 in. 
long and 2 ft. 9 in. wide, has cut from its four eor- 
ners four squares whose sides are 3 in. long. The foiur 
projecting portions are turned up at right angles to 
the rest of the lamina, and thus form a lidless box. Find 
the capacity of the box. 

277. Perform the last example after substituting dm 
for ft. and cm for in. and find out the weight of pure 
water the box would hold; answer in lb., etc., to the 
nearest gr. 



Art. 283.] 



EXAMPLES. 



329 



278. An accommodation train going at the rate of 25 
mi. an lir. starts on a journey an hour before an ex- 
press train which goes at the rate of 40 mi. an hr. The 
accommodation train arrives 15 min. before the express. 
Find the length of the journey in Km. 

279. On a map on the scale of 6 in. to a mi. a rec- 
tangulai' field is represented by a space 1 in. long and 
J in. broad ; find its area in A. Also find how many yd. 
less of paling would be required to enclose a square field 
of the same area. 

280. A cubical block of metal of 7.84 in. thick weighs 
.25 lb. per cu. in. A hole of square sectional area is to be 
cut completely through the metal, perpendicular to a face 
of the cube, in order that the weight of metal left may 
be 100 lb. Find, to three places of decimals, the side 
of the square section. 



\ 



)- 



IN PREPARATION. 



AMERICAN EDITION OF 



Algebra for Beginners- 



By H. S. HALL, H.A., and S. R. KNIOHT. 



i6mo. Cloth. 60 Gcntf. 



RBVISBD BV 



PRANK L. SEVENOAK, A.M., M.D., 

Assistant Principal, and Professor of Mathematics and Natural Sciences, 
in the Stevens School, Hoboken, N.J. 



The Algebras by Messrs. Hall and Knight have been introduced in 
many G>lleges and Schools, from among which may be mentioned : 



Brown University. 

Stanford University. 

Northwestern University. 

Dnlhousie University. 

Vassar CoUese. 

Illinois Coilece. 

U. 3. Naval Academy, Annapolis. 



Stote Nornal School, Ypslhinti, 

Mich. 
Stevens Institute of Technology. 
CascadilU School, Ithaca, N.Y. 
Thayer Academy, Bralntree, Mass. 
St. Paul's School, Concord, N.H. 
Etc., etc., etc. 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE, NEW YORK. 

I 



MATHEMATICAL TEXT-BOOKS 

SUITABLE 

FOR USE IN PREPARATORY SCHOOLS. 

SBLBCTBD PROM THB USTS OF 

MACKILLAN k GO., PnMbhen. 



ARITHMETIC FOR SCHOOLS. 

By J. B. LOCK, 

Author of ** Trigpnomttty for Btfiuturs" ** Eltmtntary Trigonomttry" ttc. 

Bdltod sad Arrsayed for AaeiiaiB Sckoolt 

By CHARLOTTE ANGAS SCOTT, D.SC, 

Hiod of Math. Dept.^ Bryn Mawr College, Pa. 

1 6mo. Cloth. 75 cents. 



i< 



Erulently the work of a thoroughly good teacher. The elementary truth, that 
arithmetic is common sense, is the principle which pervades the whole book^ and no 
process, however simple, is deemed unworthy of clear explanation. Where it seems 
advantageous, a rule is given after the explanation. . . . Mr. Lock's admirable 
' Trigonometiy ' and the present work are, to our mind, models of what mathematical 
•chool books should be." — The Literary World. 



FOR MORE ADVANCED CLASSES. 

ARITHMETIC. 

By CHARLES SMITH, M.A., 

Author of ** Elementary Algebra,** "A Treatise on Algebra,** 

AND 

CHARLES L. HARRINGTON, M.A., 

Head Master of Dr. y. Sach's School for Boys, New York. 
1 6mo. Cloth. 90 cents. 

A thorough and comprehensive High School Arithmetic, containing many good 
examples and clear, well-arranged explanations. 

There are chapters on Stocks and Bonds, and on Exchange, which are of more 
than ordinary value, and there is ^so a useful collection of miscellaneous examples. 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

6G FIFTH AVENUE, NE^W YORK. 



INTRODUCTORY MODERN GEOMETRY 



OF THB 



POINT, RAY, AND CIRCLE. 

By WILLIAM B. SMITH, PI1.D., 

Profusor of Maihematica in the Tulane University ofNem Orleans, La. 

Cloth. $1.10. 



*' To the many of my fellow-teachers in America who haye questioned me in 
regard to the Non-Euclidean Geometry, I would now wish to say publicly that 
Dr. Smithes conception of that profound advance in pure science is entirely sound. 
. . . Dr. Smith has giyen us a book of which our country can be proud. I think it 
the duty of eyery teacher of ^omet^ to examine it careftiUy." — From Prof. 
Oeosoe Bruce Halstsd, Ph. D. (Johns Hopkins), Professor of Mathenuitics, 
University of Texas. 

*' I cannot see any cogent reason for not introducing the methods of Modern 
Geometry in text-books intended for first years of a college course. How usefVil 
and instructiye these methods are, is clearly brought to yiew in Dr. Smithes admi- 
rable treatise. This treatise is in the right direction, and is one step in advancing a 
doctrine which is destined to reconstruct in great measure the whole edifice of 
Geometry. I shall make provision for it in the advanced class in this school next 
term." — J?Vofn PrtficijMU John M. Colaw, A.M., Monterey, Vd. 



MODERN PLANE GEOMETRY. 

Being the Proofs of the Theorems in the Syllabus of Modem 

Plane Geometry issued by the Association for the 

Improvement of Geometrical Teaching. 

By G. RICHARDSON, M.A., and A. S. RAMSAY, M.A. 

Cloth. $1.00. 



" Intended to be an Introduction to the subject of Modern Plane Geometry and 
to the more advanced books of Cremona and others. It has a twofold object : to 
serve, in the first place, as a seouel to Euclid . . . ; and, secondly, as a systematic 
means of procedure from Eucliaean Geometry to the higher descriptive Geometr}' 
of Conies and of imaginary points.'* 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE, NEW YORK. 



i 



TEXT-BOOK OF EUCLID'S ELEMENTS. 

Including Altematiye Proofs, together with Additional 
Theorems and Exercises, classified and arranged 

By H. S. HALL and F. H. STEVENS. 

Books L-VL and XL $1.10. 

Also Bold separately a^ follows : 



Book 1 80 cents. 

Booka I. and n. . . 60 cants. 
Books L-IY. . . . 76 cants. 



Books III.-VI. . . . 76 cents. 
Booka v., YL, and XI. 70 cents. 
Book XI 80 cents. 



*' The chief peculiarity of Messrs. Hall and Stevens* edition is the extent and 
Tarlety of thd aaditlons. After each important proposition a larf^e number of exer- . 
cises are given, and at the end of each Dook additional exercises, theorems, notes, 
etc., etc., well selected, often inffenious and interesting. . . . There are a great 
number of minute details about the construction of this edition and its mechanical 
execution which we have no space to mention, but all showing the care, the patience, 
and the labor which have been bestowed npon it. On the whole, we think it the 
most usable edition of Euclid that has yet appeared.** — I%e Nation. 



THE ELEMENTS OF SOLID GEOMETRY. 

By ROBERT BALDWIN HAYWARD, M.A., F.R.S., 

Senior Mathematical Master in Harrow School; 
Late President of the Aaaociationfor the Improvement of 

Geometrical Teaching. 

1 6mo. Cloth. 75 cents. 



" A modification and extension of the first twenty-one propositions of the eleventh 
book of Euclid, developed ont of a SyUabua of Solid Geometry submitted by the 
author to a Committee of the Association for the Improvement of Oeometrical 
Teaching, and reported upon by that Committee with a considerable degree of 
Ihvor." 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE, NEW YORK. 



ELEMENTS 
SYNTHETIC SOLID GEOMETRY. 

By NATHAN F. DUPUIS, M.A., F.R.S.C, 

< jMirtAWMMfc* in <fte Vmveriits a/ 
Kinfiatoa, Canada. 

lemo. pp. 239. $i.eo. 



wn induced lo ptssept thB work to the public, psrlly by reoelTtng 
vould recommenil u k Kquel (o my Fluis Geometry, ind partly from the blgh 

*' "■'in'tUs' wk the BU^Je°cl is 'carried eomewhsl further than is cuatomirr In 

geometry, but the eitenslons thgs made we Mfty nithln the scope of an elemen- 
Ury wort and era highly Interesling and important In themaslvee u forming yaln. 
able aids to the ligbt ODderBtaadlDg of the more truiHwndeotal metboda." 



Introductory to the Above. 



ELEMENTARY SYNTHETIC GEOMETRY 
Point, Line, and Circle in the Plane. 

lemo. $l.IO. 

"To tbls Taluable vork ve prerlonaly directed apecial attention. The whole In- 
tsntloD of the worli hu been to prepare the student to take up anccessfally the 

more of tha scieDC« frooi this book In one yeiir than he can loam from the old- 
Dubloned tnuiBlatlonB of s certain ueient l^reek treatise in two years. Every 
nuthemUlaal maiter should study this book In order to learn Ih? Inelcal method 
of pntentJng the aubjeot to be^nners." — Canada Educational Journal. 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE, NKW YORK. 



I 




lUnfp ^^ ^^^^"9 orders for th§ Mmorfcan Edition of Smith 's Ele- 

*■ montary M/gebra^ th§ Briofer Edition will bo sent wherever 

tiro Comploto Edition is not distinctly ordered* A pamphlet con- 
taining the answers will be supplied free, but only upon the written 
order of the teacher for whose classes they are required. 



AMERICAN EDITION OF 



Charles Smith's iementary Algebra 



FOR THE USE OF 



I 



PREPARATORY SCHOOLS, HIGH SCHOOLS, 
ACADEMIES, SEMINARIES, Etc. 



BY 



IRVIKO STRIN6HAH, PH.D., 

Profbssor of Mathematics, and Dean op the College Faculties 
IN THE University of California. 



|f BRIEFER EDITION (408 iwges) $1.10 

This edition is the same as Chapters L-XXVI. cf the 
COMPLETE EDITION (584 IWffes) $1.30 



'' I have always liked Charles Smith's Alge- 
bra, and the new edition contains a good many 
improvements, and seems to me an excellent 
work. The use of the book in schools prepar- 
ing for Harvard College would be satisfactory to 
our Mathematical Department. I have already 
privately recommended it to teachers who have 
consulted me/' 

—Prof. W. £. BYERLY, Harvard College. 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE NEW YORK. 



A TREATISE ON ALGEBRA. 

By CHARLES SMITH, M.A. 



Cloth. $ 1 .90. 



■ work Is Dwdod thin the (ket tlut It Is the tei' 

nisdlD sUrgs rnunber, IT not in the mijoriiy, or tbe ludlng cDUeg:ea of Ihaedunfry 

' unongwUBhnujrlMineiitlDliHlHuTirdniilTerBl^, Cornell Unlvareltj.nulvFrslt.i 

of Ohio, or PeDISjInnla, of MIohLgin, of WlBmseln.'of Kinus. of Cslifomln. .< 

MlMonri. BtMifcrd DnltBraltj, all., ot*. 

"ThoH scqu^twl with Mr. Smith'a tait-booke on cotlo iHtlotig tud "uUi 
geotaetty will form ■ high eipecUtlon of IhU irork, uid we do Dot think they wll 
bo dluppointed. Its style li oleu ud Doit, It glToe nlleniMiTS prooh of ini>~1 u 
llie fuadunentA] thooroms, and abounds In pnctlcal hlnta« among which wo niaj 
notice thoes on the reaolntloii of eipresdona into IBetDra and tba recosDltkon of i 
Hries as a bloomiiial eipauilon." — Oi(ft>nt Rtvieu. 



HIGHER ALGEBRA FOR SCHOOLS. 

By H. S. HALL, B.A., and S. R. KNIGHT, B.A. 



Cloth. $l.90. 



"Tho ■ Elflmentai7 Algebra,' by tha same authors, whlob haa ah»»dy rtaclied i 
alxth edition, la a work of such exceptional merit that tbota acquainted with li u-UI 
form high eipoelatlana of the sequel to It now Issued, Nor win Ihej be disappoint I'd. 
Of the ■utbOTB' ' HIgbor Algebra,' u of their ' EleiDeutary Algebra,' wf an- 
hesitating usert that It le by tv the best work of the kind wUh which w.> nro 
. It suppllee a want muoh felt by teachers." — I%e 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

ee FIFTH AVENUE, NEW YORK. 



ri 



I 



} 



f 



ELEMENTARY TRIGONOMETRY 

BY 

H. S. HALL, B.A., and S. R. KNIGHT, B.A. 

Authors of **Algtbrafor Btfinners" **EUm€Mtary Algebra for Schools" etc. 

Cloth. $1.10. 

" I consider the work as a remarkably clean and clear presentation of the principles 
of Plane Trigonometry. For the beginner, it is a book that will tead him step by step 
to grasp its subject matter in a most satisfactory manner." — £. Miller, University 
of Kansas. 

** The book is an excellent one. The treatment of the fundamental relations of 
angles and their functions is clear and easy, the arrangement of the topics such as 
cannot but commend itself to the experienced teacher. It is, more than any other 
work on the subject that I just now recall, one which should, I think, give pleasure 
to the student"— John J. Schobinckr, The Harvard School. 



WORKS BY RSV. J. B. LOCK. 

TRIGONOMETRY FOR BEGINNERS. 

AS FAR AS THE SOLUTION OF TRIANGLES. 
1 6mo. 75 cents. 

"A very concise and complete little treatise on this somewhat difficujt subject for 
boys; not too childishly simole in its explanations; an incentive to thinking, not a 
suDstitute for it. The schoolooy is encouraged, not insulted. The illustrations are 
clear. Abundant examples are given at every stage, with answers at the end of the 
book, the general correctness of which we have taken pains to prove. The definitions 
are good, the arrangement of the work clear and easy, the book itself well printed." 
— Journal of Education. 



ELEMENTARY TRIGONOMETRY. 

6th edition. (In this edition the chapter on Logarithms has been carefully revised.) 

16mo. $1.10. 

" The work contains a very large collection of good (and not too bard) examples. 
Mr. Lock is to be congratulated, when so many Trigonometries are in the field, on 
having produced so good a book ; for he has not merely availed himself of the labors 
of his predecessori,7Slit by the treatment of a well-worn subject has invested the 
study of it with interest." — Nature, 



MACMILLAN & CO., 

66 FIFTH AVENUE, NE'W YORK. 



I 

'lied td^^H 
LRt date' ^^ 



This book should be returned ta| 


the Library on 


r before the 


last date^ 


stamped below. 






A fine of five cents a day is 


incurred 


by retaining it 


beyond the 


specified 


time. 






Please return 


promptly. 





tote 4 IMI